This is org, produced by makeinfo version 4.13 from org.texi. This manual is for Org version 9.1.3 (release_9.1.3-29-g037db0). Copyright (C) 2004-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License." (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and modify this GNU manual." INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs editing modes START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY  File: org, Node: Top, Next: Introduction, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir) Org Mode Manual *************** This manual is for Org version 9.1.3 (release_9.1.3-29-g037db0). Copyright (C) 2004-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License." (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and modify this GNU manual." * Menu: * Introduction:: Getting started * Document structure:: A tree works like your brain * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context * TODO items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags * Properties and columns:: Storing information about an entry * Dates and times:: Making items useful for planning * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects * Agenda views:: Collecting information into views * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing notes * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files * Working with source code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere * Hacking:: How to hack your way around * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device * History and acknowledgments:: How Org came into being * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation. * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual --- The Detailed Node Listing --- Introduction * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does * Installation:: Installing Org * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual Document structure * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away * Blocks:: Folding blocks * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax Visibility cycling * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts Tables * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables The spreadsheet * References:: How to refer to another field or range * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc Hyperlinks * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file * External links:: URL-like links to the world * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links * Search options:: Linking to a specific location * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough Internal links * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text TODO items * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists Extended use of TODO keywords * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others Progress logging * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been? Tags * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline * Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags Properties and columns * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features * Property searches:: Matching property values * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers Column view * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property * Using column view:: How to create and use column view * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view Defining columns * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column Dates and times * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance * Timers:: Notes with a running timer Creating timestamps * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time * Custom time format:: Making dates look different Deadlines and scheduling * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again Clocking work time * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock * The clock table:: Detailed reports * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle Capture - Refile - Archive * Capture:: Capturing new stuff * Attachments:: Add files to tasks * RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects Capture * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types Capture templates * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context Protocols for external access * `store-link' protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. * `capture' protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. * `open-source' protocol:: Edit published contents. Archiving * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file Agenda views * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views * Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries The built-in agenda views * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review Presentation and sorting * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda Custom agenda views * Storing searches:: Type once, use often * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer * Setting options:: Changing the rules Markup for rich export * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. * Horizontal rules:: Make a line * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents Embedded LaTeX * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like? * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas Exporting * The export dispatcher:: The main interface * Export settings:: Common export settings * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents * Include files:: Include additional files into a document * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates * Comment lines:: What will not be exported * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML * LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text * Org export:: Exporting to Org * Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax Beamer export * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. * Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. * Editing support:: For using helper functions. * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation. HTML export * HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export * HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files * Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links * Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables * Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output * Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations * Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example * CSS support:: Styling HTML output * JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser LaTeX export * LaTeX export commands:: For producing LaTeX and PDF documents. * LaTeX specific export settings:: Unique to this LaTeX back-end. * LaTeX header and sectioning:: For file structure. * Quoting LaTeX code:: Directly in the Org document. * Tables in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to tables. * Images in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to images. * Plain lists in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to lists. * Source blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. * Example blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. * Special blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. * Horizontal rules in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules. OpenDocument Text export * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. * ODT export commands:: Invoking export. * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. * Extending ODT export:: Producing `.doc', `.pdf' files. * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. * Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions. * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting LaTeX fragments. * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. Math formatting in ODT export * Working with LaTeX math snippets:: Embedding in LaTeX format. * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format. Advanced topics in ODT export * Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter. * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals. * Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting. * Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates. * Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files. Texinfo export * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. * Indices:: Creating indices. * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo. Publishing * Configuration:: Defining projects * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server * Sample configuration:: Example projects * Triggering publication:: Publication commands Configuration * Project alist:: The central configuration variable * Sources and destinations:: From here to there * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/LaTeX export * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages Sample configuration * Simple example:: One-component publishing * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example Working with source code * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks * Languages:: List of supported code block languages * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line Header arguments * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments Using header arguments * System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific * Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file * Language-specific mode properties:: * Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method * Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority Specific header arguments * var:: Pass arguments to `src' code blocks * results:: Specify results type; how to collect * file:: Specify a path for output file * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results * file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output * output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution * exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none * tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name * mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target * noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables * colnames:: Handle column names in tables * rownames:: Handle row names in tables * shebang:: Make tangled files executable * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results * post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation * prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block * epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block Miscellaneous * Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions * Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code * Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files Interaction with other packages * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts Hacking * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals * Add-on packages:: Available extensions * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks * Special agenda views:: Customized views * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial * Translator functions:: Copy and modify * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists MobileOrg * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items  File: org, Node: Introduction, Next: Document structure, Prev: Top, Up: Top 1 Introduction ************** * Menu: * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does * Installation:: Installing Org * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual  File: org, Node: Summary, Next: Installation, Up: Introduction 1.1 Summary =========== Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system. It also is an authoring system with unique support for literate programming and reproducible research. Org is implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created with a built-in table editor. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails, Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects. Org develops organizational tasks around notes files that contain lists or information about projects as plain text. Project planning and task management makes use of metadata which is part of an outline node. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and create dynamic agenda views that also integrate the Emacs calendar and diary. Org can be used to implement many different project planning schemes, such as David Allen's GTD system. Org files can serve as a single source authoring system with export to many different formats such as HTML, LaTeX, Open Document, and Markdown. New export backends can be derived from existing ones, or defined from scratch. Org files can include source code blocks, which makes Org uniquely suited for authoring technical documents with code examples. Org source code blocks are fully functional; they can be evaluated in place and their results can be captured in the file. This makes it possible to create a single file reproducible research compendium. Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when needed. Org is a toolbox. Many users actually run only a (very personal) fraction of Org's capabilities, and know that there is more whenever they need it. All of this is achieved with strictly plain text files, the most portable and future-proof file format. Org runs in Emacs. Emacs is one of the most widely ported programs, so that Org mode is available on every major platform. There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at `http://orgmode.org'. An earlier version (7.3) of this manual is available as a paperback book from Network Theory Ltd. (http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/)  File: org, Node: Installation, Next: Activation, Prev: Summary, Up: Introduction 1.2 Installation ================ Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't need to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install Org on top of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it: * By using Emacs package system. * By downloading Org as an archive. * By using Org's git repository. We strongly recommend to stick to a single installation method. Using Emacs packaging system ............................ Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you install Elisp libraries. You can install Org with `M-x package-install RET org'. Important: you need to do this in a session where no `.org' file has been visited, i.e., where no Org built-in function have been loaded. Otherwise autoload Org functions will mess up the installation. Then, to make sure your Org configuration is taken into account, initialize the package system with `(package-initialize)' in your Emacs init file before setting any Org option. If you want to use Org's package repository, check out the Org ELPA page (http://orgmode.org/elpa.html). Downloading Org as an archive ............................. You can download Org latest release from Org's website (http://orgmode.org/). In this case, make sure you set the load-path correctly in your Emacs init file: (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp") The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not included in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the `contrib' directory to your load-path: (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t) Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your system. Run `make help' to list compilation and installation options. Using Org's git repository .......................... You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this: $ cd ~/src/ $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git $ make autoloads Note that in this case, `make autoloads' is mandatory: it defines Org's version in `org-version.el' and Org's autoloads in `org-loaddefs.el'. Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method above. You can also compile with `make', generate the documentation with `make doc', create a local configuration with `make config' and install Org with `make install'. Please run `make help' to get the list of compilation/installation options. For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check the Org Build System page on Worg (http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html).  File: org, Node: Activation, Next: Feedback, Prev: Installation, Up: Introduction 1.3 Activation ============== Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in Emacs(1). There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp packages, please take the time to check the list (*note Conflicts::). The four Org commands `org-store-link', `org-capture', `org-agenda', and `org-iswitchb' should be accessible through global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own liking. (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link) (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda) (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture) (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb) Files with the `.org' extension use Org mode by default. To turn on Org mode in a file that does not have the extension `.org', make the first line of a file look like this: MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*- which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what the file's name is. See also the variable `org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file'. Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is active. To make use of this, you need to have `transient-mark-mode' turned on, which is the default. If you do not like `transient-mark-mode', you can create an active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing `C-' twice before moving the cursor. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer with `(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)'  File: org, Node: Feedback, Next: Conventions, Prev: Activation, Up: Introduction 1.4 Feedback ============ If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas about it, please mail to the Org mailing list . You can subscribe to the list on this web page (https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/emacs-orgmode). If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the list after a moderator has approved it(1). For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest version of Org available--if you are running an outdated version, it is quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists, prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the version information of Emacs (`M-x emacs-version ') and Org (`M-x org-version RET'), as well as the Org related setup in the Emacs init file. The easiest way to do this is to use the command M-x org-submit-bug-report RET which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so that you only need to add your description. If you are not sending the Email from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program. Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below. $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as `emacs -Q'. The `minimal-org.el' setup file can have contents as shown below. ;;; Minimal setup to load latest 'org-mode' ;; activate debugging (setq debug-on-error t debug-on-signal nil debug-on-quit nil) ;; add latest org-mode to load path (add-to-list 'load-path "/path/to/org-mode/lisp") (add-to-list 'load-path "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t) If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information about: 1. What exactly did you do? 2. What did you expect to happen? 3. What happened instead? Thank you for helping to improve this program. How to create a useful backtrace ................................ If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a _backtrace_. This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace: 1. Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code. To do this, use C-u M-x org-reload RET or select `Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled' from the menu. 2. Go to the `Options' menu and select `Enter Debugger on Error'. 3. Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to document the steps you take. 4. When you hit the error, a `*Backtrace*' buffer will appear on the screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using `C-x C-w') and attach it to your bug report. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Please consider subscribing to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list moderators have to do.  File: org, Node: Conventions, Prev: Feedback, Up: Introduction 1.5 Typesetting conventions used in this manual =============================================== TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc. ..................................... Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property names. In this manual we use the following conventions: `TODO' `WAITING' TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are user-defined. `boss' `ARCHIVE' User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special meaning are written with all capitals. `Release' `PRIORITY' User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with special meaning are written with all capitals. Moreover, Org uses option keywords (like `#+TITLE' to set the title) and environment keywords (like `#+BEGIN_EXPORT html' to start a `HTML' environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org file. Key bindings and commands ......................... The manual suggests a few global key bindings, in particular `C-c a' for `org-agenda' and `C-c c' for `org-capture'. These are only suggestions, but the rest of the manual assumes that these key bindings are in place in order to list commands by key access. Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic name, like `org-metaright'. In the manual we will, wherever possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For example, in the chapter on document structure, `M-' will be listed to call `org-do-demote', while in the chapter on tables, it will be listed to call `org-table-move-column-right'. If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag `cmdnames' in `org.texi'.  File: org, Node: Document structure, Next: Tables, Prev: Introduction, Up: Top 2 Document structure ******************** Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to edit the structure of the document. * Menu: * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away * Blocks:: Folding blocks * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org * Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax  File: org, Node: Outlines, Next: Headlines, Up: Document structure 2.1 Outlines ============ Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the document to show only the general document structure and the parts currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single command, `org-cycle', which is bound to the key.  File: org, Node: Headlines, Next: Visibility cycling, Prev: Outlines, Up: Document structure 2.2 Headlines ============= Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin(1) (2). For example: * Top level headline ** Second level *** 3rd level some text *** 3rd level more text * Another top level headline Note that a headline named after `org-footnote-section', which defaults to `Footnotes', is considered as special. A subtree with this headline will be silently ignored by exporting functions. Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline starters. *note Clean view::, describes a setup to realize this. An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the variable `org-cycle-separator-lines' to modify this behavior. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See the variables `org-special-ctrl-a/e', `org-special-ctrl-k', and `org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree' to configure special behavior of `C-a', `C-e', and `C-k' in headlines. (2) Clocking only works with headings indented less than 30 stars.  File: org, Node: Visibility cycling, Next: Motion, Prev: Headlines, Up: Document structure 2.3 Visibility cycling ====================== * Menu: * Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states * Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state * Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts  File: org, Node: Global and local cycling, Next: Initial visibility, Up: Visibility cycling 2.3.1 Global and local cycling ------------------------------ Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer. Org uses just two commands, bound to and `S-' to change the visibility in the buffer. `' (`org-cycle') _Subtree cycling_: Rotate current subtree among the states ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --. '-----------------------------------' The cursor must be on a headline for this to work(1). `S-' (`org-global-cycle') C-u _Global cycling_: Rotate the entire buffer among the states ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --. '--------------------------------------' When `S-' is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside tables, `S-' jumps to the previous field. You can run global cycling using only if point is at the very beginning of the buffer, but not on a headline, and `org-cycle-global-at-bob' is set to a non-`nil' value. `C-u C-u ' (`org-set-startup-visibility') Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer (*note Initial visibility::). `C-u C-u C-u ' (`outline-show-all') Show all, including drawers. `C-c C-r' (`org-reveal') Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been exposed by a sparse tree command (*note Sparse trees::) or an agenda command (*note Agenda commands::). With a prefix argument show, on each level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the entire subtree of the parent. `C-c C-k' (`outline-show-branches') Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENTS view for just one subtree. `C-c ' (`outline-show-children') Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N, expose all children down to level N. `C-c C-x b' (`org-tree-to-indirect-buffer') Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer(2). With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is negative then go up that many levels. With a `C-u' prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect buffer. `C-c C-x v' (`org-copy-visible') Copy the visible text in the region into the kill ring. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) see, however, the option `org-cycle-emulate-tab'. (2) The indirect buffer (*note Indirect Buffers: (emacs)Indirect Buffers.) will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer, but without affecting visibility in that buffer.  File: org, Node: Initial visibility, Next: Catching invisible edits, Prev: Global and local cycling, Up: Visibility cycling 2.3.2 Initial visibility ------------------------ When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible(1). This can be configured through the variable `org-startup-folded', or on a per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the buffer: #+STARTUP: overview #+STARTUP: content #+STARTUP: showall #+STARTUP: showeverything Furthermore, any entries with a `VISIBILITY' property (*note Properties and columns::) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values for this property are `folded', `children', `content', and `all'. `C-u C-u ' (`org-set-startup-visibility') Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is requested by startup options and `VISIBILITY' properties in individual entries. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) When `org-agenda-inhibit-startup' is non-`nil', Org will not honor the default visibility state when first opening a file for the agenda (*note Speeding up your agendas::).  File: org, Node: Catching invisible edits, Prev: Initial visibility, Up: Visibility cycling 2.3.3 Catching invisible edits ------------------------------ Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer and be confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake. Setting `org-catch-invisible-edits' to non-`nil' will help prevent this. See the docstring of this option on how Org should catch invisible edits and process them.  File: org, Node: Motion, Next: Structure editing, Prev: Visibility cycling, Up: Document structure 2.4 Motion ========== The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer. `C-c C-n' (`org-next-visible-heading') Next heading. `C-c C-p' (`org-previous-visible-heading') Previous heading. `C-c C-f' (`org-forward-same-level') Next heading same level. `C-c C-b' (`org-backward-same-level') Previous heading same level. `C-c C-u' (`outline-up-heading') Backward to higher level heading. `C-c C-j' (`org-goto') Jump to a different place without changing the current outline visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where you can use the following keys to find your destination: Cycle visibility. / Next/previous visible headline. Select this location. / Do a Sparse-tree search The following keys work if you turn off `org-goto-auto-isearch' n / p Next/previous visible headline. f / b Next/previous headline same level. u One level up. 0-9 Digit argument. q Quit See also the option `org-goto-interface'.  File: org, Node: Structure editing, Next: Sparse trees, Prev: Motion, Up: Document structure 2.5 Structure editing ===================== `M-' (`org-meta-return') Insert a new heading, item or row. If the command is used at the _beginning_ of a line, and if there is a heading or a plain list item (*note Plain lists::) at point, the new heading/item is created _before_ the current line. When used at the beginning of a regular line of text, turn that line into a heading. When this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new item or headline. If you do not want the line to be split, customize `org-M-RET-may-split-line'. Calling the command with a `C-u' prefix unconditionally inserts a new heading at the end of the current subtree, thus preserving its contents. With a double `C-u C-u' prefix, the new heading is created at the end of the parent subtree instead. `C-' (`org-insert-heading-respect-content') Insert a new heading at the end of the current subtree. `M-S-' (`org-insert-todo-heading') Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the variable `org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change'. `C-S-' (`org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content') Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like `C-', the new headline will be inserted after the current subtree. `' (`org-cycle') In a new entry with no text yet, the first demotes the entry to become a child of the previous one. The next makes it a parent, and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another , and you are back to the initial level. `M-' (`org-do-promote') Promote current heading by one level. `M-' (`org-do-demote') Demote current heading by one level. `M-S-' (`org-promote-subtree') Promote the current subtree by one level. `M-S-' (`org-demote-subtree') Demote the current subtree by one level. `M-' (`org-move-subtree-up') Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same level). `M-' (`org-move-subtree-down') Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level). `M-h' (`org-mark-element') Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent elements of the one just marked. E.g., hitting on a paragraph will mark it, hitting immediately again will mark the next one. `C-c @' (`org-mark-subtree') Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark subsequent subtrees of the same level than the marked subtree. `C-c C-x C-w' (`org-cut-subtree') Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees. `C-c C-x M-w' (`org-copy-subtree') Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N sequential subtrees. `C-c C-x C-y' (`org-paste-subtree') Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a headline marker like `****'. `C-y' (`org-yank') Depending on the options `org-yank-adjusted-subtrees' and `org-yank-folded-subtrees', Org's internal `yank' command will paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as `C-c C-x C-y'. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place, but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal `yank' to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal yank is `C-u C-y'. If you use `yank-pop' after a yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding. `C-c C-x c' (`org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift') Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example, to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For more details, see the docstring of the command `org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift'. `C-c C-w' (`org-refile') Refile entry or region to a different location. *Note Refile and copy::. `C-c ^' (`org-sort') Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred, creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With a `C-u' prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. `C-x n s' (`org-narrow-to-subtree') Narrow buffer to current subtree. `C-x n b' (`org-narrow-to-block') Narrow buffer to current block. `C-x n w' (`widen') Widen buffer to remove narrowing. `C-c *' (`org-toggle-heading') Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region. When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is inside a table (*note Tables::), the Meta-Cursor keys have different functionality.  File: org, Node: Sparse trees, Next: Plain lists, Prev: Structure editing, Up: Document structure 2.6 Sparse trees ================ An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct _sparse trees_ for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made visible along with the headline structure above it(1). Just try it out and you will see immediately how it works. Org mode contains several commands for creating such trees, all these commands can be accessed through a dispatcher: `C-c /' (`org-sparse-tree') This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command. `C-c / r' or `C-c / /' (`org-occur') Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an editing command(2), or by pressing `C-c C-c'. When called with a `C-u' prefix argument, previous highlights are kept, so several calls to this command can be stacked. `M-g n' or `M-g M-n' (`next-error') Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer. `M-g p' or `M-g M-p' (`previous-error') Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer. For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can use the option `org-agenda-custom-commands' to define fast keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be accessible through the agenda dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::). For example: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME"))) will define the key `C-c a f' as a shortcut for creating a sparse tree matching the string `FIXME'. The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords, tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual. To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command `ps-print-buffer-with-faces' which does not print invisible parts of the document. Or you can use `C-c C-e C-v' to export only the visible part of the document and print the resulting file. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See also the variable `org-show-context-detail' to decide how much context is shown around each match. (2) This depends on the option `org-remove-highlights-with-change'  File: org, Node: Plain lists, Next: Drawers, Prev: Sparse trees, Up: Document structure 2.7 Plain lists =============== Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter (*note Exporting::) can parse and format them. Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists. * _Unordered_ list items start with `-', `+', or `*'(1) as bullets. * _Ordered_ list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or a right parenthesis(2), such as `1.' or `1)'(3). If you want a list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item with `[@20]'(4). Those constructs can be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering. * _Description_ list items are unordered list items, and contain the separator ` :: ' to distinguish the description _term_ from the description. Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number `10.', then the 2-digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented than its bullet/number. A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank lines. In that case, all items are closed. Here is an example: ** Lord of the Rings My favorite scenes are (in this order) 1. The attack of the Rohirrim 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king + this was already my favorite scene in the book + I really like Miranda Otto. 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas - on DVD only He makes a really funny face when it happens. But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole. Important actors in this film are: - Elijah Wood :: He plays Frodo - Sean Astin :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in The Goonies. Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with them correctly, and by exporting them properly (*note Exporting::). Since indentation is what governs the structure of these lists, many structural constructs like `#+BEGIN_...' blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item. If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable `org-list-demote-modify-bullet'. To get a greater difference of indentation between items and their sub-items, customize `org-list-indent-offset'. The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of these actions get in your way, configure `org-list-automatic-rules' to disable them individually. `' (`org-cycle') Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable `org-cycle-include-plain-lists'. If this variable is set to `integrate', plain list items will be treated like low-level headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the first demotes the item to become a child of the previous one. Subsequent s move the item to meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial position. `M-' (`org-insert-heading') Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new heading (*note Structure editing::). If this command is used in the middle of an item, that item is _split_ in two, and the second part becomes the new item(5). If this command is executed _before item's body_, the new item is created _before_ the current one. `M-S-' Insert a new item with a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::). `S-up' `S-down' Jump to the previous/next item in the current list(6), but only if `org-support-shift-select' is off. If not, you can still use paragraph jumping commands like `C-' and `C-' to quite similar effect. `M-up' `M-down' Move the item including subitems up/down(7) (swap with previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is automatic. `M-left' `M-right' Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone. `M-S-' `M-S-' Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems. Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor motion or so. As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring `org-list-automatic-rules'. The global indentation of a list has no influence on the text _after_ the list. `C-c C-c' If there is a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::) in the item line, toggle the state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation consistency in the whole list. `C-c -' Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets (`-', `+', `*', `1.', `1)') or a subset of them, depending on `org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator', the type of list, and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, all selected lines are converted to list items. With a prefix argument, selected text is changed into a single item. If the first line already was a list item, any item marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be converted into a list item. `C-c *' Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at its location). *Note Structure editing::, for a detailed explanation. `C-c C-*' Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked (resp. checked). `S-left/right' This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or anywhere in an item line, details depending on `org-support-shift-select'. `C-c ^' Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method: numerically, alphabetically, by time, by checked status for check lists, or by a custom function. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) When using `*' as a bullet, lines must be indented or they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though `*' is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items. (2) You can filter out any of them by configuring `org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator'. (3) You can also get `a.', `A.', `a)' and `A)' by configuring `org-list-allow-alphabetical'. To minimize confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers. (4) If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie must be put _before_ the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical lists, you can also use counters like `[@b]'. (5) If you do not want the item to be split, customize the variable `org-M-RET-may-split-line'. (6) If you want to cycle around items that way, you may customize `org-list-use-circular-motion'. (7) See `org-list-use-circular-motion' for a cyclic behavior.  File: org, Node: Drawers, Next: Blocks, Prev: Plain lists, Up: Document structure 2.8 Drawers =========== Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has _drawers_. They can contain anything but a headline and another drawer. Drawers look like this: ** This is a headline Still outside the drawer :DRAWERNAME: This is inside the drawer. :END: After the drawer. You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling `org-insert-drawer', which is bound to . With an active region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix argument, this command calls `org-insert-property-drawer' and add a property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer keywords is also possible using `M-'(1). Visibility cycling (*note Visibility cycling::) on the headline will hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and press there. Org mode uses the `PROPERTIES' drawer for storing properties (*note Properties and columns::), and you can also arrange for state change notes (*note Tracking TODO state changes::) and clock times (*note Clocking work time::) to be stored in a drawer `LOGBOOK'. If you want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use `C-c C-z' Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer. You can select the name of the drawers which should be exported with `org-export-with-drawers'. In that case, drawer contents will appear in export output. Property drawers are not affected by this variable: configure `org-export-with-properties' instead. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Many desktops intercept `M-' to switch windows. Use `C-M-i' or ` ' instead for completion (*note Completion::).  File: org, Node: Blocks, Next: Footnotes, Prev: Drawers, Up: Document structure 2.9 Blocks ========== Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source code examples (*note Literal examples::) to capturing time logging information (*note Clocking work time::). These blocks can be folded and unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks folded at startup by configuring the option `org-hide-block-startup' or on a per-file basis by using #+STARTUP: hideblocks #+STARTUP: nohideblocks  File: org, Node: Footnotes, Next: Orgstruct mode, Prev: Blocks, Up: Document structure 2.10 Footnotes ============== Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote definition, headline, or after two consecutive empty lines. The footnote reference is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. Markers always start with `fn:'. For example: The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to. ... [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org Org mode extends the number-based syntax to _named_ footnotes and optional inline definition. Here are the valid references: `[fn:name]' A named footnote reference, where `name' is a unique label word, or, for simplicity of automatic creation, a number. `[fn::This is the inline definition of this footnote]' A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the reference point. `[fn:name:a definition]' An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note. Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use `[fn:name]' to create additional references. Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself. This is handled by the variable `org-footnote-auto-label' and its corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords. See the docstring of that variable for details. The following command handles footnotes: `C-c C-x f' The footnote action command. When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference. Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the option `org-footnote-define-inline'(1), the definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or separately into the location determined by the option `org-footnote-section'. When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional options is offered: s Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing, Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will also move entries according to `org-footnote-section'. Automatic sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the option `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. r Renumber the simple `fn:N' footnotes. Automatic renumbering after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the option `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. S Short for first `r', then `s' action. n Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. d Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references to it. Depending on the variable `org-footnote-auto-adjust'(2), renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or deletion. `C-c C-c' If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as `C-c C-x f'. `C-c C-o or mouse-1/2' Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and you can use the usual commands to follow these links. `C-c '' `C-c '' Edit the footnote definition corresponding to the reference at point in a separate window. The window can be closed by pressing `C-c ''. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: fninline' or `#+STARTUP: nofninline' (2) the corresponding in-buffer options are `fnadjust' and `nofnadjust'.  File: org, Node: Orgstruct mode, Next: Org syntax, Prev: Footnotes, Up: Document structure 2.11 The Orgstruct minor mode ============================= If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode `orgstruct-mode' makes this possible. Toggle the mode with `M-x orgstruct-mode RET', or turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of: (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct) (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++) When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use `orgstruct++-mode', Org will also export indentation and autofill settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an item. You can also use Org structure editing to fold and unfold headlines in _any_ file, provided you defined `orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp': the regular expression must match the local prefix to use before Org's headlines. For example, if you set this variable to `";; "' in Emacs Lisp files, you will be able to fold and unfold headlines in Emacs Lisp commented lines. Some commands like `org-demote' are disabled when the prefix is set, but folding/unfolding will work correctly.  File: org, Node: Org syntax, Prev: Orgstruct mode, Up: Document structure 2.12 Org syntax =============== A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is available as a draft on Worg (http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html), written and maintained by Nicolas Goaziou. It defines Org's core internal concepts such as `headlines', `sections', `affiliated keywords', `(greater) elements' and `objects'. Each part of an Org file falls into one of the categories above. To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in a buffer: M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) RET It will output a list containing the buffer's content represented as an abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information stored in this list. Most interactive commands (e.g., for structure editing) also rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding context. You can check syntax in your documents using `org-lint' command.  File: org, Node: Tables, Next: Hyperlinks, Prev: Document structure, Up: Top 3 Tables ******** Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like calculations are supported using the Emacs `calc' package (*note Calc: (calc)Top.). * Menu: * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables  File: org, Node: Built-in table editor, Next: Column width and alignment, Up: Tables 3.1 The built-in table editor ============================= Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with `|' as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. `|' is also the column separator(1). A table might look like this: | Name | Phone | Age | |-------+-------+-----| | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press or or `C-c C-c' inside the table. also moves to the next field ( to the next row) and creates new table rows at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with `|-' is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to create the above table, you would only type |Name|Phone|Age| |- and then press to align the table and start filling in fields. Even faster would be to type `|Name|Phone|Age' followed by `C-c '. When typing text into a field, Org treats , , and all character keys in a special way, so that inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when typing _immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field with `', `S-' or `'_, the field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too unpredictable for you, configure the option `org-table-auto-blank-field'. Creation and conversion ....................... `C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')' Convert the active region to a table. If every line contains at least one TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated. If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed. If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix argument to force a specific separator: `C-u' forces CSV, `C-u C-u' forces TAB, `C-u C-u C-u' will prompt for a regular expression to match the separator, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator. If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org table. But it is easier just to start typing, like `|Name|Phone|Age |- '. Re-aligning and field motion ............................ `C-c C-c (`org-table-align')' Re-align the table and don't move to another field. `C-c SPC (`org-table-blank-field')' Blank the field at point. `TAB (`org-table-next-field')' Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if necessary. `S- (`org-table-previous-field')' Re-align, move to previous field. ` (`org-table-next-row')' Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, still does NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table. `M-a (`org-table-beginning-of-field')' Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field. `M-e (`org-table-end-of-field')' Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field. Column and row editing ...................... `M- (`org-table-move-column-left')' `M- (`org-table-move-column-right')' Move the current column left/right. `M-S- (`org-table-delete-column')' Kill the current column. `M-S- (`org-table-insert-column')' Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position. `M- (`org-table-move-row-up')' `M- (`org-table-move-row-down')' Move the current row up/down. `M-S- (`org-table-kill-row')' Kill the current row or horizontal line. `M-S- (`org-table-insert-row')' Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is created below the current one. `C-c - (`org-table-insert-hline')' Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line is created above the current line. `C-c (`org-table-hline-and-move')' Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row below that line. `C-c ^ (`org-table-sort-lines')' Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). You can sort in normal or reverse order. You can also supply your own key extraction and comparison functions. When called with a prefix argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive. Regions ....... `C-c C-x M-w (`org-table-copy-region')' Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region, copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines. `C-c C-x C-w (`org-table-cut-region')' Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the "cut" operation. `C-c C-x C-y (`org-table-paste-rectangle')' Paste a rectangular region into a table. The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table, the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator lines. `M- (`org-table-wrap-region')' Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above. Calculations ............ `C-c + (`org-table-sum')' Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can be inserted with `C-y'. `S- (`org-table-copy-down')' When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it. Depending on the option `org-table-copy-increment', integer field values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not be incremented. Also, a `0' prefix argument temporarily disables the increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes (*note Conflicts::). Miscellaneous ............. `C-c ` (`org-table-edit-field')' Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that are not fully visible (*note Column width and alignment::). When called with a `C-u' prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be edited in place. When called with two `C-u' prefixes, make the editor window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table, or when you repeat this command with `C-u C-u C-c `'. `M-x org-table-import RET' Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data from a database, because these programs generally can write TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the separator. `C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')' Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org buffer, selecting the pasted text with `C-x C-x' and then using the `C-c |' command (see above under Creation and conversion). `M-x org-table-export RET' Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format used to export the file can be configured in the option `org-table-export-default-format'. You may also use properties `TABLE_EXPORT_FILE' and `TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT' to specify the file name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see *note Translator functions::, for a detailed description. If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your way on lines which you would like to start with `|', you can turn it off with (setq org-enable-table-editor nil) Then the only table command that still works is `C-c C-c' to do a manual re-align. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) To insert a vertical bar into a table field, use `\vert' or, inside a word `abc\vert{}def'.  File: org, Node: Column width and alignment, Next: Column groups, Prev: Built-in table editor, Up: Tables 3.2 Column width and alignment ============================== The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction of number-like versus non-number fields in the column. Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set the width of a column, one field anywhere in the column may contain just the string `' where `N' is an integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align will then set the width of this column to this value. |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| | | | | | <6> | | 1 | one | | 1 | one | | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two | | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> | | 4 | four | | 4 | four | |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string `=>'. Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden. To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field--a tool-tip window will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command `C-c `' (that is `C-c' followed by the grave accent). This will open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with `C-c C-c'. When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option `org-startup-align-all-tables' will realign all tables in a file upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option on a per-file basis with: #+STARTUP: align #+STARTUP: noalign If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns to the right and of string-rich columns to the left, you can use `', `'(1) or `' in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field width like this: `'. Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed automatically when exporting the document. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an effect when exporting to HTML.  File: org, Node: Column groups, Next: Orgtbl mode, Prev: Column width and alignment, Up: Tables 3.3 Column groups ================= When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the first field contains only `/'. The further fields can either contain `<' to indicate that this column should start a group, `>' to indicate the end of a group, or `<>' (no space between `<' and `>') to make a column a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be marked with vertical lines. Here is an example: | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | ~sqrt(n)~ | ~sqrt[4](N)~ | |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------| | / | < | | > | < | > | | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 | | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 | |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------| #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1))) It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after every vertical line you would like to have: | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| | / | < | | | < | |  File: org, Node: Orgtbl mode, Next: The spreadsheet, Prev: Column groups, Up: Tables 3.4 The Orgtbl minor mode ========================= If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode. The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with `M-x orgtbl-mode RET'. To turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, use (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl) Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to construct LaTeX tables with the underlying ease and power of Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see *note Tables in arbitrary syntax::.  File: org, Node: The spreadsheet, Next: Org-Plot, Prev: Orgtbl mode, Up: Tables 3.5 The spreadsheet =================== The table editor makes use of the Emacs `calc' package to implement spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept of a _column formula_ that will be applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the formula, moving these references by arrow keys * Menu: * References:: How to refer to another field or range * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column * Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc  File: org, Node: References, Next: Formula syntax for Calc, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.1 References ---------------- To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find out what the coordinates of a field are, press `C-c ?' in that field, or press `C-c }' to toggle the display of a grid. Field references ................ Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number combination like `B3', meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row. However, Org prefers(1) to use another, more general representation that looks like this: @ROW$COLUMN Column specifications can be absolute like `$1', `$2',...`$N', or relative to the current column (i.e., the column of the field which is being computed) like `$+1' or `$-2'. `$<' and `$>' are immutable references to the first and last column, respectively, and you can use `$>>>' to indicate the third column from the right. The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers `@1', `@2',...`@N', and row numbers relative to the current row like `@+3' or `@-1'. `@<' and `@>' are immutable references the first and last(2) row in the table, respectively. You may also specify the row relative to one of the hlines: `@I' refers to the first hline, `@II' to the second, etc. `@-I' refers to the first such line above the current line, `@+I' to the first such line below the current line. You can also write `@III+2' which is the second data line after the third hline in the table. `@0' and `$0' refer to the current row and column, respectively, i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is implied. Org's references with _unsigned_ numbers are fixed references in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two different fields, the same field will be referenced each time. Org's references with _signed_ numbers are floating references because the same reference operator can reference different fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula. Here are a few examples: @2$3 2nd row, 3rd column (same as `C2') $5 column 5 in the current row (same as `E&') @2 current column, row 2 @-1$-3 the field one row up, three columns to the left @-I$2 field just under hline above current row, column 2 @>$5 field in the last row, in column 5 Range references ................ You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field references connected by two dots `..'. If both fields are in the current row, you may simply use `$2..$7', but if at least one field is in a different row, you need to use the general `@row$column' format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with `@' in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples: $1..$3 first three fields in the current row $P..$Q range, using column names (see under Advanced) $<<<..$>> start in third column, continue to the last but one @2$1..@4$3 6 fields between these two fields (same as `A2..C4') @-1$-2..@-1 3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left @I..II between first and second hline, short for `@I..@II' Range references return a vector of values that can be fed into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options with the mode switches `E', `N' and examples *note Formula syntax for Calc::. Field coordinates in formulas ............................. One of the very first actions during evaluation of Calc formulas and Lisp formulas is to substitute `@#' and `$#' in the formula with the row or column number of the field where the current result will go to. The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are `org-table-current-dline' and `org-table-current-column'. Examples: `if(@# % 2, $#, string(""))' Insert column number on odd rows, set field to empty on even rows. `$2 = '(identity remote(FOO, @@#$1))' Copy text or values of each row of column 1 of the table named `FOO' into column 2 of the current table. `@3 = 2 * remote(FOO, @1$$#)' Insert the doubled value of each column of row 1 of the table named `FOO' into row 3 of the current table. For the second/third example, the table named `FOO' must have at least as many rows/columns as the current table. Note that this is inefficient(3) for large number of rows/columns. Named references ................ `$name' is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or constant. Constants are defined globally through the option `org-table-formula-constants', and locally (for the file) through a line like #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6 Also properties (*note Properties and columns::) can be used as constants in table formulas: for a property `:Xyz:' use the name `$PROP_Xyz', and the property will be searched in the current outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the `constants.el' package, it will also be used to resolve constants, including natural constants like `$h' for Planck's constant, and units like `$km' for kilometers(4). Column names and parameters can be specified in special table lines. These are described below, see *note Advanced features::. All names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and numbers. Remote references ................. You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table, either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF) where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a `#+NAME: Name' line before the table. It can also be the ID of an entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as described above for example `@3$3' or `$somename', valid in the referenced table. Indirection of NAME-OR-ID: When NAME-OR-ID has the format `@ROW$COLUMN' it will be substituted with the name or ID found in this field of the current table. For example `remote($1, @>$2)' => `remote(year_2013, @>$1)'. The format `B3' is not supported because it can not be distinguished from a plain table name or ID. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Org will understand references typed by the user as `B4', but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula for editing. You can customize this behavior using the option `org-table-use-standard-references'. (2) For backward compatibility you can also use special names like `$LR5' and `$LR12' to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table. However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents. Use `@>$' instead. (3) The computation time scales as O(N^2) because the table named `FOO' is parsed for each field to be read. (4) `constants.el' can supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, `SI' and `cgs'. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable `constants-unit-system'. You can use the `#+STARTUP' options `constSI' and `constcgs' to set this value for the current buffer.  File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Calc, Next: Formula syntax for Lisp, Prev: References, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.2 Formula syntax for Calc ----------------------------- A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs `Calc' package. Note that `calc' has the non-standard convention that `/' has lower precedence than `*', so that `a/b*c' is interpreted as `a/(b*c)'. Before evaluation by `calc-eval' (*note calc-eval: (calc)Calling Calc from Your Programs.), variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above. The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions like `vmean' and `vsum'. A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display format, however, has been changed to `(float 8)' to keep tables compact. The default settings can be configured using the option `org-calc-default-modes'. List of modes: `p20' Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits. `n3', `s3', `e2', `f4' Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of Calc passed back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as long as the Calc calculation precision is greater. `D', `R' Degree and radian angle modes of Calc. `F', `S' Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc. `T', `t', `U' Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, *note Durations and time values::. `E' If and how to consider empty fields. Without `E' empty fields in range references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp list contains only the non-empty fields. With `E' the empty fields are kept. For empty fields in ranges or empty field references the value `nan' (not a number) is used in Calc formulas and the empty string is used for Lisp formulas. Add `N' to use 0 instead for both formula types. For the value of a field the mode `N' has higher precedence than `E'. `N' Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the next section to see how this is essential for computations with Lisp formulas. In Calc formulas it is used only occasionally because there number strings are already interpreted as numbers without `N'. `L' Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section. Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a `printf' format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the formatting(1). A few examples: $1+$2 Sum of first and second field $1+$2;%.2f Same, format result to two decimals exp($2)+exp($1) Math functions can be used $0;%.1f Reformat current cell to 1 decimal ($3-32)*5/9 Degrees F -> C conversion $c/$1/$cm Hz -> cm conversion, using `constants.el' tan($1);Dp3s1 Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1 sin($1);Dp3%.1e Same, but use printf specifier for display taylor($3,x=7,2) Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations, (*note Logical Operations: (calc)Logical Operations.). For example `if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))' "teen" if age $1 is less than 20, else the Org table result field is set to empty with the empty string. `if("$1" == "nan" || "$2" == "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E f-1' Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input fields is empty the Org table result field is set to empty. `E' is required to not convert empty fields to 0. `f-1' is an optional Calc format string similar to `%.1f' but leaves empty results empty. `if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) == 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E' Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every field in the range that is empty is replaced by `nan' which lets `vmean' result in `nan'. Then `typeof == 12' detects the `nan' from `vmean' and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set is expected to never have missing values. `if("$1..$7" == "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))' Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in the range that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range are empty the mean value is not defined and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set can have a variable size. `vmean($1..$7); EN' To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty fields counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when incomplete sample sets should be padded with 0 to the full size. You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with `defmath' and use them in formula syntax for Calc. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The `printf' reformatting is limited in precision because the value passed to it is converted into an `integer' or `double'. The `integer' is limited in size by truncating the signed value to 32 bits. The `double' is limited in precision to 64 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.  File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Lisp, Next: Durations and time values, Prev: Formula syntax for Calc, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.3 Emacs Lisp forms as formulas ---------------------------------- It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with an apostrophe followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with `calc' formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the `N' mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the `L' flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like `"$3"'. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples--note how the `N' mode is used when we do computations in Lisp: `'(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))' Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1. `'(+ $1 $2);N' Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's `$1+$2'. `'(apply '+ '($1..$4));N' Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's `vsum($1..$4)'.  File: org, Node: Durations and time values, Next: Field and range formulas, Prev: Formula syntax for Lisp, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.4 Durations and time values ------------------------------- If you want to compute time values use the `T', `t', or `U' flag, either in Calc formulas or Elisp formulas: | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total | |---------+----------+----------| | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 | | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59 | | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 | #+TBLFM: @2$3=$1+$2;T::@3$3=$1+$2;U::@4$3=$1+$2;t Input duration values must be of the form `HH:MM[:SS]', where seconds are optional. With the `T' flag, computed durations will be displayed as `HH:MM:SS' (see the first formula above). With the `U' flag, seconds will be omitted so that the result will be only `HH:MM' (see second formula above). Zero-padding of the hours field will depend upon the value of the variable `org-table-duration-hour-zero-padding'. With the `t' flag, computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the option `org-table-duration-custom-format', which defaults to `'hours' and will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the third formula in the example above). Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.  File: org, Node: Field and range formulas, Next: Column formulas, Prev: Durations and time values, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.5 Field and range formulas ------------------------------ To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field, preceded by `:=', for example `:=vsum(@II..III)'. When you press or or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the current field will be replaced with the result. Formulas are stored in a special line starting with `#+TBLFM:' directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like `@3$4=$1+$2'. When inserting/deleting/swapping columns and rows with the appropriate commands, absolute references (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table borders (using `@<', `@>', `$<', `$>'), or at hlines using the `@I' notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing commands--then you must fix the equations yourself. Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following command `C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a formula with default taken from the `#+TBLFM:' line, applies it to the current field, and stores it. The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor (*note Editing and debugging formulas::) or edit the `#+TBLFM:' line directly. `$2=' Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org treats these formulas in a special way, see *note Column formulas::. `@3=' Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. `@>=' means the last row. `@1$2..@4$3=' Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row. `$name=' Named field, see *note Advanced features::.  File: org, Node: Column formulas, Next: Lookup functions, Prev: Field and range formulas, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.6 Column formulas --------------------- When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like `$3=', the same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator hlines with rows above and below, everything before the first such hline is considered part of the table _header_ and will not be modified by column formulas. Therefore a header is mandatory when you use column formulas and want to add hlines to group rows, like for example to separate a total row at the bottom from the summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use. To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the column, preceded by an equal sign, like `=$1+$2'. When you press or or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only `=', the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the `#+TBLFM:' line, column formulas will look like `$4=$1+$2'. The left-hand side of a column formula cannot be the name of column, it must be the numeric column reference or `$>'. Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following command: `C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default taken from the `#+TBLFM' line, applies it to the current field and stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., `C-5 C-c =') the command will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.  File: org, Node: Lookup functions, Next: Editing and debugging formulas, Prev: Column formulas, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.7 Lookup functions ---------------------- Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables. `(org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' Searches for the first element `S' in list `S-LIST' for which (PREDICATE VAL S) is `t'; returns the value from the corresponding position in list `R-LIST'. The default `PREDICATE' is `equal'. Note that the parameters `VAL' and `S' are passed to `PREDICATE' in the same order as the corresponding parameters are in the call to `org-lookup-first', where `VAL' precedes `S-LIST'. If `R-LIST' is `nil', the matching element `S' of `S-LIST' is returned. `(org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' Similar to `org-lookup-first' above, but searches for the last element for which `PREDICATE' is `t'. `(org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' Similar to `org-lookup-first', but searches for all elements for which `PREDICATE' is `t', and returns all corresponding values. This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built when this function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions. If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the `E' mode for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty fields will not be included in `S-LIST' and/or `R-LIST' which can, for example, result in an incorrect mapping from an element of `S-LIST' to the corresponding element of `R-LIST'. These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, count matching cells, rank results, group data etc. For practical examples see this tutorial on Worg (http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html).  File: org, Node: Editing and debugging formulas, Next: Updating the table, Prev: Lookup functions, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.8 Editing and debugging formulas ------------------------------------ You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org converts references to the standard format (like `B3' or `D&') if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like `@3$2' or `$4'), configure the option `org-table-use-standard-references'. `C-c = or C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the minibuffer. See *note Column formulas::, and *note Field and range formulas::. `C-u C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' Re-insert the active formula (either a field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the minibuffer is that you can use the command `C-c ?'. `C-c ? (`org-table-field-info')' While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s) referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula. `C-c }' Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays (`org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays'). These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can force it with `C-c C-c'. `C-c {' Toggle the formula debugger on and off (`org-table-toggle-formula-debugger'). See below. `C-c ' (`org-table-edit-formulas')' Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it. While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit, remove and add formulas, and use the following commands: `C-c C-c or C-x C-s (`org-table-fedit-finish')' Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With `C-u' prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table. `C-c C-q (`org-table-fedit-abort')' Exit the formula editor without installing changes. `C-c C-r (`org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type')' Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like `B3') and internal (like `@3$2'). ` (`org-table-fedit-lisp-indent')' Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules. Another collapses the formula back again. In the open formula, re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode. `M- (`lisp-complete-symbol')' Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.(1) `S-///' Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is `B3' and you press `S-', it will become `C3'. This also works for relative references and for hline references. `M-S- (`org-table-fedit-line-up')' `M-S- (`org-table-fedit-line-down')' Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and down. `M- (`org-table-fedit-scroll-down')' `M- (`org-table-fedit-scroll-up')' Scroll the window displaying the table. `C-c }' Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off. Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with the field, because that is stored in a different line (the `#+TBLFM' line)--during the next recalculation the field will be filled again. To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when prompted for the formula, or to edit the `#+TBLFM' line. You may edit the `#+TBLFM' directly and re-apply the changed equations with `C-c C-c' in that line or with the normal recalculation commands in the table. Using multiple #+TBLFM lines ............................ You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you switch the formula. Place multiple `#+TBLFM' lines right after the table, and then press `C-c C-c' on the formula to apply. Here is an example: | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | | | 2 | | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 Pressing `C-c C-c' in the line of `#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2' yields: | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | 2 | | 2 | 4 | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 Note: If you recalculate this table (with `C-u C-c *', for example), you will get the following result of applying only the first `#+TBLFM' line. | x | y | |---+---| | 1 | 1 | | 2 | 2 | #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 Debugging formulas .................. When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content becomes the string `#ERROR'. If you would like see what is going on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug, turn on formula debugging in the `Tbl' menu and repeat the calculation, for example by pressing `C-u C-u C-c = ' in a field. Detailed information will be displayed. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Many desktops intercept `M-' to switch windows. Use `C-M-i' or ` ' instead for completion (*note Completion::).  File: org, Node: Updating the table, Next: Advanced features, Prev: Editing and debugging formulas, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.9 Updating the table ------------------------ Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be triggered by a command. See *note Advanced features::, for a way to make recalculation at least semi-automatic. In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the following commands: `C-c * (`org-table-recalculate')' Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row. `C-u C-c *' `C-u C-c C-c' Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header. `C-u C-u C-c * or C-u C-u C-c C-c (`org-table-iterate')' Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur. This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other fields that are computed later in the calculation sequence. `M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables RET' Recompute all tables in the current buffer. `M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables RET' Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table dependencies.  File: org, Node: Advanced features, Prev: Updating the table, Up: The spreadsheet 3.5.10 Advanced features ------------------------ If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you want to be able to assign names(1) to fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters. `C-# (`org-table-rotate-recalc-marks')' Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states ` ', `#', `*', `!', `$'. When there is an active region, change all marks in the region. Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and makes use of these features: |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | | | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 | | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 | | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| | | Average | | | | 25.0 | | | ^ | | | | | at | | | $ | max=50 | | | | | | |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@-II..@-I);%.1f Important: please note that for these special tables, recalculating the table with `C-u C-c *' will only affect rows that are marked `#' or `*', and fields that have a formula assigned to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with empty first field. The marking characters have the following meaning: `!' The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may refer to a column as `$Tot' instead of `$6'. `^' This row defines names for the fields _above_ the row. With such a definition, any formula in the table may use `$m1' to refer to the value `10'. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it will be stored as `$name=...'. `_' Similar to `^', but defines names for the fields in the row _below_. `$' Fields in this row can define _parameters_ for formulas. For example, if a field in a `$' row contains `max=50', then formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using `$max'. Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on a per-table basis. `#' Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing or or `S-' in this row. Also, this row is selected for a global recalculation with `C-u C-c *'. Unmarked lines will be left alone by this command. `*' Selects this line for global recalculation with `C-u C-c *', but not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic recalculation slows down editing too much. ` ' Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with `C-u C-c *'. All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with `#' or `*'. `/' Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing `' markers or column group markers. Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the fantastic `calc.el' package, here is a table that computes the Taylor series of degree `n' at location `x' for a couple of functions. |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | | Func | n | x | Result | |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x | | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 | | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 | | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 | | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 | | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 | |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3 ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Such names must start by an alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.  File: org, Node: Org-Plot, Prev: The spreadsheet, Up: Tables 3.6 Org-Plot ============ Org-Plot can produce graphs of information stored in org tables, either graphically or in ASCII-art. Graphical plots using `Gnuplot' ------------------------------- Org-Plot produces 2D and 3D graphs using `Gnuplot' `http://www.gnuplot.info/' and `gnuplot-mode' `http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode'. To see this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, then call `C-c " g' or `M-x org-plot/gnuplot ' on the following table. #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]" | Sede | Max cites | H-index | |-----------+-----------+---------| | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 | | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 | | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 | | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 | | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 | Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels. Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can be exercised through the `#+PLOT:' lines preceding a table. See below for a complete list of Org-plot options. The `#+PLOT:' lines are optional. For more information and examples see the Org-plot tutorial at `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html'. Plot Options ............ `set' Specify any `gnuplot' option to be set when graphing. `title' Specify the title of the plot. `ind' Specify which column of the table to use as the `x' axis. `deps' Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses and separated by spaces for example `dep:(3 4)' to graph the third and fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the `ind' column). `type' Specify whether the plot will be `2d', `3d', or `grid'. `with' Specify a `with' option to be inserted for every col being plotted (e.g., `lines', `points', `boxes', `impulses', etc...). Defaults to `lines'. `file' If you want to plot to a file, specify `"PATH/TO/DESIRED/OUTPUT-FILE"'. `labels' List of labels to be used for the `deps' (defaults to the column headers if they exist). `line' Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script. `map' When plotting `3d' or `grid' types, set this to `t' to graph a flat mapping rather than a `3d' slope. `timefmt' Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot. Defaults to `%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'. `script' If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every instance of `$datafile' in the specified script will be replaced with the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of the data file. ASCII bar plots --------------- While the cursor is on a column, typing `C-c " a' or `M-x orgtbl-ascii-plot ' create a new column containing an ASCII-art bars plot. The plot is implemented through a regular column formula. When the source column changes, the bar plot may be updated by refreshing the table, for example typing `C-u C-c *'. | Sede | Max cites | | |---------------+-----------+--------------| | Chile | 257.72 | WWWWWWWWWWWW | | Leeds | 165.77 | WWWWWWWh | | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | WWW; | | Stockholm | 134.19 | WWWWWW: | | Morelia | 257.56 | WWWWWWWWWWWH | | Rochefourchat | 0.00 | | #+TBLFM: $3='(orgtbl-ascii-draw $2 0.0 257.72 12) The formula is an elisp call: (orgtbl-ascii-draw COLUMN MIN MAX WIDTH) `COLUMN' is a reference to the source column. `MIN MAX' are the minimal and maximal values displayed. Sources values outside this range are displayed as `too small' or `too large'. `WIDTH' is the width in characters of the bar-plot. It defaults to `12'.  File: org, Node: Hyperlinks, Next: TODO items, Prev: Tables, Up: Top 4 Hyperlinks ************ Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more. * Menu: * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file * External links:: URL-like links to the world * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links * Search options:: Linking to a specific location * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough  File: org, Node: Link format, Next: Internal links, Up: Hyperlinks 4.1 Link format =============== Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this: [[link][description]] or alternatively [[link]] Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org will change the display so that `description' is displayed instead of `[[link][description]]' and `link' is displayed instead of `[[link]]'. Links will be highlighted in the face `org-link', which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the `link' part (if there is no description) or the `description' part. To edit also the invisible `link' part, use `C-c C-l' with the cursor on the link. If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the displayed text and press , you will remove the (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the internal structure of all links, use the menu entry `Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links'.  File: org, Node: Internal links, Next: External links, Prev: Link format, Up: Hyperlinks 4.2 Internal links ================== If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the current file. The most important case is a link like `[[#my-custom-id]]' which will link to the entry with the `CUSTOM_ID' property `my-custom-id'. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique in a file. Links such as `[[My Target]]' or `[[My Target][Find my target]]' lead to a text search in the current file. The link can be followed with `C-c C-o' when the cursor is on the link, or with a mouse click (*note Handling links::). Links to custom IDs will point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is a dedicated target: the same string in double angular brackets, like `<>'. If no dedicated target exists, the link will then try to match the exact name of an element within the buffer. Naming is done with the `#+NAME' keyword, which has to be put in the line before the element it refers to, as in the following example #+NAME: My Target | a | table | |----+------------| | of | four cells | If none of the above succeeds, Org will search for a headline that is exactly the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags(1). During export, internal links will be used to mark objects and assign them a number. Marked objects will then be referenced by links pointing to them. In particular, links without a description will appear as the number assigned to the marked object(2). In the following excerpt from an Org buffer - one item - <>another item Here we refer to item [[target]]. The last sentence will appear as `Here we refer to item 2' when exported. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the link text. In the above example the search would be for `my target'. Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can return to the previous position with `C-c &'. Using this command several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded earlier. * Menu: * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press `M-'. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as completions. (2) When targeting a `#+NAME' keyword, `#+CAPTION' keyword is mandatory in order to get proper numbering (*note Images and tables::).  File: org, Node: Radio targets, Up: Internal links 4.2.1 Radio targets ------------------- Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target `<<>>' causes each occurrence of `my target' in normal text to become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To update the target list during editing, press `C-c C-c' with the cursor on or at a target.  File: org, Node: External links, Next: Handling links, Prev: Internal links, Up: Hyperlinks 4.3 External links ================== Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type. http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik on the web doi:10.1000/182 DOI for an electronic resource file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg file, absolute path /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg same as above file:papers/last.pdf file, relative path ./papers/last.pdf same as above file:/ssh:myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf file, path on remote machine /ssh:myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf same as above file:sometextfile::NNN file, jump to line number file:projects.org another Org file file:projects.org::some words text search in Org file(1) file:projects.org::*task title heading search in Org file(2) docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN open in doc-view mode at page id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 Link to heading by ID news:comp.emacs Usenet link mailto:adent@galaxy.net Mail link mhe:folder MH-E folder link mhe:folder#id MH-E message link rmail:folder RMAIL folder link rmail:folder#id RMAIL message link gnus:group Gnus group link gnus:group#id Gnus article link bbdb:R.*Stallman BBDB link (with regexp) irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob IRC link info:org#External links Info node or index link shell:ls *.org A shell command elisp:org-agenda Interactive Elisp command elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") Elisp form to evaluate On top of these built-in link types, some are available through the `contrib/' directory (*note Installation::). For example, these links to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load the corresponding libraries from the `contrib/' directory: vm:folder VM folder link vm:folder#id VM message link vm://myself@some.where.org/folder#id VM on remote machine vm-imap:account:folder VM IMAP folder link vm-imap:account:folder#id VM IMAP message link wl:folder WANDERLUST folder link wl:folder#id WANDERLUST message link For customizing Org to add new link types *note Adding hyperlink types::. A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (*note Link format::), for example: [[https://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]] If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML export (*note HTML export::) will inline the image as a clickable button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an image, that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file. Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in `bbdb:Richard Stallman'), or if you need to remove ambiguities about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of the option `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline'. If its value is `nil', then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is `t', then only the exact headline will be matched, ignoring spaces and cookies. If the value is `query-to-create', then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user will be queried to create it. (2) Headline searches always match the exact headline, ignoring spaces and cookies. If the headline is not found and the value of the option `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline' is `query-to-create', then the user will be queried to create it.  File: org, Node: Handling links, Next: Using links outside Org, Prev: External links, Up: Hyperlinks 4.4 Handling links ================== Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link. `C-c l (`org-store-link')' Store a link to the current location. This is a _global_ command (you must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current buffer: Org mode buffers For Org files, if there is a `<>' at the cursor, the link points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also be the description(1). If the headline has a `CUSTOM_ID' property, a link to this custom ID will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of `org-id-link-to-org-use-id'), a globally unique `ID' property will be created and/or used to construct a link(2). So using this command in Org buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one to use. Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is constructed from the author and the subject. Web browsers: Eww, W3 and W3M Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description. Contacts: BBDB Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry. Chat: IRC For IRC links, if you set the option `org-irc-link-to-logs' to `t', a `file:/' style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current conversation is created. Otherwise an `irc:/' style link to the user/channel/server under the point will be stored. Other files For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string (*note Search options::) pointing to the contents of the current line. If there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string and to do the search for particular file types--see *note Custom searches::. The key binding `C-c l' is only a suggestion--see *note Installation::. Agenda view When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the entry referenced by the current line. `C-c C-l (`org-insert-link')' Insert a link(3). This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted into the buffer(4), along with a descriptive text. If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text becomes the default description. Inserting stored links All links stored during the current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access them with and (or `M-p/n'). Completion support Completion with will help you to insert valid link prefixes like `https:', including the prefixes defined through link abbreviations (*note Link abbreviations::). If you press after inserting only the PREFIX, Org will offer specific completion support for some link types(5) For example, if you type `file ', file name completion (alternative access: `C-u C-c C-l', see below) will be offered, and after `bbdb ' you can complete contact names. `C-u C-c C-l' When `C-c C-l' is called with a `C-u' prefix argument, a link to a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative to the current directory using `../'. Otherwise an absolute path is used, if possible with `~/' for your home directory. You can force an absolute path with two `C-u' prefixes. `C-c C-l (with cursor on existing link)' When the cursor is on an existing link, `C-c C-l' allows you to edit the link and description parts of the link. `C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')' Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using `browse-url-at-point'), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search. When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in `file:' links with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files. Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option `org-file-apps'. If you want to override the default application and visit the file with Emacs, use a `C-u' prefix. If you want to avoid opening in Emacs, use a `C-u C-u' prefix. If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for following links, customize `org-link-frame-setup'. `' When `org-return-follows-link' is set, `' will also follow the link at point. `mouse-2' `mouse-1' On links, `mouse-1' and `mouse-2' will open the link just as `C-c C-o' would. `mouse-3' Like `mouse-2', but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and internal links to be displayed in another window(6). `C-c C-x C-v (`org-toggle-inline-images')' Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be displayed at startup by configuring the variable `org-startup-with-inline-images'(7). `C-c % (`org-mark-ring-push')' Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically. `C-c & (`org-mark-ring-goto')' Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the commands following internal links, and by `C-c %'. Using this command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of previously recorded positions. `C-c C-x C-n (`org-next-link')' `C-c C-x C-p (`org-previous-link')' Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also to `C-n' and `C-p' (add-hook 'org-load-hook (lambda () (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link) (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link))) ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be removed from the link and result in a wrong link--you should avoid putting timestamp in the headline. (2) The library `org-id.el' must first be loaded, either through `org-customize' by enabling `org-id' in `org-modules', or by adding `(require 'org-id)' in your Emacs init file. (3) Note that you don't have to use this command to insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional descriptive text. (4) After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a triple `C-u' prefix argument to `C-c C-l', or configure the option `org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion'. (5) This works if a completion function is defined in the `:complete' property of a link in `org-link-parameters'. (6) See the option `org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer' (7) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `inlineimages' and `noinlineimages'  File: org, Node: Using links outside Org, Next: Link abbreviations, Prev: Handling links, Up: Hyperlinks 4.5 Using links outside Org =========================== You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys yourself): (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global) (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)  File: org, Node: Link abbreviations, Next: Search options, Prev: Using links outside Org, Up: Hyperlinks 4.6 Link abbreviations ====================== Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An abbreviated link looks like this [[linkword:tag][description]] where the tag is optional. The linkword must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by letters, numbers, `-', and `_'. Abbreviations are resolved according to the information in the variable `org-link-abbrev-alist' that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example: (setq org-link-abbrev-alist '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=") ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h") ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=") ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s") ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1") ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST"))) If the replacement text contains the string `%s', it will be replaced with the tag. Using `%h' instead of `%s' will url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode the URL parameter.) Using `%(my-function)' will pass the tag to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string. If the replacement text doesn't contain any specifier, the tag will simply be appended in order to create the link. Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link. With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with `[[bugzilla:129]]', search the web for `OrgMode' with `[[google:OrgMode]]', show the map location of the Free Software Foundation `[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]' or of Carsten office `[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]' and find out what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with `[[ads:Dominik,C]]'. If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you can define them in the file with #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id= #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s In-buffer completion (*note Completion::) can be used after `[' to complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function that implements special (e.g., completion) support for inserting such a link with `C-c C-l'. Such a function should not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix. You can add a completion function to a link like this: (org-link-set-parameters ``type'' :complete #'some-function)  File: org, Node: Search options, Next: Custom searches, Prev: Link abbreviations, Up: Hyperlinks 4.7 Search options in file links ================================ File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a line number or a search option after a double(1) colon. For example, when the command `C-c l' creates a link (*note Handling links::) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search string that can be used to find this line back later when following the link with `C-c C-o'. Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file link, together with an explanation: [[file:~/code/main.c::255]] [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]] [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]] [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]] [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]] `255' Jump to line 255. `My Target' Search for a link target `<>', or do a text search for `my target', similar to the search in internal links, see *note Internal links::. In HTML export (*note HTML export::), such a file link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in the linked file. `*My Target' In an Org file, restrict search to headlines. `#my-custom-id' Link to a heading with a `CUSTOM_ID' property `/regexp/' Do a regular expression search for `regexp'. This uses the Emacs command `occur' to list all matches in a separate window. If the target file is in Org mode, `org-occur' is used to create a sparse tree with the matches. As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used to search the current file. For example, `[[file:::find me]]' does a search for `find me' in the current file, just as `[[find me]]' would. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) For backward compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.  File: org, Node: Custom searches, Prev: Search options, Up: Hyperlinks 4.8 Custom Searches =================== The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like `year="1993"' which would not result in good search strings, because the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the citation key. If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search for the string in the file. Using `add-hook', these functions need to be added to the hook variables `org-create-file-search-functions' and `org-execute-file-search-functions'. See the docstring for these variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism for BibTeX database files, and you can use the corresponding code as an implementation example. See the file `org-bibtex.el'.  File: org, Node: TODO items, Next: Tags, Prev: Hyperlinks, Up: Top 5 TODO items ************ Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents(1). Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way, information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO item emerged is always present. Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do. * Menu: * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Of course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items, but this is not required.  File: org, Node: TODO basics, Next: TODO extensions, Up: TODO items 5.1 Basic TODO functionality ============================ Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word `TODO', for example: *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune The most important commands to work with TODO entries are: `C-c C-t (`org-todo')' Rotate the TODO state of the current item among ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --. '--------------------------------' If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see *note Fast access to TODO states::), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through the fast selection interface; this is the default behavior when `org-use-fast-todo-selection' is non-`nil'. The same rotation can also be done "remotely" from agenda buffers with the `t' command key (*note Agenda commands::). `C-u C-c C-t' When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific keyword using completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO states with no prompt. When `org-use-fast-todo-selection' is set to `prefix', use the fast selection interface. `S- / S-' Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (*note TODO extensions::). See also *note Conflicts::, for a discussion of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. See also the variable `org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change'. `C-c / t (`org-show-todo-tree')' View TODO items in a _sparse tree_ (*note Sparse trees::). Folds the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using `C-c / T'), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like `KWD1|KWD2|...' to list entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the option `org-todo-keywords'. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done. `C-c a t (`org-todo-list')' Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states) from all agenda files (*note Agenda views::) into a single buffer. The new buffer will be in `agenda-mode', which provides commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (*note Agenda commands::). *Note Global TODO list::, for more information. `S-M- (`org-insert-todo-heading')' Insert a new TODO entry below the current one. Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the option `org-todo-state-tags-triggers' for details.  File: org, Node: TODO extensions, Next: Progress logging, Prev: TODO basics, Up: TODO items 5.2 Extended use of TODO keywords ================================= By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways with _TODO keywords_ (stored in `org-todo-keywords'). With special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different files. Note that tags are another way to classify headlines in general and TODO items in particular (*note Tags::). * Menu: * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others  File: org, Node: Workflow states, Next: TODO types, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.1 TODO keywords as workflow states -------------------------------------- You can use TODO keywords to indicate different _sequential_ states in the process of working on an item, for example(1): (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED"))) The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that _need action_) from the DONE states (which need _no further action_). If you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE state. With this setup, the command `C-c C-t' will cycle an entry from TODO to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For example `C-3 C-c C-t' will change the state immediately to VERIFY. Or you can use `S-' to go backward through the sequence. If you define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion (*note Completion::) or even a special one-key selection scheme (*note Fast access to TODO states::) to insert these words into the buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see *note Tracking TODO state changes::, for more information. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Changing this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a buffer.  File: org, Node: TODO types, Next: Multiple sets in one file, Prev: Workflow states, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.2 TODO keywords as types ---------------------------- The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different _types_ of action items. For example, you might want to indicate that items are for "work" or "home". Or, when you work with several people on a single project, you might want to assign action items directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would be set up like this: (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE"))) In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting the workings of the command `C-c C-t'(1). When used several times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some time and execute `C-c C-t' again, it will switch from any name directly to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix to `C-c / t'. For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you would use `C-3 C-c / t'. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument as well when creating the global TODO list: `C-3 C-c a t'. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) This is also true for the `t' command in the agenda buffers.  File: org, Node: Multiple sets in one file, Next: Fast access to TODO states, Prev: TODO types, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.3 Multiple keyword sets in one file --------------------------------------- Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic `TODO'/`DONE', but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look like this: (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE") (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED") (sequence "|" "CANCELED"))) The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup, `C-c C-t' only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from `DONE' to (nothing) to `TODO', and from `FIXED' to (nothing) to `REPORT'. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands: `C-u C-u C-c C-t' `C-S-' `C-S-' These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example, `C-u C-u C-c C-t' or `C-S-' would jump from `TODO' or `DONE' to `REPORT', and any of the words in the second row to `CANCELED'. Note that the `C-S-' key binding conflict with `shift-selection-mode' (*note Conflicts::). `S-' `S-' `S-' and `S-' and walk through _all_ keywords from all sets, so for example `S-' would switch from `DONE' to `REPORT' in the example above. See also *note Conflicts::, for a discussion of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'.  File: org, Node: Fast access to TODO states, Next: Per-file keywords, Prev: Multiple sets in one file, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.4 Fast access to TODO states -------------------------------- If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after each keyword, in parentheses(1). For example: (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)") (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)") (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)"))) If you then press `C-c C-t' followed by the selection key, the entry will be switched to this state. `SPC' can be used to remove any TODO keyword from an entry.(2) ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) All characters are allowed except `@^!', which have a special meaning here. (2) Check also the option `org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo', it allows you to change the TODO state through the tags interface (*note Setting tags::), in case you like to mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with unique keys across both sets of keywords.  File: org, Node: Per-file keywords, Next: Faces for TODO keywords, Prev: Fast access to TODO states, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.5 Setting up keywords for individual files ---------------------------------------------- It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you need one of the following lines anywhere in the file: #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED (you may also write `#+SEQ_TODO' to be explicit about the interpretation, but it means the same as `#+TODO'), or #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE A setup for using several sets in parallel would be: #+TODO: TODO | DONE #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED #+TODO: | CANCELED To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type `#+' into the buffer and then use `M-' completion. Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the line to make the changes known to Org mode(1). ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Org mode parses these lines only when Org mode is activated after visiting a file. `C-c C-c' with the cursor in a line starting with `#+' is simply restarting Org mode for the current buffer.  File: org, Node: Faces for TODO keywords, Next: TODO dependencies, Prev: Per-file keywords, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.6 Faces for TODO keywords ----------------------------- Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: `org-todo' for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and `org-done' for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use special faces for some of them. This can be done using the option `org-todo-keyword-faces'. For example: (setq org-todo-keyword-faces '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow") ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold)))) While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED _should_ work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The option `org-faces-easy-properties' determines if that color is interpreted as a foreground or a background color.  File: org, Node: TODO dependencies, Prev: Faces for TODO keywords, Up: TODO extensions 5.2.7 TODO dependencies ----------------------- The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize the option `org-enforce-todo-dependencies', Org will block entries from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE. Furthermore, if an entry has a property `ORDERED', each of its children will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an example: * TODO Blocked until (two) is done ** DONE one ** TODO two * Parent :PROPERTIES: :ORDERED: t :END: ** TODO a ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a) ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b) You can ensure an entry is never blocked by using the `NOBLOCKING' property: * This entry is never blocked :PROPERTIES: :NOBLOCKING: t :END: `C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')' Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the current entry. A property is used for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the option `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'. `C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t' Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking. If you set the option `org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks', TODO entries that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed font or even made invisible in agenda views (*note Agenda views::). You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::). If you set the option `org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies', an entry that has unchecked checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE. If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed module `org-depend.el'.  File: org, Node: Progress logging, Next: Priorities, Prev: TODO extensions, Up: TODO items 5.3 Progress logging ==================== Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For information on how to clock working time for a task, see *note Clocking work time::. * Menu: * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?  File: org, Node: Closing items, Next: Tracking TODO state changes, Up: Progress logging 5.3.1 Closing items ------------------- The most basic logging is to keep track of _when_ a certain TODO item was finished. This is achieved with(1) (setq org-log-done 'time) Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any of the DONE states, a line `CLOSED: [timestamp]' will be inserted just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you turn the entry back to a non-TODO state (by pressing for example), that line will also be removed, unless you set `org-closed-keep-when-no-todo' to non-`nil'. If you want to record a note along with the timestamp, use(2) (setq org-log-done 'note) You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below the entry with a `Closing Note' heading. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: logdone' (2) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: lognotedone'.  File: org, Node: Tracking TODO state changes, Next: Tracking your habits, Prev: Closing items, Up: Progress logging 5.3.2 Tracking TODO state changes --------------------------------- When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (*note Workflow states::), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the headline as an itemized list, newest first(1). When taking a lot of notes, you might want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (*note Drawers::). Customize `org-log-into-drawer' to get this behavior--the recommended drawer for this is called `LOGBOOK'(2). You can also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a `LOG_INTO_DRAWER' property. Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by adding special markers `!' (for a timestamp) or `@' (for a note with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting (setq org-todo-keywords '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@)"))) To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with `@', just type `C-c C-c' to enter a blank note when prompted. You not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to DONE(3), and that a note is recorded when switching to WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the `!' after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when leaving the WAIT state, if and only if the target state does not configure logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the `/!' in the WAIT setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging configured. You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local to a buffer: #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@) In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty LOGGING property resets all logging settings to `nil'. You may then turn on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like `lognotedone' or `logrepeat', as well as adding state specific settings like `TODO(!)'. For example * TODO Log each state with only a time :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!) :END: * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: WAIT(@) logrepeat :END: * TODO No logging at all :PROPERTIES: :LOGGING: nil :END: ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See the option `org-log-states-order-reversed' (2) Note that the `LOGBOOK' drawer is unfolded when pressing in the agenda to show an entry--use to keep it folded here (3) It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps when you are using both `org-log-done' and state change logging. However, it will never prompt for two notes--if you have configured both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel the `Closing Note'.  File: org, Node: Tracking your habits, Prev: Tracking TODO state changes, Up: Progress logging 5.3.3 Tracking your habits -------------------------- Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs, called "habits". A habit has the following properties: 1. You have enabled the `habits' module by customizing `org-modules'. 2. The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state. 3. The property `STYLE' is set to the value `habit'. 4. The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a `.+' style repeat interval. A `++' style may be appropriate for habits with time constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a `+' style for an unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports. 5. The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the syntax `.+2d/3d', which says that you want to do the task at least every three days, but at most every two days. 6. You must also have state logging for the `DONE' state enabled (*note Tracking TODO state changes::), in order for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless. To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an actual habit with some history: ** TODO Shave SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d> :PROPERTIES: :STYLE: habit :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36] :END: - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed] - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat] What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the `SCHEDULED' date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17, after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19, after four days have elapsed. What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are: `Blue' If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day. `Green' If the task could have been done on that day. `Yellow' If the task was going to be overdue the next day. `Red' If the task was overdue on that day. In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where the current day falls in the graph. There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way habits are displayed in the agenda. `org-habit-graph-column' The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits' titles brief and to the point. `org-habit-preceding-days' The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs. `org-habit-following-days' The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs. `org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today' If non-`nil', only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by default. Lastly, pressing `K' in the agenda buffer will cause habits to temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press `K' again to bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.  File: org, Node: Priorities, Next: Breaking down tasks, Prev: Progress logging, Up: TODO items 5.4 Priorities ============== If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by placing a _priority cookie_ into the headline of a TODO item, like this *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune By default, Org mode supports three priorities: `A', `B', and `C'. `A' is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is treated just like priority `B'. Priorities make a difference only for sorting in the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::); outside the agenda, they have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with special faces by customizing `org-priority-faces'. Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO items. `C-c ,' Set the priority of the current headline (`org-priority'). The command prompts for a priority character `A', `B' or `C'. When you press instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline. The priorities can also be changed "remotely" from the agenda buffer with the `,' command (*note Agenda commands::). `S- (`org-priority-up')' `S- (`org-priority-down')' Increase/decrease priority of current headline(1). Note that these keys are also used to modify timestamps (*note Creating timestamps::). See also *note Conflicts::, for a discussion of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the options `org-highest-priority', `org-lowest-priority', and `org-default-priority'. For an individual buffer, you may set these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest priority): #+PRIORITIES: A C B ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See also the option `org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'.  File: org, Node: Breaking down tasks, Next: Checkboxes, Prev: Priorities, Up: TODO items 5.5 Breaking tasks down into subtasks ===================================== It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item, with detailed subtasks on the tree(1). To keep the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert either `[/]' or `[%]' anywhere in the headline. These cookies will be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing `C-c C-c' on the cookie. For example: * Organize Party [33%] ** TODO Call people [1/2] *** TODO Peter *** DONE Sarah ** TODO Buy food ** DONE Talk to neighbor If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property `COOKIE_DATA' to either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue. If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the subtree (not just direct children), configure `org-hierarchical-todo-statistics'. To do this for a single subtree, include the word `recursive' into the value of the `COOKIE_DATA' property. * Parent capturing statistics [2/20] :PROPERTIES: :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive :END: If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when all children are done, you can use the following setup: (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done) "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise." (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO")))) (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo) Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a large number of subtasks (*note Checkboxes::). ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) To keep subtasks out of the global TODO list, see the `org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels'.  File: org, Node: Checkboxes, Prev: Breaking down tasks, Up: TODO items 5.6 Checkboxes ============== Every item in a plain list(1) (*note Plain lists::) can be made into a checkbox by starting it with the string `[ ]'. This feature is similar to TODO items (*note TODO items::), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included in the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use `C-c C-c', or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's `org-mouse.el'). Here is an example of a checkbox list. * TODO Organize party [2/4] - [-] call people [1/3] - [ ] Peter - [X] Sarah - [ ] Sam - [X] order food - [ ] think about what music to play - [X] talk to the neighbors Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are checked. The `[2/4]' and `[1/3]' in the first and second line are cookies indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off, and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie appears(2). You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either `[/]' or `[%]'. With `[/]' you get an `n out of m' result, as in the examples above. With `[%]' you get information about the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be `[50%]' and `[33%]', respectively). In a headline, a cookie can count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it will display whatever was changed last. Set the property `COOKIE_DATA' to either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue. If the current outline node has an `ORDERED' property, checkboxes must be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it. The following commands work with checkboxes: `C-c C-c (`org-toggle-checkbox')' Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current one(3). With a double prefix argument, set it to `[-]', which is considered to be an intermediate state. `C-c C-x C-b (`org-toggle-checkbox')' Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With double prefix argument, set it to `[-]', which is considered to be an intermediate state. - If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region. - If the cursor is in a headline, toggle the state of the first checkbox in the region between this headline and the next--so _not_ the entire subtree--and propagate this new state to all other checkboxes in the same area. - If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point. `M-S- (`org-insert-todo-heading')' Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item (*note Plain lists::). `C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')' Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, customize `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'. `C-c # (`org-update-statistics-cookies')' Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with a `C-u' prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with `C-c C-c' and make new ones with `M-S-'. TODO statistics cookies update when changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things back into sync. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) With the exception of description lists. But you can allow it by modifying `org-list-automatic-rules' accordingly. (2) Set the option `org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics' if you want such cookies to count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct children. (3) `C-u C-c C-c' before the _first_ bullet in a list with no checkbox will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.  File: org, Node: Tags, Next: Properties and columns, Prev: TODO items, Up: Top 6 Tags ****** An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating information is to assign tags to headlines. Org mode has extensive support for tags. Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, `_', and `@'. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g., `:work:'. Several tags can be specified, as in `:work:urgent:'. Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline. You may specify special faces for specific tags using the option `org-tag-faces', in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords (*note Faces for TODO keywords::). * Menu: * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline * Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags  File: org, Node: Tag inheritance, Next: Setting tags, Up: Tags 6.1 Tag inheritance =================== Tags make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as well. For example, in the list * Meeting with the French group :work: ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes: *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action: the final heading will have the tags `:work:', `:boss:', `:notes:', and `:action:' even though the final heading is not explicitly marked with all those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this(1): #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret: To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use `org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance'. To turn it off entirely, use `org-use-tag-inheritance'. When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match as well(2). The list of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags match in a subtree, configure `org-tags-match-list-sublevels' (not recommended). Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a tag, either in the `tags' or `tags-todo' agenda types. In other agenda types, `org-use-tag-inheritance' has no effect. Still, you may want to have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works fine, with inherited tags. Set `org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance' to control this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting this to `nil' can really speed up agenda generation. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing `C-c C-c' activates any changes in the line. (2) This is only true if the search does not involve more complex tests including properties (*note Property searches::).  File: org, Node: Setting tags, Next: Tag hierarchy, Prev: Tag inheritance, Up: Tags 6.2 Setting tags ================ Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline. After a colon, `M-' offers completion on tags. There is also a special command for inserting tags: `C-c C-q (`org-set-tags-command')' Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see below. After pressing , the tags will be inserted and aligned to `org-tags-column'. When called with a `C-u' prefix, all tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion, demotion, and TODO state changes (*note TODO basics::). `C-c C-c (`org-set-tags-command')' When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as `C-c C-q'. Org supports tag insertion based on a _list of tags_. By default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list of tags with the variable `org-tag-alist'. Finally you can set the default tags for a given file with lines like #+TAGS: @work @home @tennisclub #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the variable `org-tag-alist', but would like to use a dynamic tag list in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file: #+TAGS: If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file, in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then you may specify a list of tags with the variable `org-tag-persistent-alist'. You may turn this off on a per-file basis by adding a STARTUP option line to that file: #+STARTUP: noptag By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection method called _fast tag selection_. This allows you to select and deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should assign unique, case-sensitive, letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this globally by configuring the variable `org-tag-alist' in your Emacs init file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in different files with `:@home:'. In this case you can set something like: (setq org-tag-alist '(("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l))) If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you can instead set the TAGS option line as: #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p) The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert `\n' into the tag list #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p) or write them in two lines: #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p) You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using braces, as in: #+TAGS: { @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) } laptop(l) pc(p) you indicate that at most one of `@work', `@home', and `@tennisclub' should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed. Don't forget to press `C-c C-c' with the cursor in one of these lines to activate any changes. To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable `org-tag-alist', you must use the dummy tags `:startgroup' and `:endgroup' instead of the braces. Similarly, you can use `:newline' to indicate a line break. The previous example would be set globally by the following configuration: (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil) ("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) ("@tennisclub" . ?t) (:endgroup . nil) ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p))) If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing `C-c C-c' will automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with corresponding keys(1). Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group. In this interface, you can also use the following special keys: `' Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer. You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma. `' Clear all tags for this line. `' Accept the modified set. `C-g' Abort without installing changes. `q' If `q' is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like `C-g'. `!' Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an exception) assign several tags from such a group. `C-c' Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). If you are using expert mode, the first `C-c' will display the selection window. This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set `@home', `laptop' and `pc' tags with just the following keys: `C-c C-c h l p '. Switching from `@home' to `@work' would be done with `C-c C-c w ' or alternatively with `C-c C-c C-c w'. Adding the non-predefined tag `Sarah' could be done with `C-c C-c S a r a h '. If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to modify your list of tags, set `org-fast-tag-selection-single-key'. Then you no longer have to press to exit fast tag selection--it will immediately exit after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press `C-c' to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process (in effect: start selection with `C-c C-c C-c' instead of `C-c C-c'). If you set the variable to the value `expert', the special window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only when you press an extra `C-c'. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which have no configured keys.  File: org, Node: Tag hierarchy, Next: Tag searches, Prev: Setting tags, Up: Tags 6.3 Tag hierarchy ================= Tags can be defined in hierarchies. A tag can be defined as a _group tag_ for a set of other tags. The group tag can be seen as the "broader term" for its set of tags. Defining multiple _group tags_ and nesting them creates a tag hierarchy. One use-case is to create a taxonomy of terms (tags) that can be used to classify nodes in a document or set of documents. When you search for a group tag, it will return matches for all members in the group and its subgroups. In an agenda view, filtering by a group tag will display or hide headlines tagged with at least one of the members of the group or any of its subgroups. This makes tag searches and filters even more flexible. You can set group tags by using brackets and inserting a colon between the group tag and its related tags--beware that all whitespaces are mandatory so that Org can parse this line correctly: #+TAGS: [ GTD : Control Persp ] In this example, `GTD' is the _group tag_ and it is related to two other tags: `Control', `Persp'. Defining `Control' and `Persp' as group tags creates an hierarchy of tags: #+TAGS: [ Control : Context Task ] #+TAGS: [ Persp : Vision Goal AOF Project ] That can conceptually be seen as a hierarchy of tags: - GTD - Persp - Vision - Goal - AOF - Project - Control - Context - Task You can use the `:startgrouptag', `:grouptags' and `:endgrouptag' keyword directly when setting `org-tag-alist' directly: (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgrouptag) ("GTD") (:grouptags) ("Control") ("Persp") (:endgrouptag) (:startgrouptag) ("Control") (:grouptags) ("Context") ("Task") (:endgrouptag))) The tags in a group can be mutually exclusive if using the same group syntax as is used for grouping mutually exclusive tags together; using curly brackets. #+TAGS: { Context : @Home @Work @Call } When setting `org-tag-alist' you can use `:startgroup' & `:endgroup' instead of `:startgrouptag' & `:endgrouptag' to make the tags mutually exclusive. Furthermore, the members of a _group tag_ can also be regular expressions, creating the possibility of a more dynamic and rule-based tag structure. The regular expressions in the group must be specified within { }. Here is an expanded example: #+TAGS: [ Vision : {V@.+} ] #+TAGS: [ Goal : {G@.+} ] #+TAGS: [ AOF : {AOF@.+} ] #+TAGS: [ Project : {P@.+} ] Searching for the tag `Project' will now list all tags also including regular expression matches for `P@.+', and similarly for tag searches on `Vision', `Goal' and `AOF'. For example, this would work well for a project tagged with a common project-identifier, e.g. `P@2014_OrgTags'. If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags support with `org-toggle-tags-groups', bound to `C-c C-x q'. If you want to disable tag groups completely, set `org-group-tags' to `nil'.  File: org, Node: Tag searches, Prev: Tag hierarchy, Up: Tags 6.4 Tag searches ================ Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related information into special lists. `C-c / m or C-c \ (`org-match-sparse-tree')' Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags/property/TODO search. With a `C-u' prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. *Note Matching tags and properties::. `C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. *Note Matching tags and properties::. `C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic like `+boss+urgent-project1', to find entries with tags `boss' and `urgent', but not `project1', or `Kathy|Sally' to find entries tagged as `Kathy' or `Sally'. The full syntax of the search string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see *note Matching tags and properties::.  File: org, Node: Properties and columns, Next: Dates and times, Prev: Tags, Up: Top 7 Properties and columns ************************ A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree, or with every entry in an Org mode file. There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of using tags like `:release_1:', `:release_2:', you can use a property, say `:Release:', that in different subtrees has different values, such as `1.0' or `2.0'. Second, you can use properties to implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on. Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view (*note Column view::). * Menu: * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features * Property searches:: Matching property values * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers  File: org, Node: Property syntax, Next: Special properties, Up: Properties and columns 7.1 Property syntax =================== Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special drawer (*note Drawers::) with the name `PROPERTIES', which has to be located right below a headline, and its planning line (*note Deadlines and scheduling::) when applicable. Each property is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons) first, and the value after it. Keys are case-insensitive. Here is an example: * CD collection ** Classic *** Goldberg Variations :PROPERTIES: :Title: Goldberg Variations :Composer: J.S. Bach :Artist: Glen Gould :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon :NDisks: 1 :END: Depending on the value of `org-use-property-inheritance', a property set this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the subtree defined by the entry, see *note Property inheritance::. You may define the allowed values for a particular property `:Xyz:' by setting a property `:Xyz_ALL:'. This special property is _inherited_, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine publishers and the number of disks in a box like this: * CD collection :PROPERTIES: :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI :END: If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a file, use a line like #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4 Contrary to properties set from a special drawer, you have to refresh the buffer with `C-c C-c' to activate this change. If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a `+' to the property name. The following results in the property `var' having the value "foo=1 bar=2". #+PROPERTY: var foo=1 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The following results in the `genres' property having the value "Classic Baroque" under the `Goldberg Variations' subtree. * CD collection ** Classic :PROPERTIES: :GENRES: Classic :END: *** Goldberg Variations :PROPERTIES: :Title: Goldberg Variations :Composer: J.S. Bach :Artist: Glen Gould :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon :NDisks: 1 :GENRES+: Baroque :END: Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer. Property values set with the global variable `org-global-properties' can be inherited by all entries in all Org files. The following commands help to work with properties: `M- (`pcomplete')' After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used in the current file will be offered as possible completions. `C-c C-x p (`org-set-property')' Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If necessary, the property drawer is created as well. `C-u M-x org-insert-drawer RET' Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning information like deadlines. `C-c C-c (`org-property-action')' With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands. `C-c C-c s (`org-set-property')' Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value can be inserted using completion. `S- (`org-property-next-allowed-value')' `S- (`org-property-previous-allowed-value')' Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value. `C-c C-c d (`org-delete-property')' Remove a property from the current entry. `C-c C-c D (`org-delete-property-globally')' Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file. `C-c C-c c (`org-compute-property-at-point')' Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the nearest column format definition.  File: org, Node: Special properties, Next: Property searches, Prev: Property syntax, Up: Properties and columns 7.2 Special properties ====================== Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a column view (*note Column view::), or to use them in queries. The following property names are special and should not be used as keys in the properties drawer: ALLTAGS All tags, including inherited ones. BLOCKED "t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings. CLOCKSUM The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. `org-clock-sum' must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer. CLOCKSUM_T The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today. `org-clock-sum-today' must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer. CLOSED When was this entry closed? DEADLINE The deadline time string, without the angular brackets. FILE The filename the entry is located in. ITEM The headline of the entry. PRIORITY The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter. SCHEDULED The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets. TAGS The tags defined directly in the headline. TIMESTAMP The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry. TIMESTAMP_IA The first inactive timestamp in the entry. TODO The TODO keyword of the entry.  File: org, Node: Property searches, Next: Property inheritance, Prev: Special properties, Up: Properties and columns 7.3 Property searches ===================== To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (*note Tag searches::). `C-c / m or C-c \ (`org-match-sparse-tree')' Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a `C-u' prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. `C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files. *Note Matching tags and properties::. `C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the option `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). The syntax for the search string is described in *note Matching tags and properties::. There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a single property: `C-c / p' Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree is created with all entries that define this property with the given value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as a regular expression and matched against the property values.  File: org, Node: Property inheritance, Next: Column view, Prev: Property searches, Up: Properties and columns 7.4 Property Inheritance ======================== The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable `org-use-property-inheritance'. It may be set to `t' to make all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches inherited properties. If a property has the value `nil', this is interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance search will stop at this value and return `nil'. Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at least for the special applications for which they are used: `COLUMNS' The `:COLUMNS:' property defines the format of column view (*note Column view::). It is inherited in the sense that the level where a `:COLUMNS:' property is defined is used as the starting point for a column view table, independently of the location in the subtree from where columns view is turned on. `CATEGORY' For agenda view, a category set through a `:CATEGORY:' property applies to the entire subtree. `ARCHIVE' For archiving, the `:ARCHIVE:' property may define the archive location for the entire subtree (*note Moving subtrees::). `LOGGING' The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a subtree (*note Tracking TODO state changes::).  File: org, Node: Column view, Next: Property API, Prev: Property inheritance, Up: Properties and columns 7.5 Column view =============== A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is _column view_. In column view, each outline node is turned into a table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS view (`S- S-', or simply `c' while column view is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items. Column view also works in agenda buffers (*note Agenda views::) where queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files. * Menu: * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property * Using column view:: How to create and use column view * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view  File: org, Node: Defining columns, Next: Using column view, Up: Column view 7.5.1 Defining columns ---------------------- Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is done by defining a column format line. * Menu: * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column  File: org, Node: Scope of column definitions, Next: Column attributes, Up: Defining columns 7.5.1.1 Scope of column definitions ................................... To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a `:COLUMNS:' property to the top node of that tree, for example: ** Top node for columns view :PROPERTIES: :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO :END: If a `:COLUMNS:' property is present in an entry, it defines columns for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document, you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a deeper part of the tree.  File: org, Node: Column attributes, Prev: Scope of column definitions, Up: Defining columns 7.5.1.2 Column attributes ......................... A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general definition looks like this: %[WIDTH]PROPERTY[(TITLE)][{SUMMARY-TYPE}] Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are optional. The individual parts have the following meaning: WIDTH An integer specifying the width of the column in characters. If omitted, the width will be determined automatically. PROPERTY The property that should be edited in this column. Special properties representing meta data are allowed here as well (*note Special properties::) TITLE The header text for the column. If omitted, the property name is used. {SUMMARY-TYPE} The summary type. If specified, the column values for parent nodes are computed from the children(1). Supported summary types are: {+} Sum numbers in this column. {+;%.1f} Like `+', but format result with `%.1f'. {$} Currency, short for `+;%.2f'. {min} Smallest number in column. {max} Largest number. {mean} Arithmetic mean of numbers. {X} Checkbox status, `[X]' if all children are `[X]'. {X/} Checkbox status, `[n/m]'. {X%} Checkbox status, `[n%]'. {:} Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours(2). {:min} Smallest time value in column. {:max} Largest time value. {:mean} Arithmetic mean of time values. {@min} Minimum age(3) (in days/hours/mins/seconds). {@max} Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds). {@mean} Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds). {est+} Add `low-high' estimates. The `est+' summary type requires further explanation. It is used for combining estimates, expressed as `low-high' ranges or plain numbers. For example, instead of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery. When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, `est+' adds the statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, `est+' estimates the full job more realistically, at 10-15 days. Numbers are right-aligned when a format specifier with an explicit width like `%5d' or `%5.1f' is used. You can also define custom summary types by setting `org-columns-summary-types', which see. Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed values. :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?){X} %Owner %11Status \(4) %10Time_Estimate{:} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" "" :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]" The first column, `%25ITEM', means the first 25 characters of the item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the column definition with the `ITEM' specifier. The other specifiers create columns `Owner' with a list of names as allowed values, for `Status' with four different possible values, and for a checkbox field `Approved'. When no width is given after the `%' character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order to fully display all values. The `Approved' column does have a modified title (`Approved?', with a question mark). Summaries will be created for the `Time_Estimate' column by adding time duration expressions like HH:MM, and for the `Approved' column, by providing an `[X]' status if all children have been checked. The `CLOCKSUM' and `CLOCKSUM_T' columns are special, they lists the sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for today. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If more than one summary type apply to the property, the parent values are computed according to the first of them. (2) A time can also be a duration, using effort modifiers defined in `org-effort-durations', e.g., `3d 1h'. If any value in the column is as such, the summary will also be an effort duration. (3) An age is defined as a duration since a given time-stamp (*note Timestamps::). It can also be expressed as days, hours, minutes and seconds, identified by `d', `h', `m' and `s' suffixes, all mandatory, e.g., `0d 13h 0m 10s'. (4) Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line--it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.  File: org, Node: Using column view, Next: Capturing column view, Prev: Defining columns, Up: Column view 7.5.2 Using column view ----------------------- Turning column view on and off .............................. `C-c C-x C-c (`org-columns')' Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file, or the function called with the universal prefix argument, column view is turned on for the entire file, using the `#+COLUMNS' definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a `:COLUMNS:' property that defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for the tree starting at the entry that contains the `:COLUMNS:' property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the `#+COLUMNS' line or from the variable `org-columns-default-format', and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree. `r (`org-columns-redo')' Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer. `g (`org-columns-redo')' Same as `r'. `q (`org-columns-quit')' Exit column view. Editing values .............. ` ' Move through the column view from field to field. `S-/' Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you have to have specified allowed values for a property. `1..9,0' Directly select the Nth allowed value, `0' selects the 10th value. `n (`org-columns-next-allowed-value')' `p (`org-columns-previous-allowed-value')' Same as `S-/' `e (`org-columns-edit-value')' Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion or fast selection interface will pop up. `C-c C-c (`org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle')' When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it. `v (`org-columns-show-value')' View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of the column is smaller than that of the value. `a (`org-columns-edit-allowed')' Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found in the hierarchy, the modified value is stored there. If no list is found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the current column view. Modifying the table structure ............................. `< (`org-columns-narrow')' `> (`org-columns-widen')' Make the column narrower/wider by one character. `S-M- (`org-columns-new')' Insert a new column, to the left of the current column. `S-M- (`org-columns-delete')' Delete the current column.  File: org, Node: Capturing column view, Prev: Using column view, Up: Column view 7.5.3 Capturing column view --------------------------- Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use a `columnview' dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::). The frame of this block looks like this: * The column view #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label" #+END: This dynamic block has the following parameters: `:id' This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to capture, you can use 4 values: local use the tree in which the capture block is located global make a global view, including all headings in the file "file:PATH-TO-FILE" run column view at the top of this file "ID" call column view in the tree that has an `:ID:' property with the value label. You can use `M-x org-id-copy RET' to create a globally unique ID for the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring. `:hlines' When `t', insert an hline after every line. When a number N, insert an hline before each headline with level `<= N'. `:vlines' When set to `t', force column groups to get vertical lines. `:maxlevel' When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level. `:skip-empty-rows' When set to `t', skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the column view is `ITEM'. `:indent' When non-`nil', indent each `ITEM' field according to its level. The following commands insert or update the dynamic block: `C-c C-x i (`org-insert-columns-dblock')' Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted for the scope or ID of the view. `C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' Update dynamic block at point. `C-u C-c C-x C-u (`org-update-all-dblocks')' Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is useful if you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic blocks in a buffer. You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting instructions in front of the table--these will survive an update of the block. If there is a `#+TBLFM:' after the table, the table will actually be recalculated automatically after an update. An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is provided by Eric Schulte's `org-collector.el' which is a contributed package(1). It provides a general API to collect properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit `http://orgmode.org').  File: org, Node: Property API, Prev: Column view, Up: Properties and columns 7.6 The Property API ==================== There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement features based on them. For more information see *note Using the property API::.  File: org, Node: Dates and times, Next: Capture - Refile - Archive, Prev: Properties and columns, Up: Top 8 Dates and times ***************** To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time information is called a _timestamp_ in Org mode. This may be a little confusing because timestamp is often used to indicate when something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term is used in a much wider sense. * Menu: * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance * Timers:: Notes with a running timer  File: org, Node: Timestamps, Next: Creating timestamps, Up: Dates and times 8.1 Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling ========================================= A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of times) in a special format, either `<2003-09-16 Tue>'(1) or `<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>' or `<2003-09-16 Tue 12:00-12:30>'(2). A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). We distinguish: PLAIN TIMESTAMP; EVENT; APPOINTMENT A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the agenda display, the headline of an entry associated with a plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date. * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15> * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00> TIMESTAMP WITH REPEATER INTERVAL A timestamp may contain a _repeater interval_, indicating that it applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday: * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w> DIARY-STYLE SEXP ENTRIES For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary package(3). For example with optional time * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month <%%(diary-float t 4 2)> TIME/DATE RANGE Two timestamps connected by `--' denote a range. The headline will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example: ** Meeting in Amsterdam <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu> INACTIVE TIMESTAMP Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do _not_ trigger an entry to show up in the agenda. * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed] ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) In this simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself. However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for reading convenience. (2) This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see *note Custom time format::. (3) When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depends evilly on the variable `calendar-date-style' (or, for older Emacs versions, `european-calendar-style'). For example, to specify a date December 1, 2005, the call might look like `(diary-date 12 1 2005)' or `(diary-date 1 12 2005)' or `(diary-date 2005 12 1)', depending on the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users can resort to special versions of these functions like `org-date' or `org-anniversary'. These work just like the corresponding `diary-' functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever applicable, independent of the value of `calendar-date-style'.  File: org, Node: Creating timestamps, Next: Deadlines and scheduling, Prev: Timestamps, Up: Dates and times 8.2 Creating timestamps ======================= For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct format. `C-c . (`org-time-stamp')' Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in succession, a time range is inserted. `C-c ! (`org-time-stamp-inactive')' Like `C-c .', but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause an agenda entry. `C-u C-c .' `C-u C-c !' Like `C-c .' and `C-c !', but use the alternative format which contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes, see the option `org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes'. `C-c C-c' Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong. `C-c < (`org-date-from-calendar')' Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar. `C-c > (`org-goto-calendar')' Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date instead. `C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')' Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at point (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). `S- (`org-timestamp-down-day')' `S- (`org-timestamp-up-day')' Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with shift-selection and related modes (*note Conflicts::). `S- (`org-timestamp-up')' `S- (`org-timestamp-down-down')' Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range like `15:30-16:30', modifying the first time will also shift the second, shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item. (*note Priorities::). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and related modes (*note Conflicts::). `C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')' Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end. With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into the following column). * Menu: * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time * Custom time format:: Making dates look different  File: org, Node: The date/time prompt, Next: Custom time format, Up: Creating timestamps 8.2.1 The date/time prompt -------------------------- When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific format. But it will in fact accept date/time information in a variety of formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning of the string. Org mode will find whatever information is in there and derive anything you have not specified from the _default date and time_. The default is usually the current date and time, but when modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is before today, it will assume that you mean a future date(1). If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the time prompt will show this with `(=>F).' For example, let's assume that today is June 13, 2006. Here is how various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are in bold. 3-2-5 => 2003-02-05 2/5/3 => 2003-02-05 14 => 2006-06-14 12 => 2006-07-12 2/5 => 2007-02-05 Fri => nearest Friday after the default date sep 15 => 2006-09-15 feb 15 => 2007-02-15 sep 12 9 => 2009-09-12 12:45 => 2006-06-13 12:45 22 sept 0:34 => 2006-09-22 00:34 w4 => ISO week four of the current year 2006 2012 w4 fri => Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012 2012-w04-5 => Same as above Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the _first_ thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter ([hdwmy]) to indicate change in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. With a single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be the Nth such day, e.g.: +0 => today . => today +4d => four days from today +4 => same as above +2w => two weeks from today ++5 => five days from default date +2tue => second Tuesday from now -wed => last Wednesday The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure the variables `parse-time-months' and `parse-time-weekdays'. Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970-2037 which works on all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range, read the docstring of the variable `org-read-date-force-compatible-dates'. You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case, e.g.: 11am-1:15pm => 11:00-13:15 11am--1:15pm => same as above 11am+2:15 => same as above Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up(2). When you exit the date prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing , the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully from the minibuffer: Choose date at cursor in calendar. mouse-1 Select date by clicking on it. S-/ One day forward/backward. S-/ One week forward/backward. M-S-/ One month forward/backward. > / < Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month. M-v / C-v Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months. M-S-/ Scroll calendar forward/backward by one year. The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the minibuffer(3). ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See the variable `org-read-date-prefer-future'. You may set that variable to the symbol `time' to even make a time before now shift the date to tomorrow. (2) If you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable `org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt'. (3) If you find this distracting, turn the display off with `org-read-date-display-live'.  File: org, Node: Custom time format, Prev: The date/time prompt, Up: Creating timestamps 8.2.2 Custom time format ------------------------ Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by customizing the options `org-display-custom-times' and `org-time-stamp-custom-formats'. `C-c C-x C-t (`org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays')' Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times. Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time format does not _replace_ the default format--instead it is put _over_ the default format using text properties. This has the following consequences: * You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or after. * The `S-/' keys can no longer be used to adjust each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of the stamp, `S-/' will change the stamp by one day, just like `S-/'. At the end of the stamp, the time will be changed by one minute. * If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were. * When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only disappear from the buffer after _all_ (invisible) characters belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed. * If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom format is shorter, things do work as expected.  File: org, Node: Deadlines and scheduling, Next: Clocking work time, Prev: Creating timestamps, Up: Dates and times 8.3 Deadlines and scheduling ============================ A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning. Both the timestamp and the keyword have to be positioned immediately after the task they refer to. DEADLINE Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed to be finished on that date. On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In addition, the agenda for _today_ will carry a warning about the approaching or missed deadline, starting `org-deadline-warning-days' before the due date, and continuing until the entry is marked DONE. An example: *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun> The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]] You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific deadline using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning period of 5 days `DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>'. This warning is deactivated if the task gets scheduled and you set `org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled' to `t'. SCHEDULED Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given date. The headline will be listed under the given date(1). In addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present in the compilation for _today_, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e., the task will automatically be forwarded until completed. *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve. SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat> If you want to _delay_ the display of this task in the agenda, use `SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>': the task is still scheduled on the 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task contains a repeater, the delay is considered to affect all occurrences; if you want the delay to only affect the first scheduled occurrence of the task, use `--2d' instead. See `org-scheduled-delay-days' and `org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline' for details on how to control this globally or per agenda. Important: Scheduling an item in Org mode should not be understood in the same way that we understand scheduling a meeting. Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by Org users. In Org mode, scheduling means setting a date when you want to start working on an action item. You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the assumption that the timestamp represents the nearest instance of the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like `<%%(diary-float t 42)>' in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the sexp entry matches. * Menu: * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) It will still be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like this, set the variable `org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done'.  File: org, Node: Inserting deadline/schedule, Next: Repeated tasks, Up: Deadlines and scheduling 8.3.1 Inserting deadlines or schedules -------------------------------------- The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule an item: `C-c C-d (`org-deadline')' Insert `DEADLINE' keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the variable `org-log-redeadline'(1), a note will be taken when changing an existing deadline. `C-c C-s (`org-schedule')' Insert `SCHEDULED' keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling date from the entry. Depending on the variable `org-log-reschedule'(2), a note will be taken when changing an existing scheduling time. `C-c / d (`org-check-deadlines')' Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or which will become due within `org-deadline-warning-days'. With `C-u' prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric prefix, check that many days. For example, `C-1 C-c / d' shows all deadlines due tomorrow. `C-c / b (`org-check-before-date')' Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date. `C-c / a (`org-check-after-date')' Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date. Note that `org-schedule' and `org-deadline' supports setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set the date to the next day after today, and -1w will set the date to the previous week before any current timestamp. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logredeadline', `lognoteredeadline', and `nologredeadline' (2) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logreschedule', `lognotereschedule', and `nologreschedule'  File: org, Node: Repeated tasks, Prev: Inserting deadline/schedule, Up: Deadlines and scheduling 8.3.2 Repeated tasks -------------------- Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED, or plain timestamp. In the following example ** TODO Pay the rent DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m> the `+1m' is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat cookies by using the `y/w/m/d/h' letters. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last: `DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>'. Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the _next_ instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using `C-c C-t'), it will shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state back to TODO(1). In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually switch the date like this: ** TODO Pay the rent DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m> To mark a task with a repeater as `DONE', use `C-- 1 C-c C-t' (i.e., `org-todo' with a numeric prefix argument of -1.) A timestamp(2) will be added under the deadline, to keep a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline. As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances will be visible. With the `+1m' cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time after the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has special repeaters `++' and `.+'. For example: ** TODO Call Father DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w> Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week, but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called and marked it done on Saturday. ** TODO Empty kitchen trash DEADLINE: <2008-02-08 Fri 20:00 ++1d> Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one day, and also by as many days as it takes to get the timestamp into the future. Since there is a time in the timestamp, the next deadline in the future will be on today's date if you complete the task before 20:00. ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m> Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after today. You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific task. If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you probably want the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so, set the variable `org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown' to `repeated-after-deadline'. However, any scheduling information without a repeater is no longer relevant once the task is done, and thus, removed upon repeating the task. If you want both scheduling and deadline information to repeat after the same interval, set the same repeater for both timestamps. An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command `C-c C-x c' was created for this purpose, it is described in *note Structure editing::. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) In fact, the target state is taken from, in this sequence, the `REPEAT_TO_STATE' property or the variable `org-todo-repeat-to-state'. If neither of these is specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state sequence. (2) You can change this using the option `org-log-repeat', or the `#+STARTUP' options `logrepeat', `lognoterepeat', and `nologrepeat'. With `lognoterepeat', you will also be prompted for a note.  File: org, Node: Clocking work time, Next: Effort estimates, Prev: Deadlines and scheduling, Up: Dates and times 8.4 Clocking work time ====================== Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes the total time spent on each subtree(1) of a project. And it remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, so that you can jump quickly between a number of tasks absorbing your time. To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use (setq org-clock-persist 'history) (org-clock-persistence-insinuate) When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete clock(2) will be found (*note Resolving idle time::) and you will be prompted about what to do with it. * Menu: * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock * The clock table:: Detailed reports * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Clocking only works if all headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'. (2) To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked on this task while outside Emacs, use `(setq org-clock-persist t)'.  File: org, Node: Clocking commands, Next: The clock table, Up: Clocking work time 8.4.1 Clocking commands ----------------------- `C-c C-x C-i (`org-clock-in')' Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a `:LOGBOOK:' drawer (see also the variable `org-clock-into-drawer'). You can also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a `CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER' or `LOG_INTO_DRAWER' property. When called with a `C-u' prefix argument, select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two `C-u C-u' prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task; the default task will then always be available with letter `d' when selecting a clocking task. With three `C-u C-u C-u' prefixes, force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped. While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort estimate (*note Effort estimates::), the mode line displays the current clocking time against it(1) If the task is a repeating one (*note Repeated tasks::), only the time since the last reset of the task (2) will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with the `CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL' property. It may have the values `current' to show only the current clocking instance, `today' to show all time clocked on this task today (see also the variable `org-extend-today-until'), `all' to include all time, or `auto' which is the default(3). Clicking with `mouse-1' onto the mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options. `C-c C-x C-o (`org-clock-out')' Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes the resulting time and inserts it after the time range as `=> HH:MM'. See the variable `org-log-note-clock-out' for the possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out timestamp(4). `C-c C-x C-x (`org-clock-in-last')' Reclock the last clocked task. With one `C-u' prefix argument, select the task from the clock history. With two `C-u' prefixes, force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped. `C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')' Update the effort estimate for the current clock task. `C-c C-c or C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')' Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change them with `S-' keys, the update is automatic. `C-S- (`org-clock-timestamps-up/down')' On `CLOCK' log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the clock duration keeps the same. `S-M- (`org-timestamp-up/down')' On `CLOCK' log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration. For example, if you hit `S-M-' to increase a clocked-out timestamp by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be increased by five minutes. `C-c C-t (`org-todo')' Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock if it is running in this same item. `C-c C-x C-q (`org-clock-cancel')' Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by mistake, or if you ended up working on something else. `C-c C-x C-j (`org-clock-goto')' Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a `C-u' prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks. `C-c C-x C-d (`org-clock-display')' Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the buffer (see variable `org-remove-highlights-with-change') or press `C-c C-c'. The `l' key may be used the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::) to show which tasks have been worked on or closed during a day. *Important:* note that both `org-clock-out' and `org-clock-in-last' can have a global key binding and will not modify the window disposition. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) To add an effort estimate "on the fly", hook a function doing this to `org-clock-in-prepare-hook'. (2) as recorded by the `LAST_REPEAT' property (3) See also the variable `org-clock-modeline-total'. (4) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out'  File: org, Node: The clock table, Next: Resolving idle time, Prev: Clocking commands, Up: Clocking work time 8.4.2 The clock table --------------------- Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking information. Such a report is called a _clock table_, because it is formatted as one or several Org tables. `C-c C-x C-r (`org-clock-report')' Insert a dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::) containing a clock report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and update it. The clock table always includes also trees with `:ARCHIVE:' tag. `C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' Update dynamic block at point. `C-u C-c C-x C-u' Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is useful if you have several clock table blocks in a buffer. `S-' `S- (`org-clocktable-try-shift')' Shift the current `:block' interval and update the table. The cursor needs to be in the `#+BEGIN: clocktable' line for this command. If `:block' is `today', it will be shifted to `today-1' etc. Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the buffer with the `C-c C-x C-r' command: #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file #+END: clocktable The `BEGIN' line specifies a number of options to define the scope, structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can be configured in the variable `org-clocktable-defaults'. First there are options that determine which clock entries are to be selected: :maxlevel Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table. Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level. :scope The scope to consider. This can be any of the following: nil the current buffer or narrowed region file the full current buffer subtree the subtree where the clocktable is located treeN the surrounding level N tree, for example `tree3' tree the surrounding level 1 tree agenda all agenda files ("file"..) scan these files function the list of files returned by a function of no argument file-with-archives current file and its archives agenda-with-archives all agenda files, including archives :block The time block to consider. This block is specified either absolutely, or relative to the current time and may be any of these formats: 2007-12-31 New year eve 2007 2007-12 December 2007 2007-W50 ISO-week 50 in 2007 2007-Q2 2nd quarter in 2007 2007 the year 2007 today, yesterday, today-N a relative day thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N a relative week thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N a relative month thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N a relative year untilnow Use `S-/' keys to shift the time interval. :tstart A time string specifying when to start considering times. Relative times like `"<-2w>"' can also be used. See *note Matching tags and properties:: for relative time syntax. :tend A time string specifying when to stop considering times. Relative times like `""' can also be used. See *note Matching tags and properties:: for relative time syntax. :wstart The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for monday. :mstart The starting day of the month. The default 1 is for the first day of the month. :step `week' or `day', to split the table into chunks. To use this, `:block' or `:tstart', `:tend' are needed. :stepskip0 Do not show steps that have zero time. :fileskip0 Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute. :tags A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See *note Matching tags and properties:: for the match syntax. Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. These options are interpreted by the function `org-clocktable-write-default', but you can specify your own function using the `:formatter' parameter. :emphasize When `t', emphasize level one and level two items. :lang Language(1) to use for descriptive cells like "Task". :link Link the item headlines in the table to their origins. :narrow An integer to limit the width of the headline column in the org table. If you write it like `50!', then the headline will also be shortened in export. :indent Indent each headline field according to its level. :tcolumns Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller than `:maxlevel', lower levels will be lumped into one column. :level Should a level number column be included? :sort A cons cell like containing the column to sort and a sorting type. E.g., `:sort (1 . ?a)' sorts the first column alphabetically. :compact Abbreviation for `:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1' All are overwritten except if there is an explicit `:narrow' :timestamp A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED, DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order. :properties List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each property will get its own column. :inherit-props When this flag is `t', the values for `:properties' will be inherited. :formula Content of a `#+TBLFM' line to be added and evaluated. As a special case, `:formula %' adds a column with % time. If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated. :formatter A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer. To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current day, you could write #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t #+END: clocktable and to use a specific time range you could write(2) #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>" :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>" #+END: clocktable A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "" #+END: clocktable A summary of the current subtree with % times would be #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula % #+END: clocktable A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week would be #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t #+END: clocktable ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Language terms can be set through the variable `org-clock-clocktable-language-setup'. (2) Note that all parameters must be specified in a single line--the line is broken here only to fit it into the manual.  File: org, Node: Resolving idle time, Prev: The clock table, Up: Clocking work time 8.4.3 Resolving idle time and continuous clocking ------------------------------------------------- Resolving idle time ................... If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your computer--perhaps to take a phone call--you often need to "resolve" the time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or applying it to another one. By customizing the variable `org-clock-idle-time' to some integer, such as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after being idle for that many minutes(1), and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of choices to correct the discrepancy: `k' To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press `k'. Org will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press to keep them all, effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes. `K' If you use the shift key and press `K', it will keep however many minutes you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task. `s' To keep none of the minutes, use `s' to subtract all the away time from the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned. `S' To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time, use the shift key and press `S'. Remember that using shift will always leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose. `C' To cancel the clock altogether, use `C'. Note that if instead of canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the log with an empty entry. What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time "on the books", so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to the next task you clock in on. There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org mode changes, including your last clock in. If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period, Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time. You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling clocks at any time using `M-x org-resolve-clocks RET' (or `C-c C-x C-z'). Continuous clocking ................... You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the previous task. To enable this systematically, set `org-clock-continuously' to `t'. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there. If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments with `org-clock-in' and two `C-u C-u' with `org-clock-in-last'. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) On computers using Mac OS X, idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For X11, you can install a utility program `x11idle.c', available in the `contrib/scripts' directory of the Org git distribution, or install the `xprintidle' package and set it to the variable `org-clock-x11idle-program-name' if you are running Debian, to get the same general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time only.  File: org, Node: Effort estimates, Next: Timers, Prev: Clocking work time, Up: Dates and times 8.5 Effort estimates ==================== If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a special property `EFFORT'. You can set the effort for an entry with the following commands: `C-c C-x e (`org-set-effort')' Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also accessible from the agenda with the `e' key. `C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')' Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked. Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view (*note Column view::). You should start by setting up discrete values for effort estimates, and a `COLUMNS' format that displays these values together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific buffer you can use #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort){:} %CLOCKSUM or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the variables `org-global-properties' and `org-columns-default-format'. In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global setup may be advised. The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column mode, and to use `S-' and `S-' to change the value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy. In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed. If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column will summarize the estimated work effort for each day(1), and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the option `org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum'. The appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will then also be added to the load estimate of the day. Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered with the `/' key in the agenda (*note Agenda commands::). If you have these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Please note the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (*note Agenda column view::).  File: org, Node: Timers, Prev: Effort estimates, Up: Dates and times 8.6 Taking notes with a timer ============================= Org provides two types of timers. There is a relative timer that counts up, which can be useful when taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing. There is also a countdown timer. The relative and countdown are started with separate commands. `C-c C-x 0 (`org-timer-start')' Start or reset the relative timer. By default, the timer is set to 0. When called with a `C-u' prefix, prompt the user for a starting offset. If there is a timer string at point, this is taken as the default, providing a convenient way to restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double prefix argument `C-u C-u', change all timer strings in the active region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was not started at exactly the right moment. `C-c C-x ; (`org-timer-set-timer')' Start a countdown timer. The user is prompted for a duration. `org-timer-default-timer' sets the default countdown value. Giving a numeric prefix argument overrides this default value. This command is available as `;' in agenda buffers. Once started, relative and countdown timers are controlled with the same commands. `C-c C-x . (`org-timer')' Insert the value of the current relative or countdown timer into the buffer. If no timer is running, the relative timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the relative timer is restarted. `C-c C-x - (`org-timer-item')' Insert a description list item with the value of the current relative or countdown timer. With a prefix argument, first reset the relative timer to 0. `M- (`org-insert-heading')' Once the timer list is started, you can also use `M-' to insert new timer items. `C-c C-x , (`org-timer-pause-or-continue')' Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused. `C-c C-x _ (`org-timer-stop')' Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.  File: org, Node: Capture - Refile - Archive, Next: Agenda views, Prev: Dates and times, Up: Top 9 Capture - Refile - Archive **************************** An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them. Org does this using a process called capture. It also can store files related to a task (attachments) in a special directory. Once in the system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast. * Menu: * Capture:: Capturing new stuff * Attachments:: Add files to tasks * RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org * Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects  File: org, Node: Capture, Next: Attachments, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.1 Capture =========== Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley excellent `remember.el' package. Up to version 6.36, Org used a special setup for `remember.el', then replaced it with `org-remember.el'. As of version 8.0, `org-remember.el' has been completely replaced by `org-capture.el'. If your configuration depends on `org-remember.el', you need to update it and use the setup described below. To convert your `org-remember-templates', run the command M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates RET and then customize the new variable with `M-x customize-variable org-capture-templates', check the result, and save the customization. * Menu: * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types  File: org, Node: Setting up capture, Next: Using capture, Up: Capture 9.1.1 Setting up capture ------------------------ The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines a global key(1) for capturing new material. (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org")) (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture) ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Please select your own key, `C-c c' is only a suggestion.  File: org, Node: Using capture, Next: Capture templates, Prev: Setting up capture, Up: Capture 9.1.2 Using capture ------------------- `C-c c (`org-capture')' Call the command `org-capture'. Note that this key binding is global and not active by default: you need to install it. If you have templates defined *note Capture templates::, it will offer these templates for selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want. `C-c C-c (`org-capture-finalize')' Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, `C-c C-c' will return you to the window configuration before the capture process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item. `C-c C-w (`org-capture-refile')' Finalize the capture process by refiling (*note Refile and copy::) the note to a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command that will be executed--so the cursor position at the moment you run this command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument given to this command will be passed on to the `org-refile' command. `C-c C-k (`org-capture-kill')' Abort the capture process and return to the previous state. You can also call `org-capture' in a special way from the agenda, using the `k c' key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date. To find the locations of the last stored capture, use `org-capture' with prefix commands: `C-u C-c c' Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the template in the usual way. `C-u C-u C-c c' Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer. You can also jump to the bookmark `org-capture-last-stored', which will automatically be created unless you set `org-capture-bookmark' to `nil'. To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call `org-capture' with a `C-0' prefix argument.  File: org, Node: Capture templates, Prev: Using capture, Up: Capture 9.1.3 Capture templates ----------------------- You can use templates for different types of capture items, and for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is through the customize interface. `C-c c C' Customize the variable `org-capture-templates'. Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading `Tasks' in your file `~/org/gtd.org'. Also, a date tree in the file `journal.org' should capture journal entries. A possible configuration would look like: (setq org-capture-templates '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks") "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a") ("j" "Journal" entry (file+olp+datetree "~/org/journal.org") "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a"))) If you then press `C-c c t', Org will prepare the template for you like this: * TODO [[file:LINK TO WHERE YOU INITIATED CAPTURE]] During expansion of the template, `%a' has been replaced by a link to the location from where you called the capture command. This can be extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in the task definition, press `C-c C-c' and Org returns you to the same place where you started the capture process. To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding like this: (define-key global-map "\C-cx" (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x"))) * Menu: * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context  File: org, Node: Template elements, Next: Template expansion, Up: Capture templates 9.1.3.1 Template elements ......................... Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in `org-capture-templates' is a list with the following items: KEYS The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters only, for example `"a"' for a template to be selected with a single key, or `"bt"' for selection with two keys. When using several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the prefix key, for example ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy") If you do not define a template for the `C' key, this key will be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable. DESCRIPTION A short string describing the template, which will be shown during selection. TYPE The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are: `entry' An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file. `item' A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target location. Again the target file should be an Org file. `checkitem' A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the default template. `table-line' a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the line will be inserted depends on the properties `:prepend' and `:table-line-pos' (see below). `plain' Text to be inserted as it is. TARGET Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is the empty string, it defaults to `org-default-notes-file'. A file can also be given as a variable or as a function called with no argument. When an absolute path is not specified for a target, it is taken as relative to `org-directory'. Valid values are: `(file "path/to/file")' Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file. `(id "id of existing org entry")' Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry. `(file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")' Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file. `(file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)' For non-unique headings, the full path is safer. `(file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")' Use a regular expression to position the cursor. `(file+olp+datetree "path/to/file" [ "Level 1 heading" ....])' This target(1) will create a heading in a date tree(2) for today's date. If the optional outline path is given, the tree will be built under the node it is pointing to, instead of at top level. Check out the `:time-prompt' and `:tree-type' properties below for additional options. `(file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)' A function to find the right location in the file. `(clock)' File to the entry that is currently being clocked. `(function function-finding-location)' Most general way: write your own function which both visits the file and moves point to the right location. TEMPLATE The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file, using the special syntax `(file "path/to/template")'. See below for more details. PROPERTIES The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options. Recognized properties are: `:prepend' Normally new captured information will be appended at the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...). Setting this property will change that. `:immediate-finish' When set, do not offer to edit the information, just file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs information that can be added automatically. `:empty-lines' Set this to the number of lines to insert before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1. `:clock-in' Start the clock in this item. `:clock-keep' Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry. `:clock-resume' If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished with the capture. Note that `:clock-keep' has precedence over `:clock-resume'. When setting both to `t', the current clock will run and the previous one will not be resumed. `:time-prompt' Prompt for a date/time to be used for date/week trees and when filling the template. Without this property, capture uses the current date and time. Even if this property has not been set, you can force the same behavior by calling `org-capture' with a `C-1' prefix argument. `:tree-type' When `week', make a week tree instead of the month tree, i.e. place the headings for each day under a heading with the current iso week. `:unnarrowed' Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to narrow it so that you only see the new material. `:table-line-pos' Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be inserted. It can be a string, a variable holding a string or a function returning a string. The string should look like `"II-3"' meaning that the new line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator line. `:kill-buffer' If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the buffer again after capture is completed. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Org used to offer four different targets for date/week tree capture. Now, Org automatically translates these to use `file+olp+datetree', applying the `:time-prompt' and `:tree-type' properties. Please rewrite your date/week-tree targets using `file+olp+datetree' since the older targets are now deprecated. (2) A date tree is an outline structure with years on the highest level, months or ISO-weeks as sublevels and then dates on the lowest level. Tags are allowed in the tree structure.  File: org, Node: Template expansion, Next: Templates in contexts, Prev: Template elements, Up: Capture templates 9.1.3.2 Template expansion .......................... In the template itself, special `%'-escapes(1) allow dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here: %[FILE] Insert the contents of the file given by FILE. %(SEXP) Evaluate Elisp SEXP and replace with the result. For convenience, %:keyword (see below) placeholders within the expression will be expanded prior to this. The sexp must return a string. %<...> The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification. %t Timestamp, date only. %T Timestamp, with date and time. %u, %U Like the above, but inactive timestamps. %i Initial content, the region when capture is called while the region is active. The entire text will be indented like `%i' itself. %a Annotation, normally the link created with `org-store-link'. %A Like `%a', but prompt for the description part. %l Like %a, but only insert the literal link. %c Current kill ring head. %x Content of the X clipboard. %k Title of the currently clocked task. %K Link to the currently clocked task. %n User name (taken from `user-full-name'). %f File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called. %F Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer. %:keyword Specific information for certain link types, see below. %^g Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file. %^G Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files. %^t Like `%t', but prompt for date. Similarly `%^T', `%^u', `%^U'. You may define a prompt like `%^{Birthday}t'. %^C Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use. %^L Like `%^C', but insert as link. %^{PROP}p Prompt the user for a value for property PROP. %^{PROMPT} prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it. You may specify a default value and a completion table with %^{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...}. The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history. %\1 ... %\N Insert the text entered at the Nth %^{PROMPT}, where `N' is a number, starting from 1.(2) %? After completing the template, position cursor here. For specific link types, the following keywords will be defined(3): Link type | Available keywords ---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------- bbdb | %:name %:company irc | %:server %:port %:nick vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail, | %:type %:subject %:message-id gnus, notmuch | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress | %:to %:toname %:toaddress | %:date (message date header field) | %:date-timestamp (date as active timestamp) | %:date-timestamp-inactive (date as inactive timestamp) | %:fromto (either "to NAME" or "from NAME")(4) gnus | %:group, for messages also all email fields eww, w3, w3m | %:url info | %:file %:node calendar | %:date org-protocol | %:link %:description %:annotation To place the cursor after template expansion use: %? After completing the template, position cursor here. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If you need one of these sequences literally, escape the `%' with a backslash. (2) As required in Emacs Lisp, it is necessary to escape any backslash character in a string with another backslash. So, in order to use `%\1' placeholder, you need to write `%\\1' in the template. (3) If you define your own link types (*note Adding hyperlink types::), any property you store with `org-store-link-props' can be accessed in capture templates in a similar way. (4) This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable `org-from-is-user-regexp'.  File: org, Node: Templates in contexts, Prev: Template expansion, Up: Capture templates 9.1.3.3 Templates in contexts ............................. To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific context, you can customize `org-capture-templates-contexts'. Let's say for example that you have a capture template `"p"' for storing Gnus emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this: (setq org-capture-templates-contexts '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) You can also tell that the command key `"p"' should refer to another template. In that case, add this command key like this: (setq org-capture-templates-contexts '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) See the docstring of the variable for more information.  File: org, Node: Attachments, Next: RSS feeds, Prev: Capture, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.2 Attachments =============== It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task. Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project. Hyperlinks (*note Hyperlinks::) can establish associations with files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or source code files belonging to a project. Another method is attachments, which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are located in the `data' directory which lives in the same directory where your Org file lives(1). If you initialize this directory with `git init', Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them. The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley. In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached directory. The following commands deal with attachments: `C-c C-a (`org-attach')' The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key to select a command: `a (`org-attach-attach')' Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on `org-attach-method'. Note that hard links are not supported on all systems. `c/m/l' Attach a file using the copy/move/link method. Note that hard links are not supported on all systems. `u (`org-attach-url')' Attach a file from URL `n (`org-attach-new')' Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer. `z (`org-attach-sync')' Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added attachments yourself. `o (`org-attach-open')' Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by `org-file-apps'. For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks (*note Handling links::). `O (`org-attach-open-in-emacs')' Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs. `f (`org-attach-reveal')' Open the current task's attachment directory. `F (`org-attach-reveal-in-emacs')' Also open the directory, but force using `dired' in Emacs. `d (`org-attach-delete-one')' Select and delete a single attachment. `D (`org-attach-delete-all')' Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in `dired' and delete from there. `s (`org-attach-set-directory')' Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by putting the directory path into the `ATTACH_DIR' property. `i (`org-attach-set-inherit')' Set the `ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT' property, so that children will use the same directory for attachments as the parent does. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If you move entries or Org files from one directory to another, you may want to configure `org-attach-directory' to contain an absolute path.  File: org, Node: RSS feeds, Next: Protocols, Prev: Attachments, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.3 RSS feeds ============= Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable `org-feed-alist'. The docstring of this variable has detailed information. Here is just an example: (setq org-feed-alist '(("Slashdot" "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot" "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries"))) will configure that new items from the feed provided by `rss.slashdot.org' will result in new entries in the file `~/org/feeds.org' under the heading `Slashdot Entries', whenever the following command is used: `C-c C-x g (`org-feed-update-all')' `C-c C-x g' Collect items from the feeds configured in `org-feed-alist' and act upon them. `C-c C-x G (`org-feed-goto-inbox')' Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed. Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer `FEEDSTATUS' in which it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid adding the same item several times. For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see `org-feed.el' and the docstring of `org-feed-alist'.  File: org, Node: Protocols, Next: Refile and copy, Prev: RSS feeds, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.4 Protocols for external access ================================= Org protocol is a mean to trigger custom actions in Emacs from external applications. Any application that supports calling external programs with an URL as argument may be used with this functionality. For example, you can configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to Org and create a note from it using capture (*note Capture::). You can also create a bookmark that tells Emacs to open the local source file of a remote website you are browsing. In order to use Org protocol from an application, you need to register `org-protocol://' as a valid scheme-handler. External calls are passed to Emacs through the `emacsclient' command, so you also need to ensure an Emacs server is running. More precisely, when the application calls emacsclient org-protocol://PROTOCOL?key1=val1&key2=val2 Emacs calls the handler associated to `PROTOCOL' with argument `(:key1 val1 :key2 val2)'. Org protocol comes with three predefined protocols, detailed in the following sections. Configure `org-protocol-protocol-alist' to define your own. * Menu: * `store-link' protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. * `capture' protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. * `open-source' protocol:: Edit published contents.  File: org, Node: `store-link' protocol, Next: `capture' protocol, Up: Protocols 9.4.1 `store-link' protocol --------------------------- Using `store-link' handler, you can copy links, insertable through `M-x org-insert-link' or yanking thereafter. More precisely, the command emacsclient org-protocol://store-link?url=URL&title=TITLE stores the following link: [[URL][TITLE]] In addition, `URL' is pushed on the kill-ring for yanking. You need to encode `URL' and `TITLE' if they contain slashes, and probably quote those for the shell. To use this feature from a browser, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g., `Org: store-link' and enter this as _Location_: javascript:location.href='org-protocol://store-link?url='+ encodeURIComponent(location.href);  File: org, Node: `capture' protocol, Next: `open-source' protocol, Prev: `store-link' protocol, Up: Protocols 9.4.2 `capture' protocol ------------------------ Activating `capture' handler pops up a `Capture' buffer and fills the capture template associated to the `X' key with them. emacsclient org-protocol://capture?template=X?url=URL?title=TITLE?body=BODY To use this feature, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g. `Org: capture' and enter this as `Location': javascript:location.href='org-protocol://template=x'+ '&url='+encodeURIComponent(window.location.href)+ '&title='+encodeURIComponent(document.title)+ '&body='+encodeURIComponent(window.getSelection()); The result depends on the capture template used, which is set in the bookmark itself, as in the example above, or in `org-protocol-default-template-key'. The following template placeholders are available: %:link The URL %:description The webpage title %:annotation Equivalent to [[%:link][%:description]] %i The selected text  File: org, Node: `open-source' protocol, Prev: `capture' protocol, Up: Protocols 9.4.3 `open-source' protocol ---------------------------- The `open-source' handler is designed to help with editing local sources when reading a document. To that effect, you can use a bookmark with the following location: javascript:location.href='org-protocol://open-source?&url='+ encodeURIComponent(location.href) The variable `org-protocol-project-alist' maps URLs to local file names, by stripping URL parameters from the end and replacing the `:base-url' with `:working-directory' and `:online-suffix' with `:working-suffix'. For example, assuming you own a local copy of `http://orgmode.org/worg/' contents at `/home/user/worg', you can set `org-protocol-project-alist' to the following (setq org-protocol-project-alist '(("Worg" :base-url "http://orgmode.org/worg/" :working-directory "/home/user/worg/" :online-suffix ".html" :working-suffix ".org"))) If you are now browsing `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.html' and find a typo or have an idea about how to enhance the documentation, simply click the bookmark and start editing. However, such mapping may not yield the desired results. Suppose you maintain an online store located at `http://example.com/'. The local sources reside in `/home/user/example/'. It is common practice to serve all products in such a store through one file and rewrite URLs that do not match an existing file on the server. That way, a request to `http://example.com/print/posters.html' might be rewritten on the server to something like `http://example.com/shop/products.php/posters.html.php'. The `open-source' handler probably cannot find a file named `/home/user/example/print/posters.html.php' and fails. Such an entry in `org-protocol-project-alist' may hold an additional property `:rewrites'. This property is a list of cons cells, each of which maps a regular expression to a path relative to the `:working-directory'. Now map the URL to the path `/home/user/example/products.php' by adding `:rewrites' rules like this: (setq org-protocol-project-alist '(("example.com" :base-url "http://example.com/" :working-directory "/home/user/example/" :online-suffix ".php" :working-suffix ".php" :rewrites (("example.com/print/" . "products.php") ("example.com/$" . "index.php"))))) Since `example.com/$' is used as a regular expression, it maps `http://example.com/', `https://example.com', `http://www.example.com/' and similar to `/home/user/example/index.php'. The `:rewrites' rules are searched as a last resort if and only if no existing file name is matched. Two functions can help you filling `org-protocol-project-alist' with valid contents: `org-protocol-create' and `org-protocol-create-for-org'. The latter is of use if you're editing an Org file that is part of a publishing project.  File: org, Node: Refile and copy, Next: Archiving, Prev: Protocols, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.5 Refile and copy =================== When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy some of the entries into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following special command: `C-c M-w (`org-copy')' Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not deleted. `C-c C-w (`org-refile')' Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem. Depending on `org-reverse-note-order', it will be either the first or last subitem. By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files. See the variable `org-refile-targets' for details. If you would like to select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see the variables `org-refile-use-outline-path' and `org-outline-path-complete-in-steps'. If you would like to be able to create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the variable `org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes'. When the variable `org-log-refile'(1) is set, a timestamp or a note will be recorded when an entry has been refiled. `C-u C-c C-w' Use the refile interface to jump to a heading. `C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-goto-last-stored')' Jump to the location where `org-refile' last moved a tree to. `C-2 C-c C-w' Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked. `C-3 C-c C-w' Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see `org-refile-keep' to make this the default behavior, and beware that this may result in duplicated `ID' properties. `C-0 C-c C-w or C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-cache-clear')' Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by setting `org-refile-use-cache'. To make the command see new possible targets, you have to clear the cache with this command. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logrefile', `lognoterefile', and `nologrefile'  File: org, Node: Archiving, Prev: Refile and copy, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive 9.6 Archiving ============= When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global searches like the construction of agenda views fast. `C-c C-x C-a (`org-archive-subtree-default')' Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable `org-archive-default-command'. * Menu: * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file  File: org, Node: Moving subtrees, Next: Internal archiving, Up: Archiving 9.6.1 Moving a tree to the archive file --------------------------------------- The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file, the archive file. `C-c C-x C-s or short C-c $ (`org-archive-subtree')' Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location given by `org-archive-location'. `C-u C-c C-x C-s' Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive location. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline when this command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked. `C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s' As above, but check subtree for timestamps instead of TODO entries. The command will offer to archive the subtree if it _does_ contain a timestamp, and that timestamp is in the past. The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the current file, with the name derived by appending `_archive' to the current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file. For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading, see the documentation string of the variable `org-archive-location'. There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for example: #+ARCHIVE: %s_done:: If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry or a (sub)tree, give the entry an `:ARCHIVE:' property with the location as the value (*note Properties and columns::). When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that record context information like the file from where the entry came, its outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable `org-archive-save-context-info' to adjust the amount of information added.  File: org, Node: Internal archiving, Prev: Moving subtrees, Up: Archiving 9.6.2 Internal archiving ------------------------ If you want to just switch off--for agenda views--certain subtrees without moving them to a different file, you can use the archive tag. A headline that is marked with the `:ARCHIVE:' tag (*note Tags::) stays at its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way: - It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling command (*note Visibility cycling::). You can force cycling archived subtrees with `C-', or by setting the option `org-cycle-open-archived-trees'. Also normal outline commands like `show-all' will open archived subtrees. - During sparse tree construction (*note Sparse trees::), matches in archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option `org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees'. - During agenda view construction (*note Agenda views::), the content of archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option `org-agenda-skip-archived-trees', in which case these trees will always be included. In the agenda you can press `v a' to get archives temporarily included. - Archived trees are not exported (*note Exporting::), only the headline is. Configure the details using the variable `org-export-with-archived-trees'. - Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable `org-columns-skip-archived-trees' is configured to `nil'. The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag: `C-c C-x a (`org-toggle-archive-tag')' Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set, the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is hidden. `C-u C-c C-x a' Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline when this command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked. `C-TAB (`org-force-cycle-archived')' Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE. `C-c C-x A (`org-archive-to-archive-sibling')' Move the current entry to the _Archive Sibling_. This is a sibling of the entry with the heading `Archive' and the tag `ARCHIVE'. The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the outline.  File: org, Node: Agenda views, Next: Markup, Prev: Capture - Refile - Archive, Up: Top 10 Agenda views *************** Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are important for a particular date, this information must be collected, sorted and displayed in an organized way. Org can select items based on various criteria and display them in a separate buffer. Six different view types are provided: * an _agenda_ that is like a calendar and shows information for specific dates, * a _TODO list_ that covers all unfinished action items, * a _match view_, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and TODO state associated with them, * a _text search view_ that shows all entries from multiple files that contain specified keywords, * a _stuck projects view_ showing projects that currently don't move along, and * _custom views_ that are special searches and combinations of different views. The extracted information is displayed in a special _agenda buffer_. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to edit these files remotely. By default, the report ignores commented (*note Comment lines::) and archived (*note Internal archiving::) entries. You can override this by setting `org-agenda-skip-comment-trees' and `org-agenda-skip-archived-trees' to `nil'. Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the window configuration is restored when the agenda exits: `org-agenda-window-setup' and `org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit'. * Menu: * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views * Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries  File: org, Node: Agenda files, Next: Agenda dispatcher, Up: Agenda views 10.1 Agenda files ================= The information to be shown is normally collected from all _agenda files_, the files listed in the variable `org-agenda-files'(1). If a directory is part of this list, all files with the extension `.org' in this directory will be part of the list. Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should be put into the list(2). You can customize `org-agenda-files', but the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands `C-c [ (`org-agenda-file-to-front')' Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end. `C-c ] (`org-remove-file')' Remove current file from the list of agenda files. `C-' (`org-cycle-agenda-files')' `C-,' Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other. `M-x org-iswitchb RET' Command to use an `iswitchb'-like interface to switch to and between Org buffers. The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used to visit any of them. If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command, you may press `<' once or several times in the dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::). To restrict the agenda scope for an extended period, use the following commands: `C-c C-x < (`org-agenda-set-restriction-lock')' Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file, the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in effect until removed with `C-c C-x >', or by typing either `<' or `>' in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately. `C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' Remove the permanent restriction created by `C-c C-x <'. When working with `speedbar.el', you can use the following commands in the Speedbar frame: `< in the speedbar frame (`org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction')' Permanently restrict the agenda to the item--either an Org file or a subtree in such a file--at the cursor in the Speedbar frame. If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately. `> in the speedbar frame (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' Lift the restriction. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If the value of that variable is not a list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be maintained in that external file. (2) When using the dispatcher, pressing `<' before selecting a command will actually limit the command to the current file, and ignore `org-agenda-files' until the next dispatcher command.  File: org, Node: Agenda dispatcher, Next: Built-in agenda views, Prev: Agenda files, Up: Agenda views 10.2 The agenda dispatcher ========================== The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a global key--for example `C-c a' (*note Activation::). In the following we will assume that `C-c a' is indeed how the dispatcher is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After pressing `C-c a', an additional letter is required to execute a command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands: `a' Create the calendar-like agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). `t / T' Create a list of all TODO items (*note Global TODO list::). `m / M' Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (*note Matching tags and properties::). `s' Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry. `/' Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in the files listed in `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'. This uses the Emacs command `multi-occur'. A prefix argument can be used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is 1. `# / !' Create a list of stuck projects (*note Stuck projects::). `<' Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer(1). After pressing `<', you still need to press the character selecting the command. `< <' If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree(2). After pressing `< <', you still need to press the character selecting the command. `*' Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything is always up to date. If you often switch between agenda views and the build time bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers or make this the default by customizing the variable `org-agenda-sticky'. With sticky agendas, the agenda dispatcher will not recreate agenda views from scratch, it will only switch to the selected one, and you need to update the agenda by hand with `r' or `g' when needed. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with `org-toggle-sticky-agenda'. You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and a number of special tags matches. *Note Custom agenda views::. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) For backward compatibility, you can also press `1' to restrict to the current buffer. (2) For backward compatibility, you can also press `0' to restrict to the current region/subtree.  File: org, Node: Built-in agenda views, Next: Presentation and sorting, Prev: Agenda dispatcher, Up: Agenda views 10.3 The built-in agenda views ============================== In this section we describe the built-in views. * Menu: * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review  File: org, Node: Weekly/daily agenda, Next: Global TODO list, Up: Built-in agenda views 10.3.1 The weekly/daily agenda ------------------------------ The purpose of the weekly/daily _agenda_ is to act like a page of a paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day. `C-c a a (`org-agenda-list')' Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix(1) (like `C-u 2 1 C-c a a') you may set the number of days to be displayed. The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable `org-agenda-span' (or the obsolete `org-agenda-ndays'). This variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the agenda, or to a span name, such as `day', `week', `month' or `year'. For weekly agendas, the default is to start on the previous monday (see `org-agenda-start-on-weekday'). You can also set the start date using a date shift: `(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")' will start the agenda ten days from today in the future. Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer. The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in *note Agenda commands::. Calendar/Diary integration .......................... Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with the diary. In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's agenda, you only need to customize the variable (setq org-agenda-include-diary t) After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the agenda buffer created by Org mode. , , and can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary file in order to edit existing diary entries. The `i' command to insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as well as the commands `S', `M', and `C' to display Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other calendars, respectively. `c' can be used to switch back and forth between calendar and agenda. If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example, the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries will be made in the agenda: * Holidays :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Holiday :END: %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names * Birthdays :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Ann :END: %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)(2) Arthur Dent is %d years old %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old Anniversaries from BBDB ....................... If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the following to one of your agenda files: * Anniversaries :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Anniv :END: %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries) You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically, you need to press `C-o anniversary ' with the cursor in a BBDB record and then add the date in the format `YYYY-MM-DD' or `MM-DD', followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (`birthday' or `wedding', or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to `birthday'. Here are a few examples, the header for the file `org-bbdb.el' contains more detailed information. 1973-06-22 06-22 1955-08-02 wedding 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast--much faster in fact than a long list of `%%(diary-anniversary)' entries in an Org or Diary file. If you would like to see upcoming anniversaries with a bit of forewarning, you can use the following instead: * Anniversaries :PROPERTIES: :CATEGORY: Anniv :END: %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries-future 3) That will give you three days' warning: on the anniversary date itself and the two days prior. The argument is optional: if omitted, it defaults to 7. Appointment reminders ..................... Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the appointments of your agenda files, use the command `org-agenda-to-appt'. This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression. It also reads a `APPT_WARNTIME' property which will then override the value of `appt-message-warning-time' for this appointment. See the docstring for details. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) For backward compatibility, the universal prefix `C-u' causes all TODO entries to be listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO list, or a block agenda instead (*note Block agenda::). (2) `org-anniversary' is just like `diary-anniversary', but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of `calendar-date-style'.  File: org, Node: Global TODO list, Next: Matching tags and properties, Prev: Weekly/daily agenda, Up: Built-in agenda views 10.3.2 The global TODO list --------------------------- The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and collected into a single place. `C-c a t (`org-todo-list')' Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda files (*note Agenda views::) into a single buffer. By default, this lists items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in `agenda-mode', so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries directly from that buffer (*note Agenda commands::). `C-c a T (`org-todo-list')' Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to `C-c a t'. You are prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by separating them with `|' as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in `org-todo-keywords' is selected. The `r' key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword, for example `3 r'. If you often need a search for a specific keyword, define a custom command for it (*note Agenda dispatcher::). Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags search (*note Tag searches::). Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the TODO list are described in *note Agenda commands::. Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep it more compact: - Some people view a TODO item that has been _scheduled_ for execution or have a _deadline_ (*note Timestamps::) as no longer _open_. Configure the variables `org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled', `org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines', `org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp' and/or `org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date' to exclude such items from the global TODO list. - TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable `org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels' to get this behavior.  File: org, Node: Matching tags and properties, Next: Search view, Prev: Global TODO list, Up: Built-in agenda views 10.3.3 Matching tags and properties ----------------------------------- If headlines in the agenda files are marked with _tags_ (*note Tags::), or have properties (*note Properties and columns::), you can select headlines based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with `C-c / m'. `C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic expression with tags, like `+work+urgent-withboss' or `work|home' (*note Tags::). If you often need a specific search, define a custom command for it (*note Agenda dispatcher::). `C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' Like `C-c a m', but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). To exclude scheduled/deadline items, see the variable `org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options'. Matching specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see *note Tag searches::. The commands available in the tags list are described in *note Agenda commands::. Match syntax ............ A search string can use Boolean operators `&' for `AND' and `|' for `OR'. `&' binds more strongly than `|'. Parentheses are not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular expression matching tags, or an expression like `PROPERTY OPERATOR VALUE' with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element may be preceded by `-', to select against it, and `+' is syntactic sugar for positive selection. The `AND' operator `&' is optional when `+' or `-' is present. Here are some examples, using only tags. `work' Select headlines tagged `:work:'. `work&boss' Select headlines tagged `:work:' and `:boss:'. `+work-boss' Select headlines tagged `:work:', but discard those also tagged `:boss:'. `work|laptop' Selects lines tagged `:work:' or `:laptop:'. `work|laptop+night' Like before, but require the `:laptop:' lines to be tagged also `:night:'. Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly braces. For example, `work+{^boss.*}' matches headlines that contain the tag `:work:' and any tag starting with `boss'. Group tags (*note Tag hierarchy::) are expanded as regular expressions. E.g., if `:work:' is a group tag for the group `:work:lab:conf:', then searching for `work' will search for `{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}' and searching for `-work' will search for all headlines but those with one of the tags in the group (i.e., `-{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}'). You may also test for properties (*note Properties and columns::) at the same time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special properties that represent other metadata (*note Special properties::). For example, the "property" `TODO' represents the TODO keyword of the entry and the "property" `PRIORITY' represents the PRIORITY keyword of the entry. In addition to the properties mentioned above, `LEVEL' represents the level of an entry. So a search `+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"' lists all level three headlines that have the tag `boss' and are _not_ marked with the TODO keyword DONE. In buffers with `org-odd-levels-only' set, `LEVEL' does not count the number of stars, but `LEVEL=2' will correspond to 3 stars etc. Here are more examples: `work+TODO="WAITING"' Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO keyword `WAITING'. `work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"' Waiting tasks both at work and at home. When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test the value of a property. Here is a complex example: +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \ +With={Sarah\|Denny}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>" The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written: - If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done, and the allowed operators are `<', `=', `>', `<=', `>=', and `<>'. - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes, a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed. - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes _and_ angular brackets (like `DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"'), both values are assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized are `""' for now (including time), and `""', and `""' for these days at 00:00 hours, i.e., without a time specification. Also strings like `"<+5d>"' or `"<-2m>"' with units `d', `w', `m', and `y' for day, week, month, and year, respectively, can be used. - If the comparison value is enclosed in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with `=' meaning that the regexp matches the property value, and `<>' meaning that it does not match. So the search string in the example finds entries tagged `:work:' but not `:boss:', which also have a priority value `A', a `:Coffee:' property with the value `unlimited', an `Effort' property that is numerically smaller than 2, a `:With:' property that is matched by the regular expression `Sarah\|Denny', and that are scheduled on or after October 11, 2008. You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See *note Property inheritance::, for details. For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms connected with `|') with a `/' and then specify a Boolean expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND. However, _negative selection_ combined with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use `C-c a M', or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with `!'. Using `C-c a M' or `/!' will not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples: `work/WAITING' Same as `work+TODO="WAITING"' `work/!-WAITING-NEXT' Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are neither `WAITING' nor `NEXT' `work/!+WAITING|+NEXT' Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are either `WAITING' or `NEXT'.  File: org, Node: Search view, Next: Stuck projects, Prev: Matching tags and properties, Up: Built-in agenda views 10.3.4 Search view ------------------ This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries. It is particularly useful to find notes. `C-c a s (`org-search-view')' This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring or specific words using a boolean logic. For example, the search string `computer equipment' will find entries that contain `computer equipment' as a substring. If the two words are separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match. Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean logic. The search string `+computer +wifi -ethernet -{8\.11[bg]}' will search for note entries that contain the keywords `computer' and `wifi', but not the keyword `ethernet', and which are also not matched by the regular expression `8\.11[bg]', meaning to exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first `+' is necessary to turn on word search, other `+' characters are optional. For more details, see the docstring of the command `org-search-view'. Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search the files listed in `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'.  File: org, Node: Stuck projects, Prev: Search view, Up: Built-in agenda views 10.3.5 Stuck projects --------------------- If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your work, one of the "duties" you have is a regular review to make sure that all projects move along. A _stuck_ project is a project that has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such projects and define next actions for them. `C-c a # (`org-agenda-list-stuck-projects')' List projects that are stuck. `C-c a !' Customize the variable `org-stuck-projects' to define what a stuck project is and how to find it. You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION. Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @SHOP indicates shopping and is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects with a tags/todo match(1) `+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE', and then check for TODO, NEXT, @SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The correct customization for this is (setq org-stuck-projects '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@SHOP") "\\")) Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry will still be searched for stuck projects. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) *Note Tag searches::.  File: org, Node: Presentation and sorting, Next: Agenda commands, Prev: Built-in agenda views, Up: Agenda views 10.4 Presentation and sorting ============================= Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts with a _prefix_ that contains the _category_ (*note Categories::) of the item and other important information. You can customize in which column tags will be displayed through `org-agenda-tags-column'. You can also customize the prefix using the option `org-agenda-prefix-format'. This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline associated with the item. * Menu: * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time * Sorting agenda items:: The order of things * Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda  File: org, Node: Categories, Next: Time-of-day specifications, Up: Presentation and sorting 10.4.1 Categories ----------------- The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default, the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this: #+CATEGORY: Thesis If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a (sub)tree, give the entry a `:CATEGORY:' property with the special category you want to apply as the value. The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not longer than 10 characters. You can set up icons for category by customizing the `org-agenda-category-icon-alist' variable.  File: org, Node: Time-of-day specifications, Next: Sorting agenda items, Prev: Categories, Up: Presentation and sorting 10.4.2 Time-of-day specifications --------------------------------- Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the agenda, for example as in `<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>'. Time ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like `<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>'. In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as plain text (like `12:45' or a `8:30-1pm'). If the agenda integrates the Emacs diary (*note Weekly/daily agenda::), time specifications in diary entries are recognized as well. For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this: 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like 8:00...... ------------------ 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer 10:00...... ------------------ 12:00...... ------------------ 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub 14:00...... ------------------ 16:00...... ------------------ 18:00...... ------------------ 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem 20:00...... ------------------ 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable `org-agenda-use-time-grid', and can be configured with `org-agenda-time-grid'.  File: org, Node: Sorting agenda items, Next: Filtering/limiting agenda items, Prev: Time-of-day specifications, Up: Presentation and sorting 10.4.3 Sorting agenda items --------------------------- Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is done depends on the type of view. * For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning of the list, as a _schedule_ for the day. After that, items remain grouped in categories, in the sequence given by `org-agenda-files'. Within each category, items are sorted by priority (*note Priorities::), which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority `A', 1000 for `B', and 0 for `C'), plus additional increments for overdue scheduled or deadline items. * For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within each category, sorting takes place according to priority (*note Priorities::). The priority used for sorting derives from the priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due or scheduled date. * For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the sequence in which they are found in the agenda files. Sorting can be customized using the variable `org-agenda-sorting-strategy', and may also include criteria based on the estimated effort of an entry (*note Effort estimates::).  File: org, Node: Filtering/limiting agenda items, Prev: Sorting agenda items, Up: Presentation and sorting 10.4.4 Filtering/limiting agenda items -------------------------------------- Agenda built-in or customized commands are statically defined. Agenda filters and limits provide two ways of dynamically narrowing down the list of agenda entries: _filters_ and _limits_. Filters only act on the display of the items, while limits take effect before the list of agenda entries is built. Filters are more often used interactively, while limits are mostly useful when defined as local variables within custom agenda commands. Filtering in the agenda ....................... `/ (`org-agenda-filter-by-tag')' Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates. The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without having to recreate the agenda.(1) You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; will mean any tag at all. Pressing at that prompt will offer use completion to select a tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg, remove the entries that _do_ have the tag. A second `/' at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. Pressing `+' or `-' switches between filtering and excluding the next tag. Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable `org-agenda-auto-exclude-function' is set to a user-defined function, that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda automatically. Once this is set, the `/' command then accepts `RET' as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's say you use a `Net' tag to identify tasks which need network access, an `Errand' tag for errands in town, and a `Call' tag for making phone calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this: (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag) (and (cond ((string= tag "Net") (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org"))) ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call")) (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time)))) (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21))))) (concat "-" tag))) (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function) `[ ] { }' in search view add new search words (`[' and `]') or new regular expressions (`{' and `}') to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will add a positive search term prefixed by `+', indicating that this search term must occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a negative search term which must not occur/match in the entry for it to be selected. `< (`org-agenda-filter-by-category')' Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at point. Pressing `<' another time will remove this filter. When called with a prefix argument exclude the category of the item at point from the agenda. You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option `org-agenda-category-filter-preset'. *Note Setting options::. `^ (`org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline')' Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent headline of the one at point. `= (`org-agenda-filter-by-regexp')' Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda entries matching the regular expression the user entered. When called with a prefix argument, it will filter _out_ entries matching the regexp. With two universal prefix arguments, it will remove all the regexp filters, which can be accumulated. You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option `org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset'. *Note Setting options::. `_ (`org-agenda-filter-by-effort')' Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates. You first need to set up allowed efforts globally, for example (setq org-global-properties '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00"))) You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of `<', `>', and `=', and then the one-digit index of an effort estimate in your array of allowed values, where `0' means the 10th value. The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or larger-or-equal than the selected value. For application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated according to the value of `org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high'. When called with a prefix argument, it will remove entries matching the condition. With two universal prefix arguments, it will clear effort filters, which can be accumulated. You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the option `org-agenda-effort-filter-preset'. *Note Setting options::. `| (`org-agenda-filter-remove-all')' Remove all filters in the current agenda view. Setting limits for the agenda ............................. Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or locally in your custom agenda views (*note Custom agenda views::). `org-agenda-max-entries' Limit the number of entries. `org-agenda-max-effort' Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes). `org-agenda-max-todos' Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords. `org-agenda-max-tags' Limit the number of tagged entries. When set to a positive integer, each option will exclude entries from other categories: for example, `(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)' will limit the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry that has no effort property. If you want to include entries with no effort property, use a negative value for `org-agenda-max-effort'. One useful setup is to use `org-agenda-max-entries' locally in a custom command. For example, this custom command will display the next five entries with a `NEXT' TODO keyword. (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("n" todo "NEXT" ((org-agenda-max-entries 5))))) Once you mark one of these five entry as `DONE', rebuilding the agenda will again the next five entries again, including the first entry that was excluded so far. You can also dynamically set temporary limits, which will be lost when rebuilding the agenda: `~ (`org-agenda-limit-interactively')' This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Custom commands can preset a filter by binding the variable `org-agenda-tag-filter-preset' as an option. This filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of the entire agenda view--in a block agenda, you should only set this in the global options section, not in the section of an individual block.  File: org, Node: Agenda commands, Next: Custom agenda views, Prev: Presentation and sorting, Up: Agenda views 10.5 Commands in the agenda buffer ================================== Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the original entry location, and to edit the Org files "remotely" from the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once, removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge. Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line. Motion ...... `n (`org-agenda-next-line')' Next line (same as and `C-n'). `p (`org-agenda-previous-line')' Previous line (same as and `C-p'). `N (`org-agenda-next-item')' Next item: same as next line, but only consider items. `P (`org-agenda-previous-item')' Previous item: same as previous line, but only consider items. View/Go to Org file ................... ` or mouse-3 (`org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up')' Display the original location of the item in another window. With prefix arg, make sure that drawers stay folded. `L (`org-agenda-recenter')' Display original location and recenter that window. ` or mouse-2 (`org-agenda-goto')' Go to the original location of the item in another window. ` (`org-agenda-switch-to')' Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows. `F (`org-agenda-follow-mode')' Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set with the variable `org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode'. `C-c C-x b (`org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer')' Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is negative, go up that many levels. With a `C-u' prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect buffer. `C-c C-o (`org-agenda-open-link')' Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it will be followed without a selection prompt. Change display .............. `A' Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view. `o' Delete other windows. `v d or short d (`org-agenda-day-view')' `v w or short w (`org-agenda-week-view')' `v t (`org-agenda-fortnight-view')' `v m (`org-agenda-month-view')' `v y (`org-agenda-year-view')' `v SPC (`org-agenda-reset-view')' Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, `32 d' jumps to February 1st, `9 w' to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example, `200712 w' will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval 1938-2037. `v ' will reset to what is set in `org-agenda-span'. `f (`org-agenda-later')' Go forward in time to display the following `org-agenda-current-span' days. For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix arg, go forward that many times `org-agenda-current-span' days. `b (`org-agenda-earlier')' Go backward in time to display earlier dates. `. (`org-agenda-goto-today')' Go to today. `j (`org-agenda-goto-date')' Prompt for a date and go there. `J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')' Go to the currently clocked-in task in the agenda buffer. `D (`org-agenda-toggle-diary')' Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See *note Weekly/daily agenda::. `v l or short l (`org-agenda-log-mode')' Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while logging was on (variable `org-log-done') are shown in the agenda, as are entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry types that should be included in log mode using the variable `org-agenda-log-mode-items'. When called with a `C-u' prefix, show all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two prefix arguments `C-u C-u', show only logging information, nothing else. `v L' is equivalent to `C-u v l'. `v [ or short [ (`org-agenda-manipulate-query-add')' Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily agenda. `v a (`org-agenda-archives-mode')' `v A (`org-agenda-archives-mode 'files')' Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked `ARCHIVED' are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the capital `A', even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode, press `v a' again. `v R or short R (`org-agenda-clockreport-mode')' Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will always show a table with the clocked times for the time span and file scope covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set with the variable `org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode'. By using a prefix argument when toggling this mode (i.e., `C-u R'), the clock table will not show contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering(1). See also the variable `org-clock-report-include-clocking-task'. `v c' Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them manually. See the variable `org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks' for information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking problem. To return to normal agenda display, press `l' to exit Logbook mode. `v E or short E (`org-agenda-entry-text-mode')' Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line. The maximum number of lines is given by the variable `org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines'. Calling this command with a numeric prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value. `G (`org-agenda-toggle-time-grid')' Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables `org-agenda-use-time-grid' and `org-agenda-time-grid'. `r (`org-agenda-redo')' Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after modification of the timestamps of items with `S-' and `S-'. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO keyword. `g (`org-agenda-redo')' Same as `r'. `C-x C-s or short s (`org-save-all-org-buffers')' Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of IDs. `C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')' Invoke column view (*note Column view::) in the agenda buffer. The column view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a `#+COLUMNS' line, or from the default variable `org-columns-default-format'), will be used in the agenda. `C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a file or subtree (*note Agenda files::). Secondary filtering and query editing ..................................... For a detailed description of these commands, *note Filtering/limiting agenda items::. `/ (`org-agenda-filter-by-tag')' Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates. `< (`org-agenda-filter-by-category')' Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at point. `^ (`org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline')' Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and the parent headline of the one at point. `= (`org-agenda-filter-by-regexp')' Filter the agenda view by a regular expression. `_ (`org-agenda-filter-by-effort')' Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates. `| (`org-agenda-filter-remove-all')' Remove all filters in the current agenda view. Remote editing .............. `0--9' Digit argument. `C-_ (`org-agenda-undo')' Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer. `t (`org-agenda-todo')' Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the original org file. `C-S- (`org-agenda-todo-nextset')' `C-S- (`org-agenda-todo-previousset')' Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords. `C-k (`org-agenda-kill')' Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See variable `org-agenda-confirm-kill'. `C-c C-w (`org-agenda-refile')' Refile the entry at point. `C-c C-x C-a or short a (`org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation')' Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default archiving command set in `org-archive-default-command'. When using the `a' key, confirmation will be required. `C-c C-x a (`org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag')' Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. `C-c C-x A (`org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling')' Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its _archive sibling_. `C-c C-x C-s or short $ (`org-agenda-archive')' Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a different file. `T (`org-agenda-show-tags')' Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have turned off `org-agenda-show-inherited-tags', but still want to see all tags of a headline occasionally. `: (`org-agenda-set-tags')' Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region. `,' Set the priority for the current item (`org-agenda-priority'). Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with , the priority cookie is removed from the entry. `P (`org-agenda-show-priority')' Display weighted priority of current item. `+ or S- (`org-agenda-priority-up')' Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the `r' key for this. `- or S- (`org-agenda-priority-down')' Decrease the priority of the current item. `z or C-c C-z (`org-agenda-add-note')' Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the same location where state change notes are put. Depending on `org-log-into-drawer', this may be inside a drawer. `C-c C-a (`org-attach')' Dispatcher for all command related to attachments. `C-c C-s (`org-agenda-schedule')' Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp `C-c C-d (`org-agenda-deadline')' Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline. `S- (`org-agenda-do-date-later')' Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move it to today. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example, `3 6 5 S-' will change it by a year. With a `C-u' prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double `C-u C-u' prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected in the agenda buffer. Use `r' or `g' to update the buffer. `S- (`org-agenda-do-date-earlier')' Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the past. `> (`org-agenda-date-prompt')' Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key `>' has been chosen, because it is the same as `S-.' on my keyboard. `I (`org-agenda-clock-in')' Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it is stopped first. `O (`org-agenda-clock-out')' Stop the previously started clock. `X (`org-agenda-clock-cancel')' Cancel the currently running clock. `J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')' Jump to the running clock in another window. `k (`org-agenda-capture')' Like `org-capture', but use the date at point as the default date for the capture template. See `org-capture-use-agenda-date' to make this the default behavior of `org-capture'. Dragging agenda lines forward/backward ...................................... `M- (`org-agenda-drag-line-backward')' Drag the line at point backward one line(2). With a numeric prefix argument, drag backward by that many lines. `M- (`org-agenda-drag-line-forward')' Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix argument, drag forward by that many lines. Bulk remote editing selected entries .................................... `m (`org-agenda-bulk-mark')' Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With numeric prefix argument, mark that many successive entries. `* (`org-agenda-bulk-mark-all')' Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action. `u (`org-agenda-bulk-unmark')' Unmark entry at point for bulk action. `U (`org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks')' Unmark all marked entries for bulk action. `M-m (`org-agenda-bulk-toggle')' Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action. `M-* (`org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all')' Toggle marks of all visible entries for bulk action. `% (`org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp')' Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action. `B (`org-agenda-bulk-action')' Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to `B' will be passed through to the `s' and `d' commands, to bulk-remove these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If you want them to persist, set `org-agenda-persistent-marks' to `t' or hit `p' at the prompt. `*' Toggle persistent marks. `$' Archive all selected entries. `A' Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings. `t' Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps). `+' Add a tag to all selected entries. `-' Remove a tag from all selected entries. `s' Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus at the prompt, for example `++8d' or `++2w'. `d' Set deadline to a specific date. `r' Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (`g') to bring them back. `S' Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix arg (`C-u B S'), scatter only across weekdays. `f' Apply a function(3) to marked entries. For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the entries to web. (defun set-category () (interactive "P") (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker) (org-agenda-error))) (buffer (marker-buffer marker))) (with-current-buffer buffer (save-excursion (save-restriction (widen) (goto-char marker) (org-back-to-heading t) (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web")))))) Calendar commands ................. `c (`org-agenda-goto-calendar')' Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor. `c (`org-calendar-goto-agenda')' When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the date at the cursor. `i (`org-agenda-diary-entry')' Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary file(4), in a way similar to the `i' command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where you can add the entry. If you configure `org-agenda-diary-file' to point to an Org mode file, Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be built under an entry with a `DATE_TREE' property, or else with years as top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text--if you specify it, the entry will be created in `org-agenda-diary-file' without further interaction. If you directly press at the prompt without typing text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the entry there. See also the `k r' command. `M (`org-agenda-phases-of-moon')' Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date. `S (`org-agenda-sunrise-sunset')' Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar. `C (`org-agenda-convert-date')' Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic calendars. `H (`org-agenda-holidays')' Show holidays for three months around the cursor date. `M-x org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files RET' Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files. This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu. Exporting to a file ................... `C-x C-w (`org-agenda-write')' Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (`.html' or `.htm'), Postscript (`.ps'), PDF (`.pdf'), Org (`.org') and plain text (any other extension). When exporting to Org, only the body of original headlines are exported, not subtrees or inherited tags. When called with a `C-u' prefix argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to set options for `ps-print' and for `htmlize' to be used during export. Quit and Exit ............. `q (`org-agenda-quit')' Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer. `x (`org-agenda-exit')' Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to visit Org files will not be removed. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Only tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored. (2) Moving agenda lines does not persist after an agenda refresh and does not modify the contributing `.org' files (3) You can also create persistent custom functions through `org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions'. (4) This file is parsed for the agenda when `org-agenda-include-diary' is set.  File: org, Node: Custom agenda views, Next: Exporting agenda views, Prev: Agenda commands, Up: Agenda views 10.6 Custom agenda views ======================== Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::), just like the default commands. * Menu: * Storing searches:: Type once, use often * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer * Setting options:: Changing the rules  File: org, Node: Storing searches, Next: Block agenda, Up: Custom agenda views 10.6.1 Storing searches ----------------------- The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current buffer). Custom commands are configured in the variable `org-agenda-custom-commands'. You can customize this variable, for example by pressing `C-c a C'. You can also directly set it with Emacs Lisp in the Emacs init file. The following example contains all valid agenda views: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("x" agenda) ("y" agenda*) ("w" todo "WAITING") ("W" todo-tree "WAITING") ("u" tags "+boss-urgent") ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent") ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent") ("f" occur-tree "\\") ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa") ("hp" tags "+home+Peter") ("hk" tags "+home+Kim"))) The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press after the dispatcher command `C-c a' in order to access the command. Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a prefix key(1). The second parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The example above will therefore define: `C-c a x' as a global search for agenda entries planned(2) this week/day. `C-c a y' as a global search for agenda entries planned this week/day, but only those with an hour specification like `[h]h:mm'--think of them as appointments. `C-c a w' as a global search for TODO entries with `WAITING' as the TODO keyword `C-c a W' as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the results as a sparse tree `C-c a u' as a global tags search for headlines marked `:boss:' but not `:urgent:' `C-c a v' as the same search as `C-c a u', but limiting the search to headlines that are also TODO items `C-c a U' as the same search as `C-c a u', but only in the current buffer and displaying the result as a sparse tree `C-c a f' to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries containing the word `FIXME' `C-c a h' as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an additional key (`l', `p' or `k') to select a name (Lisa, Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match. Note that the `*-tree' agenda views need to be called from an Org buffer as they operate on the current buffer only. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) You can provide a description for a prefix key by inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description. (2) _Planned_ means here that these entries have some planning information attached to them, like a time-stamp, a scheduled or a deadline string. See `org-agenda-entry-types' on how to set what planning information will be taken into account.  File: org, Node: Block agenda, Next: Setting options, Prev: Storing searches, Up: Custom agenda views 10.6.2 Block agenda ------------------- Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise the results of _several_ commands, each of which creates a block in the agenda buffer. The available commands include `agenda' for the daily or weekly agenda (as created with `C-c a a'), `alltodo' for the global TODO list (as constructed with `C-c a t'), and the matching commands discussed above: `todo', `tags', and `tags-todo'. Here are two examples: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden"))) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "work") (tags "office"))))) This will define `C-c a h' to create a multi-block view for stuff you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag `home', and also all lines tagged with `garden'. Finally the command `C-c a o' provides a similar view for office tasks.  File: org, Node: Setting options, Prev: Block agenda, Up: Custom agenda views 10.6.3 Setting options for custom commands ------------------------------------------ Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the right spot in `org-agenda-custom-commands'. For example: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("w" todo "WAITING" ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)) (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: "))) ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent" ((org-show-context-detail 'minimal))) ("N" search "" ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org")) (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil))))) Now the `C-c a w' command will sort the collected entries only by priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say ` Mixed: ' instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of `C-c a U' will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match will be shown. The command `C-c a N' will do a text search limited to only a single file. For command sets creating a block agenda, `org-agenda-custom-commands' has two separate spots for setting options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block agenda example (*note Block agenda::), let's change the sorting strategy for the `C-c a h' commands to `priority-down', but let's sort the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order, `priority-up'. This would look like this: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden" ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up))))) ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)))) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "work") (tags "office"))))) As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex. When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable--it fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in this interface, the _values_ are just Lisp expressions. So if the value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value yourself. To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific context, you can customize `org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts'. Let's say for example that you have an agenda command `"o"' displaying a view that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option like this: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) You can also tell that the command key `"o"' should refer to another command key `"r"'. In that case, add this command key like this: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) See the docstring of the variable for more information.  File: org, Node: Exporting agenda views, Next: Agenda column view, Prev: Custom agenda views, Up: Agenda views 10.7 Exporting agenda views =========================== If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML(1), Postscript, PDF(2), and iCalendar files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the command `C-x C-w (`org-agenda-write')' Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension `.html' or `.htm'), Postscript (extension `.ps'), iCalendar (extension `.ics'), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to set options for `ps-print' and for `htmlize' to be used during export, for example (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings '((ps-number-of-columns 2) (ps-landscape-mode t) (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5) (htmlize-output-type 'css))) If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate any custom agenda command with a list of output file names (3). Here is an example that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them. Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory, or absolute. (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps")) ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps")) ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" ((agenda "") (tags-todo "home") (tags "garden")) nil ("~/views/home.html")) ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" ((agenda) (tags-todo "work") (tags "office")) nil ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics")))) The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is `.html', Org mode will try to use the `htmlize.el' package to convert the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is `.ps', `ps-print-buffer-with-faces' is used to produce Postscript output. If the extension is `.ics', iCalendar export is run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other extension produces a plain ASCII file. The export files are _not_ created when you use one of those commands interactively because this might use too much overhead. Instead, there is a special command to produce _all_ specified files in one step: `C-c a e (`org-store-agenda-views')' Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with them. You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also set options for the export commands. For example: (setq org-agenda-custom-commands '(("X" agenda "" ((ps-number-of-columns 2) (ps-landscape-mode t) (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ") (org-agenda-with-colors nil) (org-agenda-remove-tags t)) ("theagenda.ps")))) This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it print in two columns in landscape format--the resulting page can be cut in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the black-and-white printer. Settings specified in `org-agenda-exporter-settings' will also apply, but the settings in `org-agenda-custom-commands' take precedence. From the command line you may also use emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill or, if you need to modify some parameters(4) emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \ org-agenda-span (quote month) \ org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \ org-agenda-include-diary nil \ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ -kill which will create the agenda views restricted to the file `~/org/project.org', without diary entries and with a 30-day extent. You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further processing by other programs. See *note Extracting agenda information::, for more information. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) You need to install `htmlize.el' from Hrvoje Niksic's repository. (https://github.com/hniksic/emacs-htmlize) (2) To create PDF output, the ghostscript `ps2pdf' utility must be installed on the system. Selecting a PDF file will also create the postscript file. (3) If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for them in order to be able to specify file names. (4) Quoting depends on the system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.  File: org, Node: Agenda column view, Prev: Exporting agenda views, Up: Agenda views 10.8 Using column view in the agenda ==================================== Column view (*note Column view::) is normally used to view and edit properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are collected by certain criteria. `C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')' Turn on column view in the agenda. To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment. This causes the following issues: 1. Org needs to make a decision which `COLUMNS' format to use. Since the entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files may have different `COLUMNS' formats, this is a non-trivial problem. Org first checks if the variable `org-agenda-overriding-columns-format' is currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item does not have a specific format--defined in a property, or in its file--it uses `org-columns-default-format'. 2. If any of the columns has a summary type defined (*note Column attributes::), turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is also true for the special `CLOCKSUM' property. Org will then sum the values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry _twice_--for example as scheduled and as a deadline--and it may show two entries from the same hierarchy--for example a _parent_ and its _child_. In these cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because some values will count double. 3. When the column view in the agenda shows the `CLOCKSUM', that is always the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with a column listing the planned total effort for a task--one of the major applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press `R' in the agenda). 4. When the column view in the agenda shows the `CLOCKSUM_T', that is always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already spent --via `CLOCKSUM'--and with the planned total effort for it.  File: org, Node: Markup, Next: Exporting, Prev: Agenda views, Up: Top 11 Markup for rich export ************************* When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since export targets like HTML and LaTeX allow much richer formatting, Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer. * Menu: * Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. * Horizontal rules:: Make a line * Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents  File: org, Node: Paragraphs, Next: Emphasis and monospace, Up: Markup 11.1 Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting ========================================= Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce a line break within a paragraph, use `\\' at the end of a line. To preserve the line breaks, indentation and blank lines in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry. #+BEGIN_VERSE Great clouds overhead Tiny black birds rise and fall Snow covers Emacs -- AlexSchroeder #+END_VERSE When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You can include quotations in Org mode documents like this: #+BEGIN_QUOTE Everything should be made as simple as possible, but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein #+END_QUOTE If you would like to center some text, do it like this: #+BEGIN_CENTER Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\ but not any simpler #+END_CENTER  File: org, Node: Emphasis and monospace, Next: Horizontal rules, Prev: Paragraphs, Up: Markup 11.2 Emphasis and monospace =========================== You can make words *bold*, /italic/, _underlined_, `=verbatim=' and `~code~', and, if you must, `+strike-through+'. Text in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific syntax, it is exported verbatim. To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set `org-fontify-emphasized-text' to `nil'. To narrow down the list of available markup syntax, you can customize `org-emphasis-alist'. To fine tune what characters are allowed before and after the markup characters, you can tweak `org-emphasis-regexp-components'. Beware that changing one of the above variables will no take effect until you reload Org, for which you may need to restart Emacs.  File: org, Node: Horizontal rules, Next: Images and tables, Prev: Emphasis and monospace, Up: Markup 11.3 Horizontal rules ===================== A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as a horizontal line.  File: org, Node: Images and tables, Next: Literal examples, Prev: Horizontal rules, Up: Markup 11.4 Images and Tables ====================== Both the native Org mode tables (*note Tables::) and tables formatted with the `table.el' package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables, the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to the object with `[[tab:basic-data]]' (*note Internal links::): #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link) #+NAME: tab:basic-data | ... | ...| |-----|----| Optionally, the caption can take the form: #+CAPTION[Caption for list of tables]: Caption for table. Some back-ends allow you to directly include images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have a description part, for example `[[./img/a.jpg]]'. If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede it with `#+CAPTION' and `#+NAME' as follows: #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table) #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049 [[./img/a.jpg]] Such images can be displayed within the buffer. *Note the discussion of image links: Handling links. Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned structures, the same caption mechanism can apply to many others (e.g., LaTeX equations, source code blocks). Depending on the export back-end, those may or may not be handled.  File: org, Node: Literal examples, Next: Special symbols, Prev: Images and tables, Up: Markup 11.5 Literal examples ===================== You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited for source code and similar examples. #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE Some example from a text file. #+END_EXAMPLE Note that such blocks may be indented in order to align nicely with indented text and in particular with plain list structure (*note Plain lists::). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional whitespace before the colon: Here is an example : Some example from a text file. If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to look like the fontified Emacs buffer(1). This is done with the `src' block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the example(2), see *note Easy templates:: for shortcuts to easily insert code blocks. #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_SRC Both in `example' and in `src' snippets, you can add a `-n' switch to the end of the `BEGIN' line, to get the lines of the example numbered. The `-n' takes an optional numeric argument specifying the starting line number of the block. If you use a `+n' switch, the numbering from the previous numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. The `+n' can also take a numeric argument. The value of the argument will be added to the last line of the previous block to determine the starting line number. #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n 20 ;; this will export with line number 20 (message "This is line 21") #+END_SRC #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp +n 10 ;; This will be listed as line 31 (message "This is line 32") #+END_SRC In literal examples, Org will interpret strings like `(ref:name)' as labels, and use them as targets for special hyperlinks like `[[(name)]]' (i.e., the reference name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of cool. You can also add a `-r' switch which removes the labels from the source code(3). With the `-n' switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses. Here is an example: #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r (save-excursion (ref:sc) (goto-char (point-min))) (ref:jump) #+END_SRC In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]] jumps to point-min. Finally, you can use `-i' to preserve the indentation of a specific code block (*note Editing source code::). If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a `-l' switch to change the format, for example `#+BEGIN_SRC pascal -n -r -l "((%s))"'. See also the variable `org-coderef-label-format'. HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (*note Text areas in HTML export::). Because the `#+BEGIN_...' and `#+END_...' patterns need to be added so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy templates facility (*note Easy templates::). `C-c '' Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by pressing `C-c '' again(4). The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited using `artist-mode'(5) to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new fixed-width region. `C-c l' Calling `org-store-link' while editing a source code example in a temporary buffer created with `C-c '' will prompt for a label. Make sure that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper formatting like `(ref:label)' at the end of the current line. Then the label is stored as a link `(label)', for retrieval with `C-c C-l'. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) This works automatically for the HTML back-end (it requires version 1.34 of the `htmlize.el' package, which you need to install). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be achieved using either the listings (https://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/macros/latex/contrib/listings/?lang=en) or the minted (https://github.com/gpoore/minted) package. If you use minted or listing, you must load the packages manually, for example by adding the desired package to `org-latex-packages-alist'. Refer to `org-latex-listings' for details. (2) Code in `src' blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export. *Note Working with source code::, for more information on evaluating code blocks. (3) Adding `-k' to `-n -r' will keep the labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code. (4) Upon exit, lines starting with `*', `,*', `#+' and `,#+' will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These commas will be stripped for editing with `C-c '', and also for export. (5) You may select a different-mode with the variable `org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode'.  File: org, Node: Special symbols, Next: Subscripts and superscripts, Prev: Literal examples, Up: Markup 11.6 Special symbols ==================== You can use LaTeX-like syntax to insert special symbols--named entities--like `\alpha' to indicate the Greek letter, or `\to' to indicate an arrow. Completion for these symbols is available, just type `\' and maybe a few letters, and press `M-' to see possible completions. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it with a pair of curly brackets. For example Pro tip: Given a circle \Gamma of diameter d, the length of its circumference is \pi{}d. A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and LaTeX; you can comfortably browse the complete list from a dedicated buffer using the command `org-entities-help'. It is also possible to provide your own special symbols in the variable `org-entities-user'. During export, these symbols are transformed into the native format of the exporter back-end. Strings like `\alpha' are exported as `α' in the HTML output, and as `\(\alpha\)' in the LaTeX output. Similarly, `\nbsp' becomes ` ' in HTML and `~' in LaTeX. Entities may also be used as a may to escape markup in an Org document, e.g., `\under{}not underlined\under' exports as `_not underlined_'. If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use the following command(1): `C-c C-x \' Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character for display purposes only. In addition to regular entities defined above, Org exports in a special way(2) the following commonly used character combinations: `\-' is treated as a shy hyphen, `--' and `---' are converted into dashes, and `...' becomes a compact set of dots. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) You can turn this on by default by setting the variable `org-pretty-entities', or on a per-file base with the `#+STARTUP' option `entitiespretty'. (2) This behaviour can be disabled with `-' export setting (*note Export settings::).  File: org, Node: Subscripts and superscripts, Next: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Special symbols, Up: Markup 11.7 Subscripts and superscripts ================================ `^' and `_' are used to indicate super- and subscripts. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary--but OK--to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces. Those are, however, mandatory, when more than one word is involved. For example The radius of the sun is R_sun = 6.96 x 10^8 m. On the other hand, the radius of Alpha Centauri is R_{Alpha Centauri} = 1.28 x R_{sun}. If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the variable `org-use-sub-superscripts' to change this convention. For example, when setting this variable to `{}', `a_b' will not be interpreted as a subscript, but `a_{b}' will. `C-c C-x \' In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.  File: org, Node: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Subscripts and superscripts, Up: Markup 11.8 Embedded LaTeX =================== Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. LaTeX(1) is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding LaTeX code into its files, because many academics are used to writing and reading LaTeX source code, and because it can be readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export back-ends. * Menu: * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like? * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) LaTeX is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's TeX system. Many of the features described here as "LaTeX" are really from TeX, but for simplicity I am blurring this distinction.  File: org, Node: LaTeX fragments, Next: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX 11.8.1 LaTeX fragments ---------------------- Org mode can contain LaTeX math fragments, and it supports ways to process these for several export back-ends. When exporting to LaTeX, the code is left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org can use either MathJax (http://www.mathjax.org) (*note Math formatting in HTML export::) or transcode the math into images (see *note Previewing LaTeX fragments::). LaTeX fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following snippets will be identified as LaTeX source code: * Environments of any kind(1). The only requirement is that the `\begin' statement appears on a new line, at the beginning of the line or after whitespaces only. * Text within the usual LaTeX math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with currency specifications, single `$' characters are only recognized as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is directly attached to the `$' characters with no whitespace in between, and if the closing `$' is followed by whitespace or punctuation (parentheses and quotes are considered to be punctuation in this context). For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use `\(...\)' as inline math delimiters. For example: \begin{equation} x=\sqrt{b} \end{equation} If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be either $$ a=+\sqrt{2} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt{2} \]. LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable `org-export-with-latex'. The default setting is `t' which means MathJax for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and LaTeX back-ends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these lines: #+OPTIONS: tex:t Do the right thing automatically (MathJax) #+OPTIONS: tex:nil Do not process LaTeX fragments at all #+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim Verbatim export, for jsMath or so ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) When MathJax is used, only the environments recognized by MathJax will be processed. When `dvipng' program, `dvisvgm' program or `imagemagick' suite is used to create images, any LaTeX environment will be handled.  File: org, Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Next: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX 11.8.2 Previewing LaTeX fragments --------------------------------- If you have a working LaTeX installation and `dvipng', `dvisvgm' or `convert' installed(1), LaTeX fragments can be processed to produce images of the typeset expressions to be used for inclusion while exporting to HTML (see *note LaTeX fragments::), or for inline previewing within Org mode. You can customize the variables `org-format-latex-options' and `org-format-latex-header' to influence some aspects of the preview. In particular, the `:scale' (and for HTML export, `:html-scale') property of the former can be used to adjust the size of the preview images. `C-c C-x C-l' Produce a preview image of the LaTeX fragment at point and overlay it over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline, process the entire buffer. `C-c C-c' Remove the overlay preview images. You can turn on the previewing of all LaTeX fragments in a file with #+STARTUP: latexpreview To disable it, simply use #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) These are respectively available at `http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/', `http://dvisvgm.bplaced.net/' and from the `imagemagick' suite. Choose the converter by setting the variable `org-preview-latex-default-process' accordingly.  File: org, Node: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX 11.8.3 Using CDLaTeX to enter math ---------------------------------- CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a major LaTeX mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install `cdlatex.el' and `texmathp.el' (the latter comes also with AUCTeX) from `https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/cdlatex'. Don't use CDLaTeX mode itself under Org mode, but use the light version `org-cdlatex-mode' that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it on for the current buffer with `M-x org-cdlatex-mode RET', or for all Org files with (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex) When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode): * Environment templates can be inserted with `C-c {'. * The key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a LaTeX fragment(1). For example, will expand `fr' to `\frac{}{}' and position the cursor correctly inside the first brace. Another will get you into the second brace. Even outside fragments, will expand environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if you write `equ' at the beginning of a line and press , this abbreviation will be expanded to an `equation' environment. To get a list of all abbreviations, type `M-x cdlatex-command-help RET'. * Pressing `_' and `^' inside a LaTeX fragment will insert these characters together with a pair of braces. If you use to move out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable `cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts'). * Pressing the grave accent ``' followed by a character inserts math macros, also outside LaTeX fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds after the grave accent, a help window will pop up. * Pressing the apostrophe `'' followed by another character modifies the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds after the apostrophe, a help window will pop up. Character modification will work only inside LaTeX fragments; outside the quote is normal. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function `org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p'.  File: org, Node: Exporting, Next: Publishing, Prev: Markup, Up: Top 12 Exporting ************ Sometimes, you may want to pretty print your notes, publish them on the web or even share them with people not using Org. In these cases, the Org export facilities can be used to convert your documents to a variety of other formats, while retaining as much structure (*note Document structure::) and markup (*note Markup::) as possible. Libraries responsible for such translation are called back-ends. Org ships with the following ones * ascii (ASCII format) * beamer (LaTeX Beamer format) * html (HTML format) * icalendar (iCalendar format) * latex (LaTeX format) * md (Markdown format) * odt (OpenDocument Text format) * org (Org format) * texinfo (Texinfo format) * man (Man page format) Org also uses additional libraries located in `contrib/' directory (*note Installation::). Users can install additional export libraries for additional formats from the Emacs packaging system. For easy discovery, these packages have a common naming scheme: `ox-NAME', where NAME is one of the formats. For example, `ox-koma-letter' for `koma-letter' back-end. Org loads back-ends for the following formats by default: `ascii', `html', `icalendar', `latex' and `odt'. Org can load additional back-ends either of two ways: through the `org-export-backends' variable configuration; or, by requiring the library in the Emacs init file like this: (require 'ox-md) * Menu: * The export dispatcher:: The main interface * Export settings:: Common export settings * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents * Include files:: Include additional files into a document * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates * Comment lines:: What will not be exported * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding * Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML * LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF * Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text * Org export:: Exporting to Org * Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo * iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar * Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page * Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output * Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax  File: org, Node: The export dispatcher, Next: Export settings, Up: Exporting 12.1 The export dispatcher ========================== The export dispatcher is the main interface for Org's exports. A hierarchical menu presents the currently configured export formats. Options are shown as easy toggle switches on the same screen. Org also has a minimal prompt interface for the export dispatcher. When the variable `org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui' is set to a non-`nil' value, Org prompts in the minibuffer. To switch back to the hierarchical menu, press . `C-c C-e' (`org-export-dispatch') Invokes the export dispatcher interface. The options show default settings. The `C-u' prefix argument preserves options from the previous export, including any sub-tree selections. Org exports the entire buffer by default. If the Org buffer has an active region, then Org exports just that region. These are the export options, the key combinations that toggle them (*note Export settings::): `C-a' Toggles asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external Emacs process with a specially configured initialization file to complete the exporting process in the background thereby releasing the current interface. This is particularly useful when exporting long documents. Output from an asynchronous export is saved on the "the export stack". To view this stack, call the export dispatcher with a double `C-u' prefix argument. If already in the export dispatcher menu, `&' displays the stack. To make the background export process the default, customize the variable, `org-export-in-background'. `C-b' Toggle body-only export. Useful for excluding headers and footers in the export. Affects only those back-end formats that have such sections--like `...' in HTML. `C-s' Toggle sub-tree export. When turned on, Org exports only the sub-tree starting from the cursor position at the time the export dispatcher was invoked. Org uses the top heading of this sub-tree as the document's title. If the cursor is not on a heading, Org uses the nearest enclosing header. If the cursor is in the document preamble, Org signals an error and aborts export. To make the sub-tree export the default, customize the variable, `org-export-initial-scope'. `C-v' Toggle visible-only export. Useful for exporting only visible parts of an Org document by adjusting outline visibility settings.  File: org, Node: Export settings, Next: Table of contents, Prev: The export dispatcher, Up: Exporting 12.2 Export settings ==================== Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual file by making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (*note In-buffer settings::), by setting individual keywords, or by specifying them in a compact form with the `#+OPTIONS' keyword; or for a tree by setting properties (*note Properties and columns::). Options set at a specific level override options set at a more general level. In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly or indirectly through a file included using `#+SETUPFILE: filename or URL' syntax. Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end can be inserted from the export dispatcher (*note The export dispatcher::) using the `Insert template' command by pressing <#>. To insert keywords individually, a good way to make sure the keyword is correct is to type `#+' and then to use `M-'(1) for completion. The export keywords available for every back-end, and their equivalent global variables, include: `AUTHOR' The document author (`user-full-name'). `CREATOR' Entity responsible for output generation (`org-export-creator-string'). `DATE' A date or a time-stamp(2). `EMAIL' The email address (`user-mail-address'). `LANGUAGE' Language to use for translating certain strings (`org-export-default-language'). With `#+LANGUAGE: fr', for example, Org translates _Table of contents_ to the French _Table des matières_. `SELECT_TAGS' The default value is `:export:'. When a tree is tagged with `:export:' (`org-export-select-tags'), Org selects that tree and its sub-trees for export. Org excludes trees with `:noexport:' tags, see below. When selectively exporting files with `:export:' tags set, Org does not export any text that appears before the first headline. `EXCLUDE_TAGS' The default value is `:noexport:'. When a tree is tagged with `:noexport:' (`org-export-exclude-tags'), Org excludes that tree and its sub-trees from export. Entries tagged with `:noexport:' will be unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they have an `:export:' tag. Even if a sub-tree is not exported, Org will execute any code blocks contained in them. `TITLE' Org displays this title. For long titles, use multiple `#+TITLE' lines. `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' The name of the output file to be generated. Otherwise, Org generates the file name based on the buffer name and the extension based on the back-end format. The `#+OPTIONS' keyword is a compact form. To configure multiple options, use several `#+OPTIONS' lines. `#+OPTIONS' recognizes the following arguments. `':' Toggle smart quotes (`org-export-with-smart-quotes'). Depending on the language used, when activated, Org treats pairs of double quotes as primary quotes, pairs of single quotes as secondary quotes, and single quote marks as apostrophes. `*:' Toggle emphasized text (`org-export-with-emphasize'). `-:' Toggle conversion of special strings (`org-export-with-special-strings'). `::' Toggle fixed-width sections (`org-export-with-fixed-width'). `<:' Toggle inclusion of time/date active/inactive stamps (`org-export-with-timestamps'). `\n:' Toggles whether to preserve line breaks (`org-export-preserve-breaks'). `^:' Toggle TeX-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write "^:{}", `a_{b}' will be interpreted, but the simple `a_b' will be left as it is (`org-export-with-sub-superscripts'). `arch:' Configure how archived trees are exported. When set to `headline', the export process skips the contents and processes only the headlines (`org-export-with-archived-trees'). `author:' Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file (`org-export-with-author'). `broken-links:' Toggles if Org should continue exporting upon finding a broken internal link. When set to `mark', Org clearly marks the problem link in the output (`org-export-with-broken-links'). `c:' Toggle inclusion of CLOCK keywords (`org-export-with-clocks'). `creator:' Toggle inclusion of creator information in the exported file (`org-export-with-creator'). `d:' Toggles inclusion of drawers, or list of drawers to include, or list of drawers to exclude (`org-export-with-drawers'). `date:' Toggle inclusion of a date into exported file (`org-export-with-date'). `e:' Toggle inclusion of entities (`org-export-with-entities'). `email:' Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file (`org-export-with-email'). `f:' Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (`org-export-with-footnotes'). `H:' Set the number of headline levels for export (`org-export-headline-levels'). Below that level, headlines are treated differently. In most back-ends, they become list items. `inline:' Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (`org-export-with-inlinetasks'). `num:' Toggle section-numbers (`org-export-with-section-numbers'). When set to number `n', Org numbers only those headlines at level `n' or above. Setting `UNNUMBERED' property to non-`nil' disables numbering of a heading. Since subheadings inherit from this property, it affects their numbering, too. `p:' Toggle export of planning information (`org-export-with-planning'). "Planning information" comes from lines located right after the headline and contain any combination of these cookies: `SCHEDULED:', `DEADLINE:', or `CLOSED:'. `pri:' Toggle inclusion of priority cookies (`org-export-with-priority'). `prop:' Toggle inclusion of property drawers, or list the properties to include (`org-export-with-properties'). `stat:' Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies (`org-export-with-statistics-cookies'). `tags:' Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be `not-in-toc' (`org-export-with-tags'). `tasks:' Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items); or `nil' to remove all tasks; or `todo' to remove DONE tasks; or list the keywords to keep (`org-export-with-tasks'). `tex:' `nil' does not export; `t' exports; `verbatim' keeps everything in verbatim (`org-export-with-latex'). `timestamp:' Toggle inclusion of the creation time in the exported file (`org-export-time-stamp-file'). `title:' Toggle inclusion of title (`org-export-with-title'). `toc:' Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit (`org-export-with-toc'). `todo:' Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text (`org-export-with-todo-keywords'). `|:' Toggle inclusion of tables (`org-export-with-tables'). When exporting sub-trees, special node properties in them can override the above keywords. They are special because they have an `EXPORT_' prefix. For example, `DATE' and `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' keywords become, respectively, `EXPORT_DATE' and `EXPORT_FILE_NAME'. Except for `SETUPFILE', all other keywords listed above have an `EXPORT_' equivalent. If `org-export-allow-bind-keywords' is non-`nil', Emacs variables can become buffer-local during export by using the BIND keyword. Its syntax is `#+BIND: variable value'. This is particularly useful for in-buffer settings that cannot be changed using keywords. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Many desktops intercept `M-TAB' to switch windows. Use `C-M-i' or ` ' instead. (2) The variable `org-export-date-timestamp-format' defines how this time-stamp will be exported.  File: org, Node: Table of contents, Next: Include files, Prev: Export settings, Up: Exporting 12.3 Table of contents ====================== Org normally inserts the table of contents directly before the first headline of the file. Org sets the TOC depth the same as the headline levels in the file. Use a lower number for lower TOC depth. To turn off TOC entirely, use `nil'. This is configured in the `org-export-with-toc' variable or as keywords in an Org file as: #+OPTIONS: toc:2 only include two levels in TOC #+OPTIONS: toc:nil no default TOC at all To move the table of contents to a different location, first turn off the default with `org-export-with-toc' variable or with `#+OPTIONS: toc:nil'. Then insert `#+TOC: headlines N' at the desired location(s). #+OPTIONS: toc:nil no default TOC ... #+TOC: headlines 2 insert TOC here, with two headline levels To adjust the TOC depth for a specific section of the Org document, append an additional `local' parameter. This parameter becomes a relative depth for the current level. Note that for this feature to work properly in LaTeX export, the Org file requires the inclusion of the `titletoc' package. Because of compatibility issues, `titletoc' has to be loaded _before_ `hyperref'. Customize the `org-latex-default-packages-alist' variable. * Section #+TOC: headlines 1 local insert local TOC, with direct children only Use the `TOC' keyword to generate list of tables (resp. all listings) with captions. #+TOC: listings build a list of listings #+TOC: tables build a list of tables Normally Org uses the headline for its entry in the table of contents. But with `ALT_TITLE' property, a different entry can be specified for the table of contents.  File: org, Node: Include files, Next: Macro replacement, Prev: Table of contents, Up: Exporting 12.4 Include files ================== Include other files during export. For example, to include your `.emacs' file, you could use: #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp The first parameter is the file name to include. The optional second parameter specifies the block type: `example', `export' or `src'. The optional third parameter specifies the source code language to use for formatting the contents. This is relevant to both `export' and `src' block types. If an include file is specified as having a markup language, Org neither checks for valid syntax nor changes the contents in any way. For `example' and `src' blocks, Org code-escapes the contents before inclusion. If an include file is not specified as having any markup language, Org assumes it be in Org format and proceeds as usual with a few exceptions. Org makes the footnote labels (*note Footnotes::) in the included file local to that file. The contents of the included file will belong to the same structure--headline, item--containing the `INCLUDE' keyword. In particular, headlines within the file will become children of the current section. That behavior can be changed by providing an additional keyword parameter, `:minlevel'. It shifts the headlines in the included file to become the lowest level. For example, this syntax makes the included file a sibling of the current top-level headline: #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1 Inclusion of only portions of files are specified using ranges parameter with `:lines' keyword. The line at the upper end of the range will not be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the obvious defaults. #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" Include lines from 10 to EOF Inclusions may specify a file-link to extract an object matched by `org-link-search'(1) (*note Search options::). To extract only the contents of the matched object, set `:only-contents' property to non-`nil'. This will omit any planning lines or property drawers. The ranges for `:lines' keyword are relative to the requested element. Some examples: #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::#theory" :only-contents t Include the body of the heading with the custom id `theory' #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::mytable" Include named element. #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::*conclusion" :lines 1-20 Include the first 20 lines of the headline named `conclusion'. `C-c '' Visit the include file at point. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Note that `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline' is locally bound to non-`nil'. Therefore, `org-link-search' only matches headlines and named elements.  File: org, Node: Macro replacement, Next: Comment lines, Prev: Include files, Up: Exporting 12.5 Macro replacement ====================== Macros replace text snippets during export. Macros are defined globally in `org-export-global-macros', or document-wise with the following syntax: #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments which can be referenced using `{{{name(arg1, arg2)}}}'(1). Org recognizes macro references in following Org markup areas: paragraphs, headlines, verse blocks, tables cells and lists. Org also recognizes macro references in keywords, such as `#+CAPTION', `#+TITLE', `#+AUTHOR', `#+DATE', and for some back-end specific export options. Org comes with following pre-defined macros: `{{{title}}}' `{{{author}}}' `{{{email}}}' Org replaces these macro references with available information at the time of export. `{{{date}}}' `{{{date(FORMAT)}}}' This macro refers to the `#+DATE' keyword. FORMAT is an optional argument to the `{{{date}}}' macro that will be used only if `#+DATE' is a single timestamp. FORMAT should be a format string understood by `format-time-string'. `{{{time(FORMAT)}}}' `{{{modification-time(FORMAT, VC)}}}' These macros refer to the document's date and time of export and date and time of modification. FORMAT is a string understood by `format-time-string'. If the second argument to the `modification-time' macro is non-`nil', Org uses `vc.el' to retrieve the document's modification time from the version control system. Otherwise Org reads the file attributes. `{{{input-file}}}' This macro refers to the filename of the exported file. `{{{property(PROPERTY-NAME)}}}' `{{{property(PROPERTY-NAME,SEARCH-OPTION)}}}' This macro returns the value of property PROPERTY-NAME in the current entry. If SEARCH-OPTION (*note Search options::) refers to a remote entry, that will be used instead. `{{{n}}}' `{{{n(NAME)}}}' `{{{n(NAME,ACTION)}}}' This macro implements custom counters by returning the number of times the macro has been expanded so far while exporting the buffer. You can create more than one counter using different NAME values. If ACTION is `-', previous value of the counter is held, i.e. the specified counter is not incremented. If the value is a number, the specified counter is set to that value. If it is any other non-empty string, the specified counter is reset to 1. You may leave NAME empty to reset the default counter. The surrounding brackets can be made invisible by setting `org-hide-macro-markers' non-`nil'. Org expands macros at the very beginning of the export process. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Since commas separate the arguments, commas within arguments have to be escaped with the backslash character. So only those backslash characters before a comma need escaping with another backslash character.  File: org, Node: Comment lines, Next: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Prev: Macro replacement, Up: Exporting 12.6 Comment lines ================== Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one `#' and a whitespace are treated as comments and, as such, are not exported. Likewise, regions surrounded by `#+BEGIN_COMMENT' ... `#+END_COMMENT' are not exported. Finally, a `COMMENT' keyword at the beginning of an entry, but after any other keyword or priority cookie, comments out the entire subtree. In this case, the subtree is not exported and no code block within it is executed either(1). The command below helps changing the comment status of a headline. `C-c ;' Toggle the `COMMENT' keyword at the beginning of an entry. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) For a less drastic behavior, consider using a select tag (*note Export settings::) instead.  File: org, Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Next: Beamer export, Prev: Comment lines, Up: Exporting 12.7 ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export =============================== ASCII export produces an output file containing only plain ASCII characters. This is the most simplest and direct text output. It does not contain any Org markup either. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export use additional characters and symbols available in these encoding standards. All three of these export formats offer the most basic of text output for maximum portability. On export, Org fills and justifies text according to the text width set in `org-ascii-text-width'. Org exports links using a footnote-like style where the descriptive part is in the text and the link is in a note before the next heading. See the variable `org-ascii-links-to-notes' for details. ASCII export commands --------------------- `C-c C-e t a/l/u (`org-ascii-export-to-ascii')' Export as an ASCII file with a `.txt' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.txt', overwriting without warning. For `myfile.txt', Org exports to `myfile.txt.txt' in order to prevent data loss. `C-c C-e t A/L/U (`org-ascii-export-as-ascii')' Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. ASCII specific export settings ------------------------------ The ASCII export back-end has one extra keyword for customizing ASCII output. Setting this keyword works similar to the general options (*note Export settings::). `SUBTITLE' The document subtitle. For long subtitles, use multiple `#+SUBTITLE' lines in the Org file. Org prints them on one continuous line, wrapping into multiple lines if necessary. Header and sectioning structure ------------------------------- Org converts the first three outline levels into headlines for ASCII export. The remaining levels are turned into lists. To change this cut-off point where levels become lists, *note Export settings::. Quoting ASCII text ------------------ To insert text within the Org file by the ASCII back-end, use one the following constructs, inline, keyword, or export block: Inline text @@ascii:and additional text@@ within a paragraph. #+ASCII: Some text #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii Org exports text in this block only when using ASCII back-end. #+END_EXPORT ASCII specific attributes ------------------------- ASCII back-end recognizes only one attribute, `:width', which specifies the width of an horizontal rule in number of characters. The keyword and syntax for specifying widths is: #+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10 ----- ASCII special blocks -------------------- Besides `#+BEGIN_CENTER' blocks (*note Paragraphs::), ASCII back-end has these two left and right justification blocks: #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT It's just a jump to the left... #+END_JUSTIFYLEFT #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT ...and then a step to the right. #+END_JUSTIFYRIGHT  File: org, Node: Beamer export, Next: HTML export, Prev: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Up: Exporting 12.8 Beamer export ================== Org uses _Beamer_ export to convert an Org file tree structure into a high-quality interactive slides for presentations. _Beamer_ is a LaTeX document class for creating presentations in PDF, HTML, and other popular display formats. * Menu: * Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. * Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. * Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. * Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. * Editing support:: For using helper functions. * A Beamer example:: A complete presentation.  File: org, Node: Beamer export commands, Next: Beamer specific export settings, Up: Beamer export 12.8.1 Beamer export commands ----------------------------- `C-c C-e l b (`org-beamer-export-to-latex')' Export as LaTeX file with a `.tex' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.tex', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e l B (`org-beamer-export-as-latex')' Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. `C-c C-e l P (`org-beamer-export-to-pdf')' Export as LaTeX file and then convert it to PDF format. `C-c C-e l O' Export as LaTeX file, convert it to PDF format, and then open the PDF file.  File: org, Node: Beamer specific export settings, Next: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Prev: Beamer export commands, Up: Beamer export 12.8.2 Beamer specific export settings -------------------------------------- Beamer export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing Beamer output. These keywords work similar to the general options settings (*note Export settings::). `BEAMER_THEME' The Beamer layout theme (`org-beamer-theme'). Use square brackets for options. For example: #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt] `BEAMER_FONT_THEME' The Beamer font theme. `BEAMER_INNER_THEME' The Beamer inner theme. `BEAMER_OUTER_THEME' The Beamer outer theme. `BEAMER_HEADER' Arbitrary lines inserted in the preamble, just before the `hyperref' settings. `DESCRIPTION' The document description. For long descriptions, use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' keywords. By default, `hyperref' inserts `#+DESCRIPTION' as metadata. Use `org-latex-hyperref-template' to configure document metadata. Use `org-latex-title-command' to configure typesetting of description as part of front matter. `KEYWORDS' The keywords for defining the contents of the document. Use multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines if necessary. By default, `hyperref' inserts `#+KEYWORDS' as metadata. Use `org-latex-hyperref-template' to configure document metadata. Use `org-latex-title-command' to configure typesetting of keywords as part of front matter. `SUBTITLE' Document's subtitle. For typesetting, use `org-beamer-subtitle-format' string. Use `org-latex-hyperref-template' to configure document metadata. Use `org-latex-title-command' to configure typesetting of subtitle as part of front matter.  File: org, Node: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Next: Beamer specific syntax, Prev: Beamer specific export settings, Up: Beamer export 12.8.3 Sectioning, Frames and Blocks in Beamer ---------------------------------------------- Org transforms heading levels into Beamer's sectioning elements, frames and blocks. Any Org tree with a not-too-deep-level nesting should in principle be exportable as a Beamer presentation. - Org headlines become Beamer frames when the heading level in Org is equal to `org-beamer-frame-level' or `H' value in an `OPTIONS' line (*note Export settings::). Org overrides headlines to frames conversion for the current tree of an Org file if it encounters the `BEAMER_ENV' property set to `frame' or `fullframe'. Org ignores whatever `org-beamer-frame-level' happens to be for that headline level in the Org tree. In Beamer terminology, a `fullframe' is a frame without its title. - Org exports a Beamer frame's objects as `block' environments. Org can enforce wrapping in special block types when `BEAMER_ENV' property is set(1). For valid values see `org-beamer-environments-default'. To add more values, see `org-beamer-environments-extra'. - If `BEAMER_ENV' is set to `appendix', Org exports the entry as an appendix. When set to `note', Org exports the entry as a note within the frame or between frames, depending on the entry's heading level. When set to `noteNH', Org exports the entry as a note without its title. When set to `againframe', Org exports the entry with `\againframe' command, which makes setting the `BEAMER_REF' property mandatory because `\againframe' needs frame to resume. When `ignoreheading' is set, Org export ignores the entry's headline but not its content. This is useful for inserting content between frames. It is also useful for properly closing a `column' environment. When `BEAMER_ACT' is set for a headline, Org export translates that headline as an overlay or action specification. When enclosed in square brackets, Org export makes the overlay specification a default. Use `BEAMER_OPT' to set any options applicable to the current Beamer frame or block. The Beamer export back-end wraps with appropriate angular or square brackets. It also adds the `fragile' option for any code that may require a verbatim block. To create a column on the Beamer slide, use the `BEAMER_COL' property for its headline in the Org file. Set the value of `BEAMER_COL' to a decimal number representing the fraction of the total text width. Beamer export uses this value to set the column's width and fills the column with the contents of the Org entry. If the Org entry has no specific environment defined, Beamer export ignores the heading. If the Org entry has a defined environment, Beamer export uses the heading as title. Behind the scenes, Beamer export automatically handles LaTeX column separations for contiguous headlines. To manually adjust them for any unique configurations needs, use the `BEAMER_ENV' property. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If `BEAMER_ENV' is set, Org export adds `:B_environment:' tag to make it visible. The tag serves as a visual aid and has no semantic relevance.  File: org, Node: Beamer specific syntax, Next: Editing support, Prev: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Up: Beamer export 12.8.4 Beamer specific syntax ----------------------------- Since Org's Beamer export back-end is an extension of the LaTeX back-end, it recognizes other LaTeX specific syntax--for example, `#+LATEX:' or `#+ATTR_LATEX:'. *Note LaTeX export::, for details. Beamer export wraps the table of contents generated with `toc:t' `OPTION' keyword in a `frame' environment. Beamer export does not wrap the table of contents generated with `TOC' keyword (*note Table of contents::). Use square brackets for specifying options. #+TOC: headlines [currentsection] Insert Beamer-specific code using the following constructs: #+BEAMER: \pause #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer Only Beamer export back-end will export this line. #+END_BEAMER Text @@beamer:some code@@ within a paragraph. Inline constructs, such as the last one above, are useful for adding overlay specifications to objects with `bold', `item', `link', `radio-target' and `target' types. Enclose the value in angular brackets and place the specification at the beginning the object as shown in this example: A *@@beamer:<2->@@useful* feature Beamer export recognizes the `ATTR_BEAMER' keyword with the following attributes from Beamer configurations: `:environment' for changing local Beamer environment, `:overlay' for specifying Beamer overlays in angular or square brackets, and `:options' for inserting optional arguments. #+ATTR_BEAMER: :environment nonindentlist - item 1, not indented - item 2, not indented - item 3, not indented #+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay <+-> - item 1 - item 2 #+ATTR_BEAMER: :options [Lagrange] Let $G$ be a finite group, and let $H$ be a subgroup of $G$. Then the order of $H$ divides the order of $G$.  File: org, Node: Editing support, Next: A Beamer example, Prev: Beamer specific syntax, Up: Beamer export 12.8.5 Editing support ---------------------- The `org-beamer-mode' is a special minor mode for faster editing of Beamer documents. #+STARTUP: beamer `C-c C-b (`org-beamer-select-environment')' The `org-beamer-mode' provides this key for quicker selections in Beamer normal environments, and for selecting the `BEAMER_COL' property.  File: org, Node: A Beamer example, Prev: Editing support, Up: Beamer export 12.8.6 A Beamer example ----------------------- Here is an example of an Org document ready for Beamer export. #+TITLE: Example Presentation #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik #+OPTIONS: H:2 toc:t num:t #+LATEX_CLASS: beamer #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation] #+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid #+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) %8BEAMER_OPT(Opt) * This is the first structural section ** Frame 1 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 :BEAMER_ENV: block :END: for the first viable Beamer setup in Org *** Thanks to everyone else :B_block: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 :BEAMER_ACT: <2-> :BEAMER_ENV: block :END: for contributing to the discussion **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note: :PROPERTIES: :BEAMER_env: note :END: ** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns) *** Request Please test this stuff!  File: org, Node: HTML export, Next: LaTeX export, Prev: Beamer export, Up: Exporting 12.9 HTML export ================ Org mode contains an HTML exporter with extensive HTML formatting compatible with XHTML 1.0 strict standard. * Menu: * HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export * HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export * HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors * HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files * Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links * Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables * Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output * Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations * Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example * CSS support:: Styling HTML output * JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser  File: org, Node: HTML Export commands, Next: HTML Specific export settings, Up: HTML export 12.9.1 HTML export commands --------------------------- `C-c C-e h h (`org-html-export-to-html')' Export as HTML file with a `.html' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.html', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e h o' Exports to HTML and opens it in a web browser. `C-c C-e h H (`org-html-export-as-html')' Exports to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file.  File: org, Node: HTML Specific export settings, Next: HTML doctypes, Prev: HTML Export commands, Up: HTML export 12.9.2 HTML Specific export settings ------------------------------------ HTML export has a number of keywords, similar to the general options settings described in *note Export settings::. `DESCRIPTION' This is the document's description, which the HTML exporter inserts it as a HTML meta tag in the HTML file. For long descriptions, use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' lines. The exporter takes care of wrapping the lines properly. `HTML_DOCTYPE' Specify the document type, for example: HTML5 (`org-html-doctype'). `HTML_CONTAINER' Specify the HTML container, such as `div', for wrapping sections and elements (`org-html-container-element'). `HTML_LINK_HOME' The URL for home link (`org-html-link-home'). `HTML_LINK_UP' The URL for the up link of exported HTML pages (`org-html-link-up'). `HTML_MATHJAX' Options for MathJax (`org-html-mathjax-options'). MathJax is used to typeset LaTeX math in HTML documents. *Note Math formatting in HTML export::, for an example. `HTML_HEAD' Arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head (`org-html-head'). `HTML_HEAD_EXTRA' More arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head (`org-html-head-extra'). `KEYWORDS' Keywords to describe the document's content. HTML exporter inserts these keywords as HTML meta tags. For long keywords, use multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines. `LATEX_HEADER' Arbitrary lines for appending to the preamble; HTML exporter appends when transcoding LaTeX fragments to images (*note Math formatting in HTML export::). `SUBTITLE' The document's subtitle. HTML exporter formats subtitle if document type is `HTML5' and the CSS has a `subtitle' class. Some of these keywords are explained in more detail in the following sections of the manual.  File: org, Node: HTML doctypes, Next: HTML preamble and postamble, Prev: HTML Specific export settings, Up: HTML export 12.9.3 HTML doctypes -------------------- Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors. Set the `org-html-doctype' variable for different (X)HTML variants. Depending on the variant, the HTML exporter adjusts the syntax of HTML conversion accordingly. Org includes the following ready-made variants: * "html4-strict" * "html4-transitional" * "html4-frameset" * "xhtml-strict" * "xhtml-transitional" * "xhtml-frameset" * "xhtml-11" * "html5" * "xhtml5" See the variable `org-html-doctype-alist' for details. The default is "xhtml-strict". Org's HTML exporter does not by default enable new block elements introduced with the HTML5 standard. To enable them, set `org-html-html5-fancy' to non-`nil'. Or use an `OPTIONS' line in the file to set `html5-fancy'. HTML5 documents can now have arbitrary `#+BEGIN' and `#+END' blocks. For example: #+BEGIN_aside Lorem ipsum #+END_aside Will export to: While this: #+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350 #+BEGIN_video #+HTML: #+HTML: Your browser does not support the video tag. #+END_video Exports to: When special blocks do not have a corresponding HTML5 element, the HTML exporter reverts to standard translation (see `org-html-html5-elements'). For example, `#+BEGIN_lederhosen' exports to `
'. Special blocks cannot have headlines. For the HTML exporter to wrap the headline and its contents in `
' or `
' tags, set the `HTML_CONTAINER' property for the headline.  File: org, Node: HTML preamble and postamble, Next: Quoting HTML tags, Prev: HTML doctypes, Up: HTML export 12.9.4 HTML preamble and postamble ---------------------------------- The HTML exporter has delineations for preamble and postamble. The default value for `org-html-preamble' is `t', which makes the HTML exporter insert the preamble. See the variable `org-html-preamble-format' for the format string. Set `org-html-preamble' to a string to override the default format string. If the string is a function, the HTML exporter expects the function to return a string upon execution. The HTML exporter inserts this string in the preamble. The HTML exporter will not insert a preamble if `org-html-preamble' is set `nil'. The default value for `org-html-postamble' is `auto', which makes the HTML exporter build a postamble from looking up author's name, email address, creator's name, and date. Set `org-html-postamble' to `t' to insert the postamble in the format specified in the `org-html-postamble-format' variable. The HTML exporter will not insert a postamble if `org-html-postamble' is set to `nil'.  File: org, Node: Quoting HTML tags, Next: Links in HTML export, Prev: HTML preamble and postamble, Up: HTML export 12.9.5 Quoting HTML tags ------------------------ The HTML export back-end transforms `<' and `>' to `<' and `>'. To include raw HTML code in the Org file so the HTML export back-end can insert that HTML code in the output, use this inline syntax: `@@html:'. For example: `@@html:@@bold text@@html:@@'. For larger raw HTML code blocks, use these HTML export code blocks: #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export or #+BEGIN_EXPORT html All lines between these markers are exported literally #+END_EXPORT  File: org, Node: Links in HTML export, Next: Tables in HTML export, Prev: Quoting HTML tags, Up: HTML export 12.9.6 Links in HTML export --------------------------- The HTML export back-end transforms Org's internal links (*note Internal links::) to equivalent HTML links in the output. The back-end similarly handles Org's automatic links created by radio targets (*note Radio targets::) similarly. For Org links to external files, the back-end transforms the links to _relative_ paths. For Org links to other `.org' files, the back-end automatically changes the file extension to `.html' and makes file paths relative. If the `.org' files have an equivalent `.html' version at the same location, then the converted links should work without any further manual intervention. However, to disable this automatic path translation, set `org-html-link-org-files-as-html' to `nil'. When disabled, the HTML export back-end substitutes the `id:'-based links in the HTML output. For more about linking files when publishing to a directory, *note Publishing links::. Org files can also have special directives to the HTML export back-end. For example, by using `#+ATTR_HTML' lines to specify new format attributes to `' or `' tags. This example shows changing the link's `title' and `style': #+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red; [[http://orgmode.org]]  File: org, Node: Tables in HTML export, Next: Images in HTML export, Prev: Links in HTML export, Up: HTML export 12.9.7 Tables in HTML export ---------------------------- The HTML export back-end uses `org-html-table-default-attributes' when exporting Org tables to HTML. By default, the exporter does not draw frames and cell borders. To change for this for a table, use the following lines before the table in the Org file: #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells #+ATTR_HTML: :border 2 :rules all :frame border The HTML export back-end preserves column groupings in Org tables (*note Column groups::) when exporting to HTML. Additional options for customizing tables for HTML export. `org-html-table-align-individual-fields' Non-`nil' attaches style attributes for alignment to each table field. `org-html-table-caption-above' Non-`nil' places caption string at the beginning of the table. `org-html-table-data-tags' Opening and ending tags for table data fields. `org-html-table-default-attributes' Default attributes and values for table tags. `org-html-table-header-tags' Opening and ending tags for table's header fields. `org-html-table-row-tags' Opening and ending tags for table rows. `org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' Non-`nil' formats column one in tables with header tags.  File: org, Node: Images in HTML export, Next: Math formatting in HTML export, Prev: Tables in HTML export, Up: HTML export 12.9.8 Images in HTML export ---------------------------- The HTML export back-end has features to convert Org image links to HTML inline images and HTML clickable image links. When the link in the Org file has no description, the HTML export back-end by default in-lines that image. For example: `[[file:myimg.jpg]]' is in-lined, while `[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]' links to the text, `the image'. For more details, see the variable `org-html-inline-images'. On the other hand, if the description part of the Org link is itself another link, such as `file:' or `http:' URL pointing to an image, the HTML export back-end in-lines this image and links to the main image. This Org syntax enables the back-end to link low-resolution thumbnail to the high-resolution version of the image, as shown in this example: [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]] To change attributes of in-lined images, use `#+ATTR_HTML' lines in the Org file. This example shows realignment to right, and adds `alt' and `title' attributes in support of text viewers and modern web accessibility standards. #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider #+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right [[./img/a.jpg]] The HTML export back-end copies the `http' links from the Org file as is.  File: org, Node: Math formatting in HTML export, Next: Text areas in HTML export, Prev: Images in HTML export, Up: HTML export 12.9.9 Math formatting in HTML export ------------------------------------- LaTeX math snippets (*note LaTeX fragments::) can be displayed in two different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use MathJax (http://www.mathjax.org) which should work out of the box with Org(1). Some MathJax display options can be configured via `org-html-mathjax-options', or in the buffer. For example, with the following settings, #+HTML_MATHJAX: align: left indent: 5em tagside: left font: Neo-Euler equation labels will be displayed on the left margin and equations will be five ems from the left margin. See the docstring of `org-html-mathjax-options' for all supported variables. The MathJax template can be configure via `org-html-mathjax-template'. If you prefer, you can also request that LaTeX fragments are processed into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This method requires that the `dvipng' program, `dvisvgm' or `imagemagick' suite is available on your system. You can still get this processing with #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm or: #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) By default Org loads MathJax from cdnjs.com (https://cdnjs.com) as recommended by MathJax (http://www.mathjax.org).  File: org, Node: Text areas in HTML export, Next: CSS support, Prev: Math formatting in HTML export, Up: HTML export 12.9.10 Text areas in HTML export --------------------------------- Before Org mode's Babel, one popular approach to publishing code in HTML was by using `:textarea'. The advantage of this approach was that copying and pasting was built into browsers with simple JavaScript commands. Even editing before pasting was made simple. The HTML export back-end can create such text areas. It requires an `#+ATTR_HTML:' line as shown in the example below with the `:textarea' option. This must be followed by either an `example' or a `src' code block. Other Org block types will not honor the `:textarea' option. By default, the HTML export back-end creates a text area 80 characters wide and height just enough to fit the content. Override these defaults with `:width' and `:height' options on the `#+ATTR_HTML:' line. #+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_EXAMPLE  File: org, Node: CSS support, Next: JavaScript support, Prev: Text areas in HTML export, Up: HTML export 12.9.11 CSS support ------------------- You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The HTML exporter assigns the following special CSS classes(1) to appropriate parts of the document--your style specifications may change these, in addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc. p.author author information, including email p.date publishing date p.creator creator info, about org mode version .title document title .subtitle document subtitle .todo TODO keywords, all not-done states .done the DONE keywords, all states that count as done .WAITING each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself .timestamp timestamp .timestamp-kwd keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED .timestamp-wrapper span around keyword plus timestamp .tag tag in a headline ._HOME each tag uses itself as a class, "@" replaced by "_" .target target for links .linenr the line number in a code example .code-highlighted for highlighting referenced code lines div.outline-N div for outline level N (headline plus text)) div.outline-text-N extra div for text at outline level N .section-number-N section number in headlines, different for each level .figure-number label like "Figure 1:" .table-number label like "Table 1:" .listing-number label like "Listing 1:" div.figure how to format an in-lined image pre.src formatted source code pre.example normal example p.verse verse paragraph div.footnotes footnote section headline p.footnote footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote .footref a footnote reference number (always a ) .footnum footnote number in footnote definition (always ) .org-svg default class for a linked `.svg' image The HTML export back-end includes a compact default style in each exported HTML file. To override the default style with another style, use these keywords in the Org file. They will replace the global defaults the HTML exporter uses. #+HTML_HEAD: #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: To just turn off the default style, customize `org-html-head-include-default-style' variable, or use this option line in the Org file. #+OPTIONS: html-style:nil For longer style definitions, either use several `#+HTML_HEAD' and `#+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA' lines, or use `' blocks around them. Both of these approaches can avoid referring to an external file. In order to add styles to a sub-tree, use the `:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:' property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a particular headline, you can use the id specified in a `:CUSTOM_ID:' property. Never change the `org-html-style-default' constant. Instead use other simpler ways of customizing as described above. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If the classes on TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables `org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' and `org-html-tag-class-prefix' to make them unique.  File: org, Node: JavaScript support, Prev: CSS support, Up: HTML export 12.9.12 JavaScript supported display of web pages ------------------------------------------------- Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This program enhances large files in two different ways of viewing. One is an _Info_-like mode where each section is displayed separately and navigation can be done with the `n' and `p' keys (and some other keys as well, press `?' for an overview of the available keys). The second one has a _folding_ view, much like Org provides inside Emacs. The script is available at `http://orgmode.org/org-info.js' and the documentation at `http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/'. The script is hosted on `http://orgmode.org', but for reliability, prefer installing it on your own web server. To use this program, just add this line to the Org file: #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil The HTML header now has the code needed to automatically invoke the script. For setting options, use the syntax from the above line for options described below: path: The path to the script. The default grabs the script from `http://orgmode.org/org-info.js', but you might want to have a local copy and use a path like `../scripts/org-info.js'. view: Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are: info Info-like interface with one section per page. overview Folding interface, initially showing only top-level. content Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible. showall Folding interface, all headlines and text visible. sdepth: Maximum headline level that will still become an independent section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from `org-export-headline-levels' (= the `H' switch in `#+OPTIONS'). If this is smaller than in `org-export-headline-levels', each info/folding section can still contain child headlines. toc: Should the table of contents _initially_ be visible? Even when `nil', you can always get to the "toc" with `i'. tdepth: The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from the variables `org-export-headline-levels' and `org-export-with-toc'. ftoc: Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"? If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section. ltoc: Should there be short contents (children) in each section? Make this `above' if the section should be above initial text. mouse: Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be `underline' (default) or a background color like `#cccccc'. buttons: Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When `nil' (the default), only one such button will be present. You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable `org-html-infojs-options'. If you want the script to always apply to your pages, configure the variable `org-html-use-infojs'.  File: org, Node: LaTeX export, Next: Markdown export, Prev: HTML export, Up: Exporting 12.10 LaTeX export ================== The LaTeX export back-end can handle complex documents, incorporate standard or custom LaTeX document classes, generate documents using alternate LaTeX engines, and produce fully linked PDF files with indexes, bibliographies, and tables of contents, destined for interactive online viewing or high-quality print publication. While the details are covered in-depth in this section, here are some quick references to variables for the impatient: for engines, see `org-latex-compiler'; for build sequences, see `org-latex-pdf-process'; for packages, see `org-latex-default-packages-alist' and `org-latex-packages-alist'. An important note about the LaTeX export back-end: it is sensitive to blank lines in the Org document. That's because LaTeX itself depends on blank lines to tell apart syntactical elements, such as paragraphs. * Menu: * LaTeX export commands:: For producing LaTeX and PDF documents. * LaTeX specific export settings:: Unique to this LaTeX back-end. * LaTeX header and sectioning:: For file structure. * Quoting LaTeX code:: Directly in the Org document. * Tables in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to tables. * Images in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to images. * Plain lists in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to lists. * Source blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. * Example blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. * Special blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. * Horizontal rules in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules.  File: org, Node: LaTeX export commands, Next: LaTeX specific export settings, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.1 LaTeX export commands ----------------------------- `C-c C-e l l (`org-latex-export-to-latex')' Export as LaTeX file with a `.tex' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.tex', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e l l' Exports to LaTeX file. `C-c C-e l L (`org-latex-export-as-latex')' Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file. `C-c C-e l p (`org-latex-export-to-pdf')' Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF file. `C-c C-e l o' Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF, then open the PDF using the default viewer. The LaTeX export back-end can use any of these LaTeX engines: `pdflatex', `xelatex', and `lualatex'. These engines compile LaTeX files with different compilers, packages, and output options. The LaTeX export back-end finds the compiler version to use from `org-latex-compiler' variable or the `#+LATEX_COMPILER' keyword in the Org file. See the docstring for the `org-latex-default-packages-alist' for loading packages with certain compilers. Also see `org-latex-bibtex-compiler' to set the bibliography compiler(1). ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) This does not allow setting different bibliography compilers for different files. However, "smart" LaTeX compilation systems, such as `latexmk', can select the correct bibliography compiler.  File: org, Node: LaTeX specific export settings, Next: LaTeX header and sectioning, Prev: LaTeX export commands, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.2 LaTeX specific export settings -------------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing LaTeX output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (*note Export settings::). `DESCRIPTION' The document's description. The description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the `hyperref' package. See `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' lines for long descriptions. `LATEX_CLASS' This is LaTeX document class, such as `article', `report', `book', and so on, which contain predefined preamble and headline level mapping that the LaTeX export back-end needs. The back-end reads the default class name from the `org-latex-default-class' variable. Org has `article' as the default class. A valid default class must be an element of `org-latex-classes'. `LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' Options the LaTeX export back-end uses when calling the LaTeX document class. `LATEX_COMPILER' The compiler, such as `pdflatex', `xelatex', `lualatex', for producing the PDF (`org-latex-compiler'). `LATEX_HEADER' Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the `hyperref' settings. See `org-latex-classes' for adjusting the structure and order of the LaTeX headers. `LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the `hyperref' settings. See `org-latex-classes' for adjusting the structure and order of the LaTeX headers. `KEYWORDS' The keywords for the document. The description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the output file by the `hyperref' package. See `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the document's front matter. Use multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines if necessary. `SUBTITLE' The document's subtitle. It is typeset as per `org-latex-subtitle-format'. If `org-latex-subtitle-separate' is non-`nil', it is typed as part of the `\title'-macro. See `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the document's front matter. The following sections have further details.  File: org, Node: LaTeX header and sectioning, Next: Quoting LaTeX code, Prev: LaTeX specific export settings, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.3 LaTeX header and sectioning structure --------------------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end converts the first three of Org's outline levels into LaTeX headlines. The remaining Org levels are exported as `itemize' or `enumerate' lists. To change this globally for the cut-off point between levels and lists, (*note Export settings::). By default, the LaTeX export back-end uses the `article' class. To change the default class globally, edit `org-latex-default-class'. To change the default class locally in an Org file, add option lines `#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass'. To change the default class for just a part of the Org file, set a sub-tree property, `EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS'. The class name entered here must be valid member of `org-latex-classes'. This variable defines a header template for each class into which the exporter splices the values of `org-latex-default-packages-alist' and `org-latex-packages-alist'. Use the same three variables to define custom sectioning or custom classes. The LaTeX export back-end sends the `LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' keyword and `EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' property as options to the LaTeX `\documentclass' macro. The options and the syntax for specifying them, including enclosing them in square brackets, follow LaTeX conventions. #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper,11pt,twoside,twocolumn] The LaTeX export back-end appends values from `LATEX_HEADER' and `LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' keywords to the LaTeX header. The docstring for `org-latex-classes' explains in more detail. Also note that LaTeX export back-end does not append `LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' to the header when previewing LaTeX snippets (*note Previewing LaTeX fragments::). A sample Org file with the above headers: #+LATEX_CLASS: article #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper] #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{xyz} * Headline 1 some text * Headline 2 some more text  File: org, Node: Quoting LaTeX code, Next: Tables in LaTeX export, Prev: LaTeX header and sectioning, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.4 Quoting LaTeX code -------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end can insert any arbitrary LaTeX code, *note Embedded LaTeX::. There are three ways to embed such code in the Org file and they all use different quoting syntax. Inserting in-line quoted with symbols: Code embedded in-line @@latex:any arbitrary LaTeX code@@ in a paragraph. Inserting as one or more keyword lines in the Org file: #+LATEX: any arbitrary LaTeX code Inserting as an export block in the Org file, where the back-end exports any code between begin and end markers: #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex any arbitrary LaTeX code #+END_EXPORT  File: org, Node: Tables in LaTeX export, Next: Images in LaTeX export, Prev: Quoting LaTeX code, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.5 Tables in LaTeX export ------------------------------ The LaTeX export back-end can pass several LaTeX attributes for table contents and layout. Besides specifying label and caption (*note Images and tables::), the other valid LaTeX attributes include: `:mode' The LaTeX export back-end wraps the table differently depending on the mode for accurate rendering of math symbols. Mode is either `table', `math', `inline-math' or `verbatim'. For `math' or `inline-math' mode, LaTeX export back-end wraps the table in a math environment, but every cell in it is exported as-is. The LaTeX export back-end determines the default mode from `org-latex-default-table-mode'. For , The LaTeX export back-end merges contiguous tables in the same mode into a single environment. `:environment' Set the default LaTeX table environment for the LaTeX export back-end to use when exporting Org tables. Common LaTeX table environments are provided by these packages: `tabularx', `longtable', `array', `tabu', and `bmatrix'. For packages, such as `tabularx' and `tabu', or any newer replacements, include them in the `org-latex-packages-alist' variable so the LaTeX export back-end can insert the appropriate load package headers in the converted LaTeX file. Look in the docstring for the `org-latex-packages-alist' variable for configuring these packages for LaTeX snippet previews, if any. `:caption' Use `#+CAPTION' keyword to set a simple caption for a table (*note Images and tables::). For custom captions, use `:caption' attribute, which accepts raw LaTeX code. `:caption' value overrides `#+CAPTION' value. `:float' `:placement' The table environments by default are not floats in LaTeX. To make them floating objects use `:float' with one of the following options: `sideways', `multicolumn', `t', and `nil'. Note that `sidewaystable' has been deprecated since Org 8.3. LaTeX floats can also have additional layout `:placement' attributes. These are the usual `[h t b p ! H]' permissions specified in square brackets. Note that for `:float sideways' tables, the LaTeX export back-end ignores `:placement' attributes. `:align' `:font' `:width' The LaTeX export back-end uses these attributes for regular tables to set their alignments, fonts, and widths. `:spread' When `:spread' is non-`nil', the LaTeX export back-end spreads or shrinks the table by the `:width' for `tabu' and `longtabu' environments. `:spread' has no effect if `:width' is not set. `:booktabs' `:center' `:rmlines' All three commands are toggles. `:booktabs' brings in modern typesetting enhancements to regular tables. The `booktabs' package has to be loaded through `org-latex-packages-alist'. `:center' is for centering the table. `:rmlines' removes all but the very first horizontal line made of ASCII characters from "table.el" tables only. `:math-prefix' `:math-suffix' `:math-arguments' The LaTeX export back-end inserts `:math-prefix' string value in a math environment before the table. The LaTeX export back-end inserts `:math-suffix' string value in a math environment after the table. The LaTeX export back-end inserts `:math-arguments' string value between the macro name and the table's contents. `:math-arguments' comes in use for matrix macros that require more than one argument, such as `qbordermatrix'. LaTeX table attributes help formatting tables for a wide range of situations, such as matrix product or spanning multiple pages: #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp{3cm}r|l | ..... | ..... | | ..... | ..... | #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times | a | b | | c | d | #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix | 1 | 2 | | 3 | 4 | Set the caption with the LaTeX command `\bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB}': #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB} | ..... | ..... | | ..... | ..... |  File: org, Node: Images in LaTeX export, Next: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Prev: Tables in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.6 Images in LaTeX export ------------------------------ The LaTeX export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not have descriptions, such as these links `[[file:img.jpg]]' or `[[./img.jpg]]', as direct image insertions in the final PDF output. In the PDF, they are no longer links but actual images embedded on the page. The LaTeX export back-end uses `\includegraphics' macro to insert the image. But for TikZ(1) images, the back-end uses an `\input' macro wrapped within a `tikzpicture' environment. For specifying image `:width', `:height', and other `:options', use this syntax: #+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] For custom commands for captions, use the `:caption' attribute. It will override the default `#+CAPTION' value: #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB} [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] When captions follow the method as described in *note Images and tables::, the LaTeX export back-end wraps the picture in a floating `figure' environment. To float an image without specifying a caption, set the `:float' attribute to one of the following: - `t': for a standard `figure' environment; used by default whenever an image has a caption. - `multicolumn': to span the image across multiple columns of a page; the back-end wraps the image in a `figure*' environment. - `wrap': for text to flow around the image on the right; the figure occupies the left half of the page. - `sideways': for a new page with the image sideways, rotated ninety degrees, in a `sidewaysfigure' environment; overrides `:placement' setting. - `nil': to avoid a `:float' even if using a caption. Use the `placement' attribute to modify a floating environment's placement. #+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement {r}{0.4\textwidth} [[./img/hst.png]] The LaTeX export back-end centers all images by default. Setting `:center' attribute to `nil' disables centering. To disable centering globally, set `org-latex-images-centered' to `t'. Set the `:comment-include' attribute to non-`nil' value for the LaTeX export back-end to comment out the `\includegraphics' macro. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) `http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/'  File: org, Node: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Next: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Images in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.7 Plain lists in LaTeX export ----------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end accepts the `:environment' and `:options' attributes for plain lists. Both attributes work together for customizing lists, as shown in the examples: #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage[inline]{enumitem} Some ways to say "Hello": #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment itemize* #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [label={}, itemjoin={,}, itemjoin*={, and}] - Hola - Bonjour - Guten Tag. Since LaTeX supports only four levels of nesting for lists, use an external package, such as `enumitem' in LaTeX, for levels deeper than four: #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{enumitem} #+LATEX_HEADER: \renewlist{itemize}{itemize}{9} #+LATEX_HEADER: \setlist[itemize]{label=$\circ$} - One - Two - Three - Four - Five  File: org, Node: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.8 Source blocks in LaTeX export ------------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end can make source code blocks into floating objects through the attributes `:float' and `:options'. For `:float': - `t': makes a source block float; by default floats any source block with a caption. - `multicolumn': spans the source block across multiple columns of a page. - `nil': avoids a `:float' even if using a caption; useful for source code blocks that may not fit on a page. #+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp Lisp code that may not fit in a single page. #+END_SRC The LaTeX export back-end passes string values in `:options' to LaTeX packages for customization of that specific source block. In the example below, the `:options' are set for Minted. Minted is a source code highlighting LaTeXpackage with many configurable options. #+ATTR_LATEX: :options commentstyle=\bfseries #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun Fib (n) (if (< n 2) n (+ (Fib (- n 1)) (Fib (- n 2))))) #+END_SRC To apply similar configuration options for all source blocks in a file, use the `org-latex-listings-options' and `org-latex-minted-options' variables.  File: org, Node: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.9 Example blocks in LaTeX export -------------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end wraps the contents of example blocks in a `verbatim' environment. To change this behavior to use another environment globally, specify an appropriate export filter (*note Advanced configuration::). To change this behavior to use another environment for each block, use the `:environment' parameter to specify a custom environment. #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment myverbatim #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE This sentence is false. #+END_EXAMPLE  File: org, Node: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export, Prev: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.10 Special blocks in LaTeX export --------------------------------------- For other special blocks in the Org file, the LaTeX export back-end makes a special environment of the same name. The back-end also takes `:options', if any, and appends as-is to that environment's opening string. For example: #+BEGIN_abstract We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. #+END_abstract #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem] #+BEGIN_proof ... Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. #+END_proof exports to \begin{abstract} We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. \end{abstract} \begin{proof}[Proof of important theorem] ... Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. \end{proof} If you need to insert a specific caption command, use `:caption' attribute. It will override standard `#+CAPTION' value, if any. For example: #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption{HeadingA} #+BEGIN_proof ... #+END_proof  File: org, Node: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export, Prev: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export 12.10.11 Horizontal rules in LaTeX export ----------------------------------------- The LaTeX export back-end converts horizontal rules by the specified `:width' and `:thickness' attributes. For example: #+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt -----  File: org, Node: Markdown export, Next: OpenDocument Text export, Prev: LaTeX export, Up: Exporting 12.11 Markdown export ===================== The Markdown export back-end, `md', converts an Org file to a Markdown format, as defined at `http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/'. Since `md' is built on top of the HTML back-end, any Org constructs not supported by Markdown, such as tables, the underlying `html' back-end (*note HTML export::) converts them. Markdown export commands ------------------------ `C-c C-e m m (`org-md-export-to-markdown')' Export to a text file with Markdown syntax. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.md', overwritten without warning. `C-c C-e m M (`org-md-export-as-markdown')' Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. `C-c C-e m o' Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it. Header and sectioning structure ------------------------------- Based on `org-md-headline-style', markdown export can generate headlines of both `atx' and `setext' types. `atx' limits headline levels to two. `setext' limits headline levels to six. Beyond these limits, the export back-end converts headlines to lists. To set a limit to a level before the absolute limit (*note Export settings::).  File: org, Node: OpenDocument Text export, Next: Org export, Prev: Markdown export, Up: Exporting 12.12 OpenDocument Text export ============================== The ODT export back-end handles creating of OpenDocument Text (ODT) format files. The format complies with `OpenDocument-v1.2 specification'(1) and is compatible with LibreOffice 3.4. * Menu: * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. * ODT export commands:: Invoking export. * ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. * Extending ODT export:: Producing `.doc', `.pdf' files. * Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. * Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. * Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions. * Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. * Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting LaTeX fragments. * Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. * Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. * Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2 (http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html)  File: org, Node: Pre-requisites for ODT export, Next: ODT export commands, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.1 Pre-requisites for ODT export ------------------------------------- The ODT export back-end relies on the `zip' program to create the final compressed ODT output. Check if `zip' is locally available and executable. Without `zip', export cannot finish.  File: org, Node: ODT export commands, Next: ODT specific export settings, Prev: Pre-requisites for ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.2 ODT export commands --------------------------- `C-c C-e o o (`org-odt-export-to-odt')' Export as OpenDocument Text file. If `org-odt-preferred-output-format' is specified, the ODT export back-end automatically converts the exported file to that format. *Note Automatically exporting to other formats: x-export-to-other-formats. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.odt', overwriting without warning. The ODT export back-end exports a region only if a region was active. Note for exporting active regions, the `transient-mark-mode' has to be turned on. If the selected region is a single tree, the ODT export back-end makes the tree head the document title. Incidentally, `C-c @' selects the current sub-tree. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' property, the ODT export back-end uses that for file name. `C-c C-e o O' Export to an OpenDocument Text file format and open it. When `org-odt-preferred-output-format' is specified, open the converted file instead. *Note Automatically exporting to other formats: x-export-to-other-formats.  File: org, Node: ODT specific export settings, Next: Extending ODT export, Prev: ODT export commands, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.3 ODT specific export settings ------------------------------------ The ODT export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing ODT output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (*note Export settings::). `DESCRIPTION' This is the document's description, which the ODT export back-end inserts as document metadata. For long descriptions, use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' lines. `KEYWORDS' The keywords for the document. The ODT export back-end inserts the description along with author name, keywords, and related file metadata as metadata in the output file. Use multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines if necessary. `ODT_STYLES_FILE' The ODT export back-end uses the `org-odt-styles-file' by default. See *note Applying custom styles:: for details. `SUBTITLE' The document subtitle.  File: org, Node: Extending ODT export, Next: Applying custom styles, Prev: ODT specific export settings, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.4 Extending ODT export ---------------------------- The ODT export back-end can produce documents in other formats besides ODT using a specialized ODT converter process. Its common interface works with popular converters to produce formats such as `doc', or convert a document from one format, say `csv', to another format, say `xls'. Customize `org-odt-convert-process' variable to point to `unoconv', which is the ODT's preferred converter. Working installations of LibreOffice would already have `unoconv' installed. Alternatively, other converters may be substituted here. *Note Configuring a document converter::. Automatically exporting to other formats ........................................ If ODT format is just an intermediate step to get to other formats, such as `doc', `docx', `rtf', or `pdf', etc., then extend the ODT export back-end to directly produce that format. Specify the final format in the `org-odt-preferred-output-format' variable. This is one way to extend (*note Exporting to ODT: x-export-to-odt.). Converting between document formats ................................... The Org export back-end is made to be inter-operable with a wide range of text document format converters. Newer generation converters, such as LibreOffice and Pandoc, can handle hundreds of formats at once. Org provides a consistent interaction with whatever converter is installed. Here are some generic commands: `M-x org-odt-convert RET' Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix argument, opens the newly produced file.  File: org, Node: Applying custom styles, Next: Links in ODT export, Prev: Extending ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.5 Applying custom styles ------------------------------ The ODT export back-end comes with many OpenDocument styles (*note Working with OpenDocument style files::). To expand or further customize these built-in style sheets, either edit the style sheets directly or generate them using an application such as LibreOffice. The example here shows creating a style using LibreOffice. Applying custom styles: the easy way .................................... 1. Create a sample `example.org' file with settings as shown below, and export it to ODT format. #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t 2. Open the above `example.odt' using LibreOffice. Use the `Stylist' to locate the target styles, which typically have the `Org' prefix. Open one, modify, and save as either OpenDocument Text (`.odt') or OpenDocument Template (`.ott') file. 3. Customize the variable `org-odt-styles-file' and point it to the newly created file. For additional configuration options *note Overriding factory styles: x-overriding-factory-styles. To apply and ODT style to a particular file, use the `#+ODT_STYLES_FILE' option as shown in the example below: #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott" or #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png")) Using third-party styles and templates ...................................... The ODT export back-end relies on many templates and style names. Using third-party styles and templates can lead to mismatches. Templates derived from built in ODT templates and styles seem to have fewer problems.  File: org, Node: Links in ODT export, Next: Tables in ODT export, Prev: Applying custom styles, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.6 Links in ODT export --------------------------- ODT export back-end creates native cross-references for internal links and Internet-style links for all other link types. A link with no description and pointing to a regular--un-itemized--outline heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading. A `\ref{label}'-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity. *Note Labels and captions in ODT export::.  File: org, Node: Tables in ODT export, Next: Images in ODT export, Prev: Links in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.7 Tables in ODT export ---------------------------- The ODT export back-end handles native Org mode tables (*note Tables::) and simple `table.el' tables. Complex `table.el' tables having column or row spans are not supported. Such tables are stripped from the exported document. By default, the ODT export back-end exports a table with top and bottom frames and with ruled lines separating row and column groups (*note Column groups::). All tables are typeset to occupy the same width. The ODT export back-end honors any table alignments and relative widths for columns (*note Column width and alignment::). Note that the ODT export back-end interprets column widths as weighted ratios, the default weight being 1. Specifying `:rel-width' property on an `#+ATTR_ODT' line controls the width of the table. For example: #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum | |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| | / | < | | | < | | | | | | | | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 | | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 | | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 | |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 | On export, the above table takes 50% of text width area. The exporter sizes the columns in the ratio: 13:5:5:5:6. The first column is left-aligned and rest of the columns, right-aligned. Vertical rules separate the header and the last column. Horizontal rules separate the header and the last row. For even more customization, create custom table styles and associate them with a table using the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. *Note Customizing tables in ODT export::.  File: org, Node: Images in ODT export, Next: Math formatting in ODT export, Prev: Tables in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.8 Images in ODT export ---------------------------- Embedding images ................ The ODT export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not have descriptions, such as these links `[[file:img.jpg]]' or `[[./img.jpg]]', as direct image insertions in the final output. Either of these examples works: [[file:img.png]] [[./img.png]] Embedding clickable images .......................... For clickable images, provide a link whose description is another link to an image file. For example, to embed a image `org-mode-unicorn.png' which when clicked jumps to `http://Orgmode.org' website, do the following [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]] Sizing and scaling of embedded images ..................................... Control the size and scale of the embedded images with the `#+ATTR_ODT' attribute. The ODT export back-end starts with establishing the size of the image in the final document. The dimensions of this size is measured in centimeters. The back-end then queries the image file for its dimensions measured in pixels. For this measurement, the back-end relies on ImageMagick's `identify' program or Emacs `create-image' and `image-size' API. ImageMagick is the preferred choice for large file sizes or frequent batch operations. The back-end then converts the pixel dimensions using `org-odt-pixels-per-inch' into the familiar 72 dpi or 96 dpi. The default value for this is in `display-pixels-per-inch', which can be tweaked for better results based on the capabilities of the output device. Here are some common image scaling operations: Explicitly size the image To embed `img.png' as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following: #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10 [[./img.png]] Scale the image To embed `img.png' at half its size, do the following: #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5 [[./img.png]] Scale the image to a specific width To embed `img.png' with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original height:width ratio, do the following: #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 [[./img.png]] Scale the image to a specific height To embed `img.png' with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original height:width ratio, do the following #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10 [[./img.png]] Anchoring of images ................... The ODT export back-end can anchor images to `"as-char"', `"paragraph"', or `"page"'. Set the preferred anchor using the `:anchor' property of the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. To create an image that is anchored to a page: #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page" [[./img.png]]  File: org, Node: Math formatting in ODT export, Next: Labels and captions in ODT export, Prev: Images in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.9 Math formatting in ODT export ------------------------------------- The ODT export back-end has special support built-in for handling math. * Menu: * Working with LaTeX math snippets:: Embedding in LaTeX format. * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format.  File: org, Node: Working with LaTeX math snippets, Next: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Up: Math formatting in ODT export Working with LaTeX math snippets ................................ LaTeX math snippets (*note LaTeX fragments::) can be embedded in an ODT document in one of the following ways: 1. MathML Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis. #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t With this option, LaTeX fragments are first converted into MathML fragments using an external LaTeX-to-MathML converter program. The resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in the exported document. To specify the LaTeX-to-MathML converter, customize the variables `org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command' and `org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file'. To use MathToWeb(1) as the preferred converter, configure the above variables as (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I" org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar") To use LaTeXML(2) use (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command "latexmlmath \"%i\" --presentationmathml=%o") To quickly verify the reliability of the LaTeX-to-MathML converter, use the following commands: `M-x org-odt-export-as-odf RET' Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (`.odf') file. `M-x org-odt-export-as-odf-and-open RET' Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (`.odf') file and open the formula file with the system-registered application. 2. PNG images Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a per-file basis. #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm or: #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick Under this option, LaTeX fragments are processed into PNG or SVG images and the resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires `dvipng' program, `dvisvgm' or `imagemagick' programs. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) See MathToWeb (http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl). (2) See `http://dlmf.nist.gov/LaTeXML/'.  File: org, Node: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Prev: Working with LaTeX math snippets, Up: Math formatting in ODT export Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files ................................................. When embedding LaTeX math snippets in ODT documents is not reliable, there is one more option to try. Embed an equation by linking to its MathML (`.mml') source or its OpenDocument formula (`.odf') file as shown below: [[./equation.mml]] or [[./equation.odf]]  File: org, Node: Labels and captions in ODT export, Next: Literal examples in ODT export, Prev: Math formatting in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.10 Labels and captions in ODT export ------------------------------------------ ODT format handles labeling and captioning of objects based on their types. Inline images, tables, LaTeX fragments, and Math formulas are numbered and captioned separately. Each object also gets a unique sequence number based on its order of first appearance in the Org file. Each category has its own sequence. A caption is just a label applied to these objects. #+CAPTION: Bell curve #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049 [[./img/a.png]] When rendered, it may show as follows in the exported document: Figure 2: Bell curve To modify the category component of the caption, customize the option `org-odt-category-map-alist'. For example, to tag embedded images with the string `Illustration' instead of the default string `Figure', use the following setting: (setq org-odt-category-map-alist '(("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p))) With the above modification, the previous example changes to: Illustration 2: Bell curve  File: org, Node: Literal examples in ODT export, Next: Advanced topics in ODT export, Prev: Labels and captions in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.11 Literal examples in ODT export --------------------------------------- The ODT export back-end supports literal examples (*note Literal examples::) with full fontification. Internally, the ODT export back-end relies on `htmlfontify.el' to generate the style definitions needed for fancy listings. The auto-generated styles get `OrgSrc' prefix and inherit colors from the faces used by Emacs `font-lock' library for that source language. For custom fontification styles, customize the `org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks' option. To turn off fontification of literal examples, customize the `org-odt-fontify-srcblocks' option.  File: org, Node: Advanced topics in ODT export, Prev: Literal examples in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export 12.12.12 Advanced topics in ODT export -------------------------------------- The ODT export back-end has extensive features useful for power users and frequent uses of ODT formats. * Menu: * Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter. * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals. * Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting. * Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates. * Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files.  File: org, Node: Configuring a document converter, Next: Working with OpenDocument style files, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export Configuring a document converter ................................ The ODT export back-end works with popular converters with little or no extra configuration. *Note Extending ODT export::. The following is for unsupported converters or tweaking existing defaults. 1. Register the converter Add the name of the converter to the `org-odt-convert-processes' variable. Note that it also requires how the converter is invoked on the command line. See the variable's docstring for details. 2. Configure its capabilities Specify which formats the converter can handle by customizing the variable `org-odt-convert-capabilities'. Use the entry for the default values in this variable for configuring the new converter. Also see its docstring for details. 3. Choose the converter Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the option `org-odt-convert-process'.  File: org, Node: Working with OpenDocument style files, Next: Creating one-off styles, Prev: Configuring a document converter, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export Working with OpenDocument style files ..................................... This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter; the means by which it produces styled documents; the use of automatic and custom OpenDocument styles. a) Factory styles ................. The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output. These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to by the variable `org-odt-styles-dir'. The two files are: * `OrgOdtStyles.xml' This file contributes to the `styles.xml' file of the final `ODT' document. This file gets modified for the following purposes: 1. To control outline numbering based on user settings. 2. To add styles generated by `htmlfontify.el' for fontification of code blocks. * `OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml' This file contributes to the `content.xml' file of the final `ODT' document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the `'...`' elements of this file. Apart from serving as a template file for the final `content.xml', the file serves the following purposes: 1. It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by the exporter. 2. It contains `'...`' elements that control numbering of tables, images, equations, and similar entities. b) Overriding factory styles ............................ The following two variables control the location from where the ODT exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. Customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the exporter. * `org-odt-styles-file' The ODT export back-end uses the file pointed to by this variable, such as `styles.xml', for the final output. It can take one of the following values: 1. A `styles.xml' file Use this file instead of the default `styles.xml' 2. A `.odt' or `.ott' file Use the `styles.xml' contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or Template file 3. A `.odt' or `.ott' file and a subset of files contained within them Use the `styles.xml' contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed those within the final `ODT' document. Use this option if the `styles.xml' file references additional files like header and footer images. 4. `nil' Use the default `styles.xml' * `org-odt-content-template-file' Use this variable to specify the blank `content.xml' that will be used in the final output.  File: org, Node: Creating one-off styles, Next: Customizing tables in ODT export, Prev: Working with OpenDocument style files, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export Creating one-off styles ....................... The ODT export back-end can read embedded raw OpenDocument XML from the Org file. Such direct formatting are useful for one-off instances. 1. Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text Enclose OpenDocument syntax in `@@odt:...@@' for inline markup. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following: @@odt:This is highlighted text@@. But this is regular text. *Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit the `styles.xml' (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtstyles-xml.) and add a custom `Highlight' style as shown below: 2. Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML The ODT export back-end can read one-liner options with `#+ODT:' in the Org file. For example, to force a page break: #+ODT: *Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit your `styles.xml' (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtstyles-xml.) and add a custom `PageBreak' style as shown below. 3. Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML The ODT export back-end can also read ODT export blocks for OpenDocument XML. Such blocks use the `#+BEGIN_EXPORT odt'...`#+END_EXPORT' constructs. For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the following: #+BEGIN_EXPORT odt This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text. #+END_EXPORT  File: org, Node: Customizing tables in ODT export, Next: Validating OpenDocument XML, Prev: Creating one-off styles, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export Customizing tables in ODT export ................................ Override the default table format by specifying a custom table style with the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. For a discussion on default formatting of tables *note Tables in ODT export::. This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.(1) For quick preview of this feature, install the settings below and export the table that follows: (setq org-odt-table-styles (append org-odt-table-styles '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-first-column-styles . t))) ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) #+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn | Name | Phone | Age | | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | The example above used `Custom' template and installed two table styles `TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn' and `TableWithFirstRowandLastRow'. *Important:* The OpenDocument styles needed for producing the above template were pre-defined. They are available in the section marked `Custom Table Template' in `OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml' (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml. For adding new templates, define new styles here. To use this feature proceed as follows: 1. Create a table template(2) A table template is set of `table-cell' and `paragraph' styles for each of the following table cell categories: - Body - First column - Last column - First row - Last row - Even row - Odd row - Even column - Odd Column The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table template using a well-defined convention. The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table template with the name `Custom', the needed style names are listed in the following table. Table cell type `table-cell' style `paragraph' style ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Body `CustomTableCell' `CustomTableParagraph' First column `CustomFirstColumnTableCell'`CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph' Last column `CustomLastColumnTableCell' `CustomLastColumnTableParagraph' First row `CustomFirstRowTableCell' `CustomFirstRowTableParagraph' Last row `CustomLastRowTableCell' `CustomLastRowTableParagraph' Even row `CustomEvenRowTableCell' `CustomEvenRowTableParagraph' Odd row `CustomOddRowTableCell' `CustomOddRowTableParagraph' Even column `CustomEvenColumnTableCell' `CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph' Odd column `CustomOddColumnTableCell' `CustomOddColumnTableParagraph' To create a table template with the name `Custom', define the above styles in the `'...`' element of the content template file (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml.). 2. Define a table style(3) To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable `org-odt-table-styles' and specify the following: - the name of the table template created in step (1) - the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated For example, the entry below defines two different table styles `TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn' and `TableWithFirstRowandLastRow' based on the same template `Custom'. The styles achieve their intended effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template. (setq org-odt-table-styles (append org-odt-table-styles '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-first-column-styles . t))) ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" ((use-first-row-styles . t) (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) 3. Associate a table with the table style To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of the `ATTR_ODT' line as shown below. #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" | Name | Phone | Age | | Peter | 1234 | 17 | | Anna | 4321 | 25 | ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification (http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html) (2) See the `' element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification (3) See the attributes `table:template-name', `table:use-first-row-styles', `table:use-last-row-styles', `table:use-first-column-styles', `table:use-last-column-styles', `table:use-banding-rows-styles', and `table:use-banding-column-styles' of the `' element in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification  File: org, Node: Validating OpenDocument XML, Prev: Customizing tables in ODT export, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export Validating OpenDocument XML ........................... Sometimes ODT format files may not open due to `.odt' file corruption. To verify if the `.odt' file is corrupt, validate it against the OpenDocument RELAX NG Compact Syntax--RNC--schema. But first the `.odt' files have to be decompressed using `zip'. Note that `.odt' files are `zip' archives: *note (emacs)File Archives::. The contents of `.odt' files are in `.xml'. For general help with validation--and schema-sensitive editing--of XML files: *note (nxml-mode)Introduction::. Customize `org-odt-schema-dir' to point to a directory with OpenDocument `.rnc' files and the needed schema-locating rules. The ODT export back-end takes care of updating the `rng-schema-locating-files'.  File: org, Node: Org export, Next: Texinfo export, Prev: OpenDocument Text export, Up: Exporting 12.13 Org export ================ `org' export back-end creates a normalized version of the Org document in current buffer. The exporter evaluates Babel code (*note Evaluating code blocks::) and removes content specific to other back-ends. Org export commands ------------------- `C-c C-e O o (`org-org-export-to-org')' Export as an Org file with a `.org' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.org.org', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e O O (`org-org-export-as-org')' Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. `C-c C-e O v' Export to an Org file, then open it.  File: org, Node: Texinfo export, Next: iCalendar export, Prev: Org export, Up: Exporting 12.14 Texinfo export ==================== The `texinfo' export back-end generates documents with Texinfo code that can compile to Info format. * Menu: * Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. * Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. * Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. * Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. * Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. * Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. * Indices:: Creating indices. * Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. * Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. * Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. * Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. * Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. * A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo.  File: org, Node: Texinfo export commands, Next: Texinfo specific export settings, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.1 Texinfo export commands ------------------------------- `C-c C-e i t (`org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo')' Export as a Texinfo file with `.texi' extension. For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.texi', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e i i (`org-texinfo-export-to-info')' Export to Texinfo format first and then process it to make an Info file. To generate other formats, such as DocBook, customize the `org-texinfo-info-process' variable.  File: org, Node: Texinfo specific export settings, Next: Texinfo file header, Prev: Texinfo export commands, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.2 Texinfo specific export settings ---------------------------------------- The Texinfo export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing Texinfo output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options (*note Export settings::). `SUBTITLE' The document subtitle. `SUBAUTHOR' The document subauthor. `TEXINFO_FILENAME' The Texinfo filename. `TEXINFO_CLASS' The default document class (`org-texinfo-default-class'), which must be a member of `org-texinfo-classes'. `TEXINFO_HEADER' Arbitrary lines inserted at the end of the header. `TEXINFO_POST_HEADER' Arbitrary lines inserted after the end of the header. `TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY' The directory category of the document. `TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE' The directory title of the document. `TEXINFO_DIR_DESC' The directory description of the document. `TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE' The printed title of the document.  File: org, Node: Texinfo file header, Next: Texinfo title and copyright page, Prev: Texinfo specific export settings, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.3 Texinfo file header --------------------------- After creating the header for a Texinfo file, the Texinfo back-end automatically generates a name and destination path for the Info file. To override this default with a more sensible path and name, specify the `#+TEXINFO_FILENAME' keyword. Along with the output's file name, the Texinfo header also contains language details (*note Export settings::) and encoding system as set in the `org-texinfo-coding-system' variable. Insert `#+TEXINFO_HEADER' keywords for each additional command in the header, for example: @code{@synindex}. Instead of repeatedly installing the same set of commands, define a class in `org-texinfo-classes' once, and then activate it in the document by setting the `#+TEXINFO_CLASS' keyword to that class.  File: org, Node: Texinfo title and copyright page, Next: Info directory file, Prev: Texinfo file header, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.4 Texinfo title and copyright page ---------------------------------------- The default template for hard copy output has a title page with `#+TITLE' and `#+AUTHOR' (*note Export settings::). To replace the regular `#+TITLE' with something different for the printed version, use the `#+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE' and `#+SUBTITLE' keywords. Both expect raw Texinfo code for setting their values. If one `#+AUTHOR' is not sufficient, add multiple `#+SUBAUTHOR' keywords. They have to be set in raw Texinfo code. #+AUTHOR: Jane Smith #+SUBAUTHOR: John Doe #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: This Long Title@inlinefmt{tex,@*} Is Broken in @TeX{} Copying material is defined in a dedicated headline with a non-`nil' `:COPYING:' property. The back-end inserts the contents within a `@copying' command at the beginning of the document. The heading itself does not appear in the structure of the document. Copyright information is printed on the back of the title page. * Legalese :PROPERTIES: :COPYING: t :END: This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file, version 1.0. Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.  File: org, Node: Info directory file, Next: Headings and sectioning structure, Prev: Texinfo title and copyright page, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.5 Info directory file --------------------------- The end result of the Texinfo export process is the creation of an Info file. This Info file's metadata has variables for category, title, and description: `#+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY', `#+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE', and `#+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC' that establish where in the Info hierarchy the file fits. Here is an example that writes to the Info directory file: #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Emacs #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Org Mode: (org) #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Outline-based notes management and organizer  File: org, Node: Headings and sectioning structure, Next: Indices, Prev: Info directory file, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.6 Headings and sectioning structure ----------------------------------------- The Texinfo export back-end uses a pre-defined scheme to convert Org headlines to an equivalent Texinfo structuring commands. A scheme like this maps top-level headlines to numbered chapters tagged as `@chapter' and lower-level headlines to unnumbered chapters tagged as `@unnumbered'. To override such mappings to introduce `@part' or other Texinfo structuring commands, define a new class in `org-texinfo-classes'. Activate the new class with the `#+TEXINFO_CLASS' keyword. When no new class is defined and activated, the Texinfo export back-end defaults to the `org-texinfo-default-class'. If an Org headline's level has no associated Texinfo structuring command, or is below a certain threshold (*note Export settings::), then the Texinfo export back-end makes it into a list item. The Texinfo export back-end makes any headline with a non-`nil' `:APPENDIX:' property into an appendix. This happens independent of the Org headline level or the `#+TEXINFO_CLASS'. The Texinfo export back-end creates a menu entry after the Org headline for each regular sectioning structure. To override this with a shorter menu entry, use the `:ALT_TITLE:' property (*note Table of contents::). Texinfo menu entries also have an option for a longer `:DESCRIPTION:' property. Here's an example that uses both to override the default menu entry: * Controlling Screen Display :PROPERTIES: :ALT_TITLE: Display :DESCRIPTION: Controlling Screen Display :END: The text before the first headline belongs to the `Top' node, i.e., the node in which a reader enters an Info manual. As such, it is expected not to appear in printed output generated from the `.texi' file. *note (texinfo)The Top Node::, for more information.  File: org, Node: Indices, Next: Quoting Texinfo code, Prev: Headings and sectioning structure, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.7 Indices --------------- The Texinfo export back-end recognizes these indexing keywords if used in the Org file: `#+CINDEX', `#+FINDEX', `#+KINDEX', `#+PINDEX', `#+TINDEX', and `#+VINDEX'. Write their value as verbatim Texinfo code; in particular, `{', `}' and `@' characters need to be escaped with `@' if they not belong to a Texinfo command. #+CINDEX: Defining indexing entries For the back-end to generate an index entry for a headline, set the `:INDEX:' property to `cp' or `vr'. These abbreviations come from Texinfo that stand for concept index and variable index. The Texinfo manual has abbreviations for all other kinds of indexes. The back-end exports the headline as an unnumbered chapter or section command, and then inserts the index after its contents. * Concept Index :PROPERTIES: :INDEX: cp :END:  File: org, Node: Quoting Texinfo code, Next: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Prev: Indices, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.8 Quoting Texinfo code ---------------------------- Use any of the following three methods to insert or escape raw Texinfo code: Richard @@texinfo:@sc{@@Stallman@@texinfo:}@@ commence' GNU. #+TEXINFO: @need800 This paragraph is preceded by... #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo @auindex Johnson, Mark @auindex Lakoff, George #+END_EXPORT  File: org, Node: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Next: Tables in Texinfo export, Prev: Quoting Texinfo code, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.9 Plain lists in Texinfo export ------------------------------------- The Texinfo export back-end by default converts description lists in the Org file using the default command `@table', which results in a table with two columns. To change this behavior, specify `:table-type' with `ftable' or `vtable' attributes. For more information, *note (texinfo)Two-column Tables::. The Texinfo export back-end by default also applies a text highlight based on the defaults stored in `org-texinfo-table-default-markup'. To override the default highlight command, specify another one with the `:indic' attribute. Org syntax is limited to one entry per list item. Nevertheless, the Texinfo export back-end can split that entry according to any text provided through the `:sep' attribute. Each part then becomes a new entry in the first column of the table. The following example illustrates all the attributes above: #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :table-type vtable :sep , :indic asis - foo, bar :: This is the common text for variables foo and bar. becomes @vtable @asis @item foo @itemx bar This is the common text for variables foo and bar. @end table  File: org, Node: Tables in Texinfo export, Next: Images in Texinfo export, Prev: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.10 Tables in Texinfo export --------------------------------- When exporting tables, the Texinfo export back-end uses the widest cell width in each column. To override this and instead specify as fractions of line length, use the `:columns' attribute. See example below. #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :columns .5 .5 | a cell | another cell |  File: org, Node: Images in Texinfo export, Next: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Prev: Tables in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.11 Images in Texinfo export --------------------------------- Insert a file link to the image in the Org file, and the Texinfo export back-end inserts the image. These links must have the usual supported image extensions and no descriptions. To scale the image, use `:width' and `:height' attributes. For alternate text, use `:alt' and specify the text using Texinfo code, as shown in the example: #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :width 1in :alt Alternate @i{text} [[ridt.pdf]]  File: org, Node: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Next: A Texinfo example, Prev: Images in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.12 Special blocks ----------------------- The Texinfo export back-end converts special blocks to commands with the same name. It also adds any `:options' attributes to the end of the command, as shown in this example: #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :options org-org-export-to-org ... #+begin_defun A somewhat obsessive function. #+end_defun becomes @defun org-org-export-to-org ... A somewhat obsessive function. @end defun  File: org, Node: A Texinfo example, Prev: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export 12.14.13 A Texinfo example -------------------------- Here is a more detailed example Org file. See *note GNU Sample Texts: (texinfo)GNU Sample Texts. for an equivalent example using Texinfo code. #+TITLE: GNU Sample {{{version}}} #+SUBTITLE: for version {{{version}}}, {{{updated}}} #+AUTHOR: A.U. Thor #+EMAIL: bug-sample@gnu.org #+OPTIONS: ':t toc:t author:t email:t #+LANGUAGE: en #+MACRO: version 2.0 #+MACRO: updated last updated 4 March 2014 #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: sample.info #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @syncodeindex pg cp #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo documentation system #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: sample: (sample) #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Invoking sample #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: GNU Sample This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}}, {{{updated}}}). * Copying :PROPERTIES: :COPYING: t :END: This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}}, {{{updated}}}), which is an example in the Texinfo documentation. Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. #+BEGIN_QUOTE Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License". #+END_QUOTE * Invoking sample #+PINDEX: sample #+CINDEX: invoking @command{sample} This is a sample manual. There is no sample program to invoke, but if there were, you could see its basic usage and command line options here. * GNU Free Documentation License :PROPERTIES: :APPENDIX: t :END: #+TEXINFO: @include fdl.texi * Index :PROPERTIES: :INDEX: cp :END:  File: org, Node: iCalendar export, Next: Other built-in back-ends, Prev: Texinfo export, Up: Exporting 12.15 iCalendar export ====================== A large part of Org mode's inter-operability success is its ability to easily export to or import from external applications. The iCalendar export back-end takes calendar data from Org files and exports to the standard iCalendar format. The iCalendar export back-end can also incorporate TODO entries based on the configuration of the `org-icalendar-include-todo' variable. The back-end exports plain timestamps as VEVENT, TODO items as VTODO, and also create events from deadlines that are in non-TODO items. The back-end uses the deadlines and scheduling dates in Org TODO items for setting the start and due dates for the iCalendar TODO entry. Consult the `org-icalendar-use-deadline' and `org-icalendar-use-scheduled' variables for more details. For tags on the headline, the iCalendar export back-end makes them into iCalendar categories. To tweak the inheritance of tags and TODO states, configure the variable `org-icalendar-categories'. To assign clock alarms based on time, configure the `org-icalendar-alarm-time' variable. The iCalendar format standard requires globally unique identifier--UID--for each entry. The iCalendar export back-end creates UIDs during export. To save a copy of the UID in the Org file set the variable `org-icalendar-store-UID'. The back-end looks for the `:ID:' property of the entry for re-using the same UID for subsequent exports. Since a single Org entry can result in multiple iCalendar entries--as timestamp, deadline, scheduled item, or TODO item--Org adds prefixes to the UID, depending on which part of the Org entry triggered the creation of the iCalendar entry. Prefixing ensures UIDs remains unique, yet enable synchronization programs trace the connections. `C-c C-e c f (`org-icalendar-export-to-ics')' Create iCalendar entries from the current Org buffer and store them in the same directory, using a file extension `.ics'. `C-c C-e c a (`org-icalendar-export-agenda-files')' Create iCalendar entries from Org files in `org-agenda-files' and store in a separate iCalendar file for each Org file. `C-c C-e c c (`org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files')' Create a combined iCalendar file from Org files in `org-agenda-files' and write it to `org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file' file name. The iCalendar export back-end includes SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION, LOCATION and TIMEZONE properties from the Org entries when exporting. To force the back-end to inherit the LOCATION and TIMEZONE properties, configure the `org-use-property-inheritance' variable. When Org entries do not have SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION properties, the iCalendar export back-end derives the summary from the headline, and derives the description from the body of the Org item. The `org-icalendar-include-body' variable limits the maximum number of characters of the content are turned into its description. The TIMEZONE property can be used to specify a per-entry time zone, and will be applied to any entry with timestamp information. Time zones should be specified as per the IANA time zone database format, e.g. "Asia/Almaty". Alternately, the property value can be "UTC", to force UTC time for this entry only. Exporting to iCalendar format depends in large part on the capabilities of the destination application. Some are more lenient than others. Consult the Org mode FAQ for advice on specific applications.  File: org, Node: Other built-in back-ends, Next: Advanced configuration, Prev: iCalendar export, Up: Exporting 12.16 Other built-in back-ends ============================== Other export back-ends included with Org are: * `ox-man.el': export to a man page. To activate such back-ends, either customize `org-export-backends' or load directly with `(require 'ox-man)'. On successful load, the back-end adds new keys in the export dispatcher (*note The export dispatcher::). Follow the comment section of such files, for example, `ox-man.el', for usage and configuration details.  File: org, Node: Advanced configuration, Next: Export in foreign buffers, Prev: Other built-in back-ends, Up: Exporting 12.17 Advanced configuration ============================ Hooks ----- The export process executes two hooks before the actual exporting begins. The first hook, `org-export-before-processing-hook', runs before any expansions of macros, Babel code, and include keywords in the buffer. The second hook, `org-export-before-parsing-hook', runs before the buffer is parsed. Both hooks are specified as functions, see example below. Their main use is for heavy duty structural modifications of the Org content. For example, removing every headline in the buffer during export: (defun my-headline-removal (backend) "Remove all headlines in the current buffer. BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol." (org-map-entries (lambda () (delete-region (point) (progn (forward-line) (point)))))) (add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal) Note that the hook function must have a mandatory argument that is a symbol for the back-end. Filters ------- The Org export process relies on filters to process specific parts of conversion process. Filters are just lists of functions to be applied to certain parts for a given back-end. The output from the first function in the filter is passed on to the next function in the filter. The final output is the output from the final function in the filter. The Org export process has many filter sets applicable to different types of objects, plain text, parse trees, export options, and final output formats. The filters are named after the element type or object type: `org-export-filter-TYPE-functions', where `TYPE' is the type targeted by the filter. Valid types are: body bold babel-call center-block clock code diary-sexp drawer dynamic-block entity example-block export-block export-snippet final-output fixed-width footnote-definition footnote-reference headline horizontal-rule inline-babel-call inline-src-block inlinetask italic item keyword latex-environment latex-fragment line-break link node-property options paragraph parse-tree plain-list plain-text planning property-drawer quote-block radio-target section special-block src-block statistics-cookie strike-through subscript superscript table table-cell table-row target timestamp underline verbatim verse-block Here is an example filter that replaces non-breaking spaces `~' in the Org buffer with `_' for the LaTeX back-end. (defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info) "Ensure \"_\" are properly handled in LaTeX export." (when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex) (replace-regexp-in-string "_" "~" text))) (add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions 'my-latex-filter-nobreaks) A filter requires three arguments: the code to be transformed, the name of the back-end, and some optional information about the export process. The third argument can be safely ignored. Note the use of `org-export-derived-backend-p' predicate that tests for `latex' back-end or any other back-end, such as `beamer', derived from `latex'. Defining filters for individual files ------------------------------------- The Org export can filter not just for back-ends, but also for specific files through the `#+BIND' keyword. Here is an example with two filters; one removes brackets from time stamps, and the other removes strike-through text. The filter functions are defined in a `src' code block in the same Org file, which is a handy location for debugging. #+BIND: org-export-filter-timestamp-functions (tmp-f-timestamp) #+BIND: org-export-filter-strike-through-functions (tmp-f-strike-through) #+begin_src emacs-lisp :exports results :results none (defun tmp-f-timestamp (s backend info) (replace-regexp-in-string "&[lg]t;\\|[][]" "" s)) (defun tmp-f-strike-through (s backend info) "") #+end_src Extending an existing back-end ------------------------------ Some parts of the conversion process can be extended for certain elements so as to introduce a new or revised translation. That is how the HTML export back-end was extended to handle Markdown format. The extensions work seamlessly so any aspect of filtering not done by the extended back-end is handled by the original back-end. Of all the export customization in Org, extending is very powerful as it operates at the parser level. For this example, make the `ascii' back-end display the language used in a source code block. Also make it display only when some attribute is non-`nil', like the following: #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t Then extend `ascii' back-end with a custom `my-ascii' back-end. (defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info) "Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII. CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication channel." (if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language)) (org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info) (concat (format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----" (org-element-property :language src-block) (replace-regexp-in-string "^" "| " (org-element-normalize-string (org-export-format-code-default src-block info))))))) (org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii :translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block))) The `my-ascii-src-block' function looks at the attribute above the current element. If not true, hands over to `ascii' back-end. If true, which it is in this example, it creates a box around the code and leaves room for the inserting a string for language. The last form creates the new back-end that springs to action only when translating `src-block' type elements. To use the newly defined back-end, call the following from an Org buffer: (org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*") Further steps to consider would be an interactive function, self-installing an item in the export dispatcher menu, and other user-friendly improvements.  File: org, Node: Export in foreign buffers, Prev: Advanced configuration, Up: Exporting 12.18 Export in foreign buffers =============================== The export back-ends in Org often include commands to convert selected regions. A convenient feature of this in-place conversion is that the exported output replaces the original source. Here are such functions: `org-html-convert-region-to-html' Convert the selected region into HTML. `org-latex-convert-region-to-latex' Convert the selected region into LaTeX. `org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo' Convert the selected region into `Texinfo'. `org-md-convert-region-to-md' Convert the selected region into `MarkDown'. In-place conversions are particularly handy for quick conversion of tables and lists in foreign buffers. For example, turn on the minor mode `M-x orgstruct-mode' in an HTML buffer, then use the convenient Org keyboard commands to create a list, select it, and covert it to HTML with `M-x org-html-convert-region-to-html RET'.  File: org, Node: Publishing, Next: Working with source code, Prev: Exporting, Up: Top 13 Publishing ************* Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure automatic HTML conversion of _projects_ composed of interlinked org files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web server. You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server. Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole. * Menu: * Configuration:: Defining projects * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server * Sample configuration:: Example projects * Triggering publication:: Publication commands  File: org, Node: Configuration, Next: Uploading files, Up: Publishing 13.1 Configuration ================== Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination and many other properties of a project. * Menu: * Project alist:: The central configuration variable * Sources and destinations:: From here to there * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/LaTeX export * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages  File: org, Node: Project alist, Next: Sources and destinations, Up: Configuration 13.1.1 The variable `org-publish-project-alist' ----------------------------------------------- Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one variable, called `org-publish-project-alist'. Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms: ("project-name" :property value :property value ...) i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values or ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...)) In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the `:components' property are taken to be sub-projects, which group together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such a "meta-project", all the components will also be published, in the sequence given.  File: org, Node: Sources and destinations, Next: Selecting files, Prev: Project alist, Up: Configuration 13.1.2 Sources and destinations for files ----------------------------------------- Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files, and where to put published files. `:base-directory' Directory containing publishing source files `:publishing-directory'Directory where output files will be published. You can directly publish to a web server using a file name syntax appropriate for the Emacs `tramp' package. Or you can publish to a local directory and use external tools to upload your website (*note Uploading files::). `:preparation-function'Function or list of functions to be called before starting the publishing process, for example, to run `make' for updating files to be published. Each preparation function is called with a single argument, the project property list. `:completion-function' Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. Each completion function is called with a single argument, the project property list.  File: org, Node: Selecting files, Next: Publishing action, Prev: Sources and destinations, Up: Configuration 13.1.3 Selecting files ---------------------- By default, all files with extension `.org' in the base directory are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the properties `:base-extension' Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a regular expression. Set this to the symbol `any' if you want to get all files in `:base-directory', even without extension. `:exclude' Regular expression to match file names that should not be published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their extension. `:include' List of files to be included regardless of `:base-extension' and `:exclude'. `:recursive' non-`nil' means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.  File: org, Node: Publishing action, Next: Publishing options, Prev: Selecting files, Up: Configuration 13.1.4 Publishing action ------------------------ Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function `org-html-publish-to-html', which calls the HTML exporter (*note HTML export::). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using `org-latex-publish-to-pdf' or as `ascii', `Texinfo', etc., using the corresponding functions. If you want to publish the Org file as an `.org' file but with the archived, commented and tag-excluded trees removed, use the function `org-org-publish-to-org'. This will produce `file.org' and put it in the publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of this file, set the parameter `:htmlized-source' to `t', it will produce `file.org.html' in the publishing directory(1). Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing destination. For this you can use `org-publish-attachment'. For non-org files, you always need to specify the publishing function: `:publishing-function' Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a list of functions, which will all be called in turn. `:htmlized-source' non-`nil' means, publish htmlized source. The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least a `:publishing-directory' property, the name of the file to be published and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If the publishing directory is the same than the source directory, `file.org' will be exported as `file.org.org', so probably don't want to do this.  File: org, Node: Publishing options, Next: Publishing links, Prev: Publishing action, Up: Configuration 13.1.5 Options for the exporters -------------------------------- The property list can be used to set export options during the publishing process. In most cases, these properties correspond to user variables in Org. While some properties are available for all export back-ends, most of them are back-end specific. The following sections list properties along with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string of these options for details. When a property is given a value in `org-publish-project-alist', its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any) during publishing. Options set within a file (*note Export settings::), however, override everything. Generic properties .................. `:archived-trees' `org-export-with-archived-trees' `:exclude-tags' `org-export-exclude-tags' `:headline-levels' `org-export-headline-levels' `:language' `org-export-default-language' `:preserve-breaks' `org-export-preserve-breaks' `:section-numbers' `org-export-with-section-numbers' `:select-tags' `org-export-select-tags' `:with-author' `org-export-with-author' `:with-broken-links' `org-export-with-broken-links' `:with-clocks' `org-export-with-clocks' `:with-creator' `org-export-with-creator' `:with-date' `org-export-with-date' `:with-drawers' `org-export-with-drawers' `:with-email' `org-export-with-email' `:with-emphasize' `org-export-with-emphasize' `:with-fixed-width' `org-export-with-fixed-width' `:with-footnotes' `org-export-with-footnotes' `:with-latex' `org-export-with-latex' `:with-planning' `org-export-with-planning' `:with-priority' `org-export-with-priority' `:with-properties' `org-export-with-properties' `:with-special-strings' `org-export-with-special-strings' `:with-sub-superscript' `org-export-with-sub-superscripts' `:with-tables' `org-export-with-tables' `:with-tags' `org-export-with-tags' `:with-tasks' `org-export-with-tasks' `:with-timestamps' `org-export-with-timestamps' `:with-title' `org-export-with-title' `:with-toc' `org-export-with-toc' `:with-todo-keywords' `org-export-with-todo-keywords' ASCII specific properties ......................... `:ascii-bullets' `org-ascii-bullets' `:ascii-caption-above' `org-ascii-caption-above' `:ascii-charset' `org-ascii-charset' `:ascii-global-margin' `org-ascii-global-margin' `:ascii-format-drawer-function' `org-ascii-format-drawer-function' `:ascii-format-inlinetask-function' `org-ascii-format-inlinetask-function' `:ascii-headline-spacing' `org-ascii-headline-spacing' `:ascii-indented-line-width' `org-ascii-indented-line-width' `:ascii-inlinetask-width' `org-ascii-inlinetask-width' `:ascii-inner-margin' `org-ascii-inner-margin' `:ascii-links-to-notes' `org-ascii-links-to-notes' `:ascii-list-margin' `org-ascii-list-margin' `:ascii-paragraph-spacing' `org-ascii-paragraph-spacing' `:ascii-quote-margin' `org-ascii-quote-margin' `:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines' `org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines' `:ascii-table-use-ascii-art' `org-ascii-table-use-ascii-art' `:ascii-table-widen-columns' `org-ascii-table-widen-columns' `:ascii-text-width' `org-ascii-text-width' `:ascii-underline' `org-ascii-underline' `:ascii-verbatim-format' `org-ascii-verbatim-format' Beamer specific properties .......................... `:beamer-theme' `org-beamer-theme' `:beamer-column-view-format' `org-beamer-column-view-format' `:beamer-environments-extra' `org-beamer-environments-extra' `:beamer-frame-default-options' `org-beamer-frame-default-options' `:beamer-outline-frame-options' `org-beamer-outline-frame-options' `:beamer-outline-frame-title' `org-beamer-outline-frame-title' `:beamer-subtitle-format' `org-beamer-subtitle-format' HTML specific properties ........................ `:html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors' `org-html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors' `:html-checkbox-type' `org-html-checkbox-type' `:html-container' `org-html-container-element' `:html-divs' `org-html-divs' `:html-doctype' `org-html-doctype' `:html-extension' `org-html-extension' `:html-footnote-format' `org-html-footnote-format' `:html-footnote-separator' `org-html-footnote-separator' `:html-footnotes-section' `org-html-footnotes-section' `:html-format-drawer-function' `org-html-format-drawer-function' `:html-format-headline-function' `org-html-format-headline-function' `:html-format-inlinetask-function' `org-html-format-inlinetask-function' `:html-head-extra' `org-html-head-extra' `:html-head-include-default-style' `org-html-head-include-default-style' `:html-head-include-scripts' `org-html-head-include-scripts' `:html-head' `org-html-head' `:html-home/up-format' `org-html-home/up-format' `:html-html5-fancy' `org-html-html5-fancy' `:html-indent' `org-html-indent' `:html-infojs-options' `org-html-infojs-options' `:html-infojs-template' `org-html-infojs-template' `:html-inline-image-rules' `org-html-inline-image-rules' `:html-inline-images' `org-html-inline-images' `:html-link-home' `org-html-link-home' `:html-link-org-files-as-html' `org-html-link-org-files-as-html' `:html-link-up' `org-html-link-up' `:html-link-use-abs-url' `org-html-link-use-abs-url' `:html-mathjax-options' `org-html-mathjax-options' `:html-mathjax-template' `org-html-mathjax-template' `:html-metadata-timestamp-format' `org-html-metadata-timestamp-format' `:html-postamble-format' `org-html-postamble-format' `:html-postamble' `org-html-postamble' `:html-preamble-format' `org-html-preamble-format' `:html-preamble' `org-html-preamble' `:html-table-align-individual-fields' `org-html-table-align-individual-fields' `:html-table-attributes' `org-html-table-default-attributes' `:html-table-caption-above' `org-html-table-caption-above' `:html-table-data-tags' `org-html-table-data-tags' `:html-table-header-tags' `org-html-table-header-tags' `:html-table-row-tags' `org-html-table-row-tags' `:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' `org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' `:html-tag-class-prefix' `org-html-tag-class-prefix' `:html-text-markup-alist' `org-html-text-markup-alist' `:html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' `org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' `:html-toplevel-hlevel' `org-html-toplevel-hlevel' `:html-use-infojs' `org-html-use-infojs' `:html-validation-link' `org-html-validation-link' `:html-viewport' `org-html-viewport' `:html-xml-declaration' `org-html-xml-declaration' LaTeX specific properties ......................... `:latex-active-timestamp-format' `org-latex-active-timestamp-format' `:latex-caption-above' `org-latex-caption-above' `:latex-classes' `org-latex-classes' `:latex-class' `org-latex-default-class' `:latex-compiler' `org-latex-compiler' `:latex-default-figure-position' `org-latex-default-figure-position' `:latex-default-table-environment' `org-latex-default-table-environment' `:latex-default-table-mode' `org-latex-default-table-mode' `:latex-diary-timestamp-format' `org-latex-diary-timestamp-format' `:latex-footnote-defined-format' `org-latex-footnote-defined-format' `:latex-footnote-separator' `org-latex-footnote-separator' `:latex-format-drawer-function' `org-latex-format-drawer-function' `:latex-format-headline-function' `org-latex-format-headline-function' `:latex-format-inlinetask-function' `org-latex-format-inlinetask-function' `:latex-hyperref-template' `org-latex-hyperref-template' `:latex-image-default-height' `org-latex-image-default-height' `:latex-image-default-option' `org-latex-image-default-option' `:latex-image-default-width' `org-latex-image-default-width' `:latex-images-centered' `org-latex-images-centered' `:latex-inactive-timestamp-format' `org-latex-inactive-timestamp-format' `:latex-inline-image-rules' `org-latex-inline-image-rules' `:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format' `org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format' `:latex-listings-langs' `org-latex-listings-langs' `:latex-listings-options' `org-latex-listings-options' `:latex-listings' `org-latex-listings' `:latex-minted-langs' `org-latex-minted-langs' `:latex-minted-options' `org-latex-minted-options' `:latex-prefer-user-labels' `org-latex-prefer-user-labels' `:latex-subtitle-format' `org-latex-subtitle-format' `:latex-subtitle-separate' `org-latex-subtitle-separate' `:latex-table-scientific-notation' `org-latex-table-scientific-notation' `:latex-tables-booktabs' `org-latex-tables-booktabs' `:latex-tables-centered' `org-latex-tables-centered' `:latex-text-markup-alist' `org-latex-text-markup-alist' `:latex-title-command' `org-latex-title-command' `:latex-toc-command' `org-latex-toc-command' Markdown specific properties ............................ `:md-footnote-format' `org-md-footnote-format' `:md-footnotes-section' `org-md-footnotes-section' `:md-headline-style' `org-md-headline-style' ODT specific properties ....................... `:odt-content-template-file' `org-odt-content-template-file' `:odt-display-outline-level' `org-odt-display-outline-level' `:odt-fontify-srcblocks' `org-odt-fontify-srcblocks' `:odt-format-drawer-function' `org-odt-format-drawer-function' `:odt-format-headline-function' `org-odt-format-headline-function' `:odt-format-inlinetask-function' `org-odt-format-inlinetask-function' `:odt-inline-formula-rules' `org-odt-inline-formula-rules' `:odt-inline-image-rules' `org-odt-inline-image-rules' `:odt-pixels-per-inch' `org-odt-pixels-per-inch' `:odt-styles-file' `org-odt-styles-file' `:odt-table-styles' `org-odt-table-styles' `:odt-use-date-fields' `org-odt-use-date-fields' Texinfo specific properties ........................... `:texinfo-active-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-active-timestamp-format' `:texinfo-classes' `org-texinfo-classes' `:texinfo-class' `org-texinfo-default-class' `:texinfo-table-default-markup' `org-texinfo-table-default-markup' `:texinfo-diary-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-diary-timestamp-format' `:texinfo-filename' `org-texinfo-filename' `:texinfo-format-drawer-function' `org-texinfo-format-drawer-function' `:texinfo-format-headline-function' `org-texinfo-format-headline-function' `:texinfo-format-inlinetask-function' `org-texinfo-format-inlinetask-function' `:texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format' `:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format' `org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format' `:texinfo-node-description-column' `org-texinfo-node-description-column' `:texinfo-table-scientific-notation' `org-texinfo-table-scientific-notation' `:texinfo-tables-verbatim' `org-texinfo-tables-verbatim' `:texinfo-text-markup-alist' `org-texinfo-text-markup-alist'  File: org, Node: Publishing links, Next: Sitemap, Prev: Publishing options, Up: Configuration 13.1.6 Links between published files ------------------------------------ To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something like `[[file:foo.org][The foo]]' or simply `file:foo.org' (*note External links::). When published, this link becomes a link to `foo.html'. You can thus interlink the pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want to link to it, use an `http:' link instead of a `file:' link, because `file:' links are converted to link to the corresponding `html' file. You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload the related files, these links will work too. See *note Complex example::, for an example of this usage. Eventually, links between published documents can contain some search options (*note Search options::), which will be resolved to the appropriate location in the linked file. For example, once published to HTML, the following links all point to a dedicated anchor in `foo.html'. [[file:foo.org::*heading]] [[file:foo.org::#custom-id]] [[file:foo.org::target]]  File: org, Node: Sitemap, Next: Generating an index, Prev: Publishing links, Up: Configuration 13.1.7 Generating a sitemap --------------------------- The following properties may be used to control publishing of a map of files for a given project. `:auto-sitemap' When non-`nil', publish a sitemap during `org-publish-current-project' or `org-publish-all'. `:sitemap-filename' Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to `sitemap.org' (which becomes `sitemap.html'). `:sitemap-title' Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file. `:sitemap-format-entry' With this option one can tell how a site-map entry is formatted in the site-map. It is a function called with three arguments: the file or directory name relative to base directory of the project, the site-map style and the current project. It is expected to return a string. Default value turns file names into links and use document titles as descriptions. For specific formatting needs, one can use `org-publish-find-date', `org-publish-find-title' and `org-publish-find-property', to retrieve additional information about published documents. `:sitemap-function' Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap. It is called with two arguments: the title of the site-map and a representation of the files and directories involved in the project as a radio list (*note Radio lists::). The latter can further be transformed using `org-list-to-generic', `org-list-to-subtree' and alike. Default value generates a plain list of links to all files in the project. `:sitemap-sort-folders' Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to `first' (default) or `last' to display folders first or last, respectively. When set to `ignore', folders are ignored altogether. Any other value will mix files and folders. This variable has no effect when site-map style is `tree'. `:sitemap-sort-files' How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to `alphabetically' (default), `chronologically' or `anti-chronologically'. `chronologically' sorts the files with older date first while `anti-chronologically' sorts the files with newer date first. `alphabetically' sorts the files alphabetically. The date of a file is retrieved with `org-publish-find-date'. `:sitemap-ignore-case' Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default `nil'. `:sitemap-date-format' Format string for the `format-time-string' function that tells how a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses `org-publish-sitemap-date-format' which defaults to `%Y-%m-%d'.  File: org, Node: Generating an index, Prev: Sitemap, Up: Configuration 13.1.8 Generating an index -------------------------- Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project. `:makeindex' When non-`nil', generate in index in the file `theindex.org' and publish it as `theindex.html'. The file will be created when first publishing a project with the `:makeindex' set. The file only contains a statement `#+INCLUDE: "theindex.inc"'. You can then build around this include statement by adding a title, style information, etc. Index entries are specified with `#+INDEX' keyword. An entry that contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. * Curriculum Vitae #+INDEX: CV #+INDEX: Application!CV  File: org, Node: Uploading files, Next: Sample configuration, Prev: Configuration, Up: Publishing 13.2 Uploading files ==================== For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as `rsync' or `unison', it might be preferable not to use the built in remote publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems under heavy usage. Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local directory (possibly even in place with your Org files) and then use `unison' or `rsync' to do the synchronization with the remote host. Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org files with `org-publish' and let the synchronization tool do the rest. You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as `jpg', `css' or `gif' files in the project definition since the 3rd party tool syncs them. Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set `org-publish-use-timestamps-flag' to `nil', you gain the main benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example files you might include with `#+INCLUDE:'. The timestamp mechanism in Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.  File: org, Node: Sample configuration, Next: Triggering publication, Prev: Uploading files, Up: Publishing 13.3 Sample configuration ========================= Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is more complex, with a multi-component project. * Menu: * Simple example:: One-component publishing * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example  File: org, Node: Simple example, Next: Complex example, Up: Sample configuration 13.3.1 Example: simple publishing configuration ----------------------------------------------- This example publishes a set of Org files to the `public_html' directory on the local machine. (setq org-publish-project-alist '(("org" :base-directory "~/org/" :publishing-directory "~/public_html" :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html :section-numbers nil :with-toc nil :html-head "")))  File: org, Node: Complex example, Prev: Simple example, Up: Sample configuration 13.3.2 Example: complex publishing configuration ------------------------------------------------ This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are excluded. To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in `~/org' and your publishable images in `~/images', you would link to an image with file:../images/myimage.png On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the right place on the web server, and publishing images to it. (setq org-publish-project-alist '(("orgfiles" :base-directory "~/org/" :base-extension "org" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/notebook/" :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp :headline-levels 3 :section-numbers nil :with-toc nil :html-head "" :html-preamble t) ("images" :base-directory "~/images/" :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/images/" :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) ("other" :base-directory "~/other/" :base-extension "css\\|el" :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/other/" :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))  File: org, Node: Triggering publication, Prev: Sample configuration, Up: Publishing 13.4 Triggering publication =========================== Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands: `C-c C-e P x (`org-publish')' Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it. `C-c C-e P p (`org-publish-current-project')' Publish the project containing the current file. `C-c C-e P f (`org-publish-current-file')' Publish only the current file. `C-c C-e P a (`org-publish-all')' Publish every project. Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands above, or by customizing the variable `org-publish-use-timestamps-flag'. This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via `#+SETUPFILE:' or `#+INCLUDE:'.  File: org, Node: Working with source code, Next: Miscellaneous, Prev: Publishing, Up: Top 14 Working with source code *************************** Source code here refers to any code typed in Org mode documents. Org can manage source code in any Org file once such code is tagged with begin and end markers. Working with source code begins with tagging source code blocks. Tagged `src' code blocks are not restricted to the preamble or the end of an Org document; they can go anywhere--with a few exceptions, such as not inside comments and fixed width areas. Here's a sample `src' code block in emacs-lisp: #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (defun org-xor (a b) "Exclusive or." (if a (not b) b)) #+END_SRC Org can take the code in the block between the `#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC' tags, and format, compile, execute, and show the results. Org can simplify many housekeeping tasks essential to modern code maintenance. That's why these blocks in Org mode literature are sometimes referred to as `live code' blocks (as compared to the static text and documentation around it). Users can control how `live' they want each block by tweaking the headers for compiling, execution, extraction. Org's `src' code block type is one of many block types, such as quote, export, verse, latex, example, and verbatim. This section pertains to `src' code blocks between `#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC' For editing `src' code blocks, Org provides native Emacs major-modes. That leverages the latest Emacs features for that source code language mode. For exporting, Org can then extract `src' code blocks into compilable source files (in a conversion process known as "tangling" in literate programming terminology). For publishing, Org's back-ends can handle the `src' code blocks and the text for output to a variety of formats with native syntax highlighting. For executing the source code in the `src' code blocks, Org provides facilities that glue the tasks of compiling, collecting the results of the execution, and inserting them back to the Org file. Besides text output, results may include links to other data types that Emacs can handle: audio, video, and graphics. An important feature of Org's execution of the `src' code blocks is passing variables, functions, and results between `src' blocks. Such interoperability uses a common syntax even if these `src' blocks are in different source code languages. The integration extends to linking the debugger's error messages to the line in the `src' code block in the Org file. That should partly explain why this functionality by the original contributors, Eric Schulte and Dan Davison, was called `Org Babel'. In literate programming, the main appeal is code and documentation co-existing in one file. Org mode takes this several steps further. First by enabling execution, and then by inserting results of that execution back into the Org file. Along the way, Org provides extensive formatting features, including handling tables. Org handles multiple source code languages in one file, and provides a common syntax for passing variables, functions, and results between `src' code blocks. Org mode fulfills the promise of easy verification and maintenance of publishing reproducible research by keeping all these in the same file: text, data, code, configuration settings of the execution environment, the results of the execution, and associated narratives, claims, references, and internal and external links. Details of Org's facilities for working with source code are shown next. * Menu: * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks * Languages:: List of supported code block languages * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line  File: org, Node: Structure of code blocks, Next: Editing source code, Up: Working with source code 14.1 Structure of code blocks ============================= Org offers two ways to structure source code in Org documents: in a `src' block, and directly inline. Both specifications are shown below. A `src' block conforms to this structure: #+NAME: #+BEGIN_SRC
#+END_SRC Org mode's templates system (*note Easy templates::) speeds up creating `src' code blocks with just three keystrokes. Do not be put-off by having to remember the source block syntax. Org also works with other completion systems in Emacs, some of which predate Org and have custom domain-specific languages for defining templates. Regular use of templates reduces errors, increases accuracy, and maintains consistency. An inline code block conforms to this structure: src_{} or src_[
]{} `#+NAME: ' Optional. Names the `src' block so it can be called, like a function, from other `src' blocks or inline blocks to evaluate or to capture the results. Code from other blocks, other files, and from table formulas (*note The spreadsheet::) can use the name to reference a `src' block. This naming serves the same purpose as naming Org tables. Org mode requires unique names. For duplicate names, Org mode's behavior is undefined. `#+BEGIN_SRC' `#+END_SRC' Mandatory. They mark the start and end of a block that Org requires. The `#+BEGIN_SRC' line takes additional arguments, as described next. `' Mandatory for live code blocks. It is the identifier of the source code language in the block. *Note Languages::, for identifiers of supported languages. `' Optional. Switches provide finer control of the code execution, export, and format (see the discussion of switches in *note Literal examples::) `
' Optional. Heading arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and tangling of code blocks (*note Header arguments::). Using Org's properties feature, header arguments can be selectively applied to the entire buffer or specific sub-trees of the Org document. `source code, header arguments' `' Source code in the dialect of the specified language identifier.  File: org, Node: Editing source code, Next: Exporting code blocks, Prev: Structure of code blocks, Up: Working with source code 14.2 Editing source code ======================== `C-c '' for editing the current code block. It opens a new major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the `src' code block, ready for any edits. `C-c '' again to close the buffer and return to the Org buffer. saves the buffer and updates the contents of the Org buffer. Set `org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay' to save the base buffer after a certain idle delay time. Set `org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save' to auto-save this buffer into a separate file using `auto-save-mode'. `C-c '' to close the major-mode buffer and return back to the Org buffer. While editing the source code in the major-mode, the `org-src-mode' minor mode remains active. It provides these customization variables as described below. For even more variables, look in the customization group `org-edit-structure'. `org-src-lang-modes' If an Emacs major-mode named `-mode' exists, where `' is the language identifier from code block's header line, then the edit buffer uses that major-mode. Use this variable to arbitrarily map language identifiers to major modes. `org-src-window-setup' For specifying Emacs window arrangement when the new edit buffer is created. `org-src-preserve-indentation' Default is `nil'. Source code is indented. This indentation applies during export or tangling, and depending on the context, may alter leading spaces and tabs. When non-`nil', source code is aligned with the leftmost column. No lines are modified during export or tangling, which is very useful for white-space sensitive languages, such as Python. `org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer' When `nil', Org returns to the edit buffer without further prompts. The default prompts for a confirmation. Set `org-src-fontify-natively' to non-`nil' to turn on native code fontification in the _Org_ buffer. Fontification of `src' code blocks can give visual separation of text and code on the display page. To further customize the appearance of `org-block' for specific languages, customize `org-src-block-faces'. The following example shades the background of regular blocks, and colors source blocks only for Python and Emacs-Lisp languages. (require 'color) (set-face-attribute 'org-block nil :background (color-darken-name (face-attribute 'default :background) 3)) (setq org-src-block-faces '(("emacs-lisp" (:background "#EEE2FF")) ("python" (:background "#E5FFB8"))))  File: org, Node: Exporting code blocks, Next: Extracting source code, Prev: Editing source code, Up: Working with source code 14.3 Exporting code blocks ========================== Org can flexibly export just the _code_ from the code blocks, just the _results_ of evaluation of the code block, _both_ the code and the results of the code block evaluation, or _none_. Org defaults to exporting _code_ for most languages. For some languages, such as `ditaa', Org defaults to _results_. To export just the body of code blocks, *note Literal examples::. To selectively export sub-trees of an Org document, *note Exporting::. The `:exports' header arguments control exporting code blocks only and not inline code: Header arguments: ................. `:exports code' This is the default for most languages where the body of the code block is exported. See *note Literal examples:: for more. `:exports results' On export, Org includes only the results and not the code block. After each evaluation, Org inserts the results after the end of code block in the Org buffer. By default, Org replaces any previous results. Org can also append results. `:exports both' Org exports both the code block and the results. `:exports none' Org does not export the code block nor the results. To stop Org from evaluating code blocks to speed exports, use the header argument `:eval never-export' (*note eval::). To stop Org from evaluating code blocks for greater security, set the `org-export-use-babel' variable to `nil', but understand that header arguments will have no effect. Turning off evaluation comes in handy when batch processing. For example, markup languages for wikis, which have a high risk of untrusted code. Stopping code block evaluation also stops evaluation of all header arguments of the code block. This may not be desirable in some circumstances. So during export, to allow evaluation of just the header arguments but not any code evaluation in the source block, set `:eval never-export' (*note eval::). Org never evaluates code blocks in commented sub-trees when exporting (*note Comment lines::). On the other hand, Org does evaluate code blocks in sub-trees excluded from export (*note Export settings::).  File: org, Node: Extracting source code, Next: Evaluating code blocks, Prev: Exporting code blocks, Up: Working with source code 14.4 Extracting source code =========================== Extracting source code from code blocks is a basic task in literate programming. Org has features to make this easy. In literate programming parlance, documents on creation are _woven_ with code and documentation, and on export, the code is _tangled_ for execution by a computer. Org facilitates weaving and tangling for producing, maintaining, sharing, and exporting literate programming documents. Org provides extensive customization options for extracting source code. When Org tangles `src' code blocks, it expands, merges, and transforms them. Then Org recomposes them into one or more separate files, as configured through the options. During this _tangling_ process, Org expands variables in the source code, and resolves any Noweb style references (*note Noweb reference syntax::). Header arguments ................ `:tangle no' By default, Org does not tangle the `src' code block on export. `:tangle yes' Org extracts the contents of the code block for the tangled output. By default, the output file name is the same as the Org file but with a file extension derived from the language identifier of the `src' code block. `:tangle filename' Override the default file name with this one for the tangled output. Functions ......... `org-babel-tangle' Tangle the current file. Bound to `C-c C-v t'. With prefix argument only tangle the current `src' code block. `org-babel-tangle-file' Choose a file to tangle. Bound to `C-c C-v f'. Hooks ..... `org-babel-post-tangle-hook' This hook runs from within code tangled by `org-babel-tangle', making it suitable for post-processing, compilation, and evaluation of code in the tangled files. Jumping between code and Org ............................ Debuggers normally link errors and messages back to the source code. But for tangled files, we want to link back to the Org file, not to the tangled source file. To make this extra jump, Org uses `org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org' function with two additional source code block header arguments: One, set `padline' (*note padline::) to true (the default setting). Two, set `comments' (*note comments::) to `link', which makes Org insert links to the Org file.  File: org, Node: Evaluating code blocks, Next: Library of Babel, Prev: Extracting source code, Up: Working with source code 14.5 Evaluating code blocks =========================== A note about security: With code evaluation comes the risk of harm. Org safeguards by prompting for user's permission before executing any code in the source block. To customize this safeguard (or disable it) see *note Code evaluation security::. Org captures the results of the `src' code block evaluation and inserts them in the Org file, right after the `src' code block. The insertion point is after a newline and the `#+RESULTS' label. Org creates the `#+RESULTS' label if one is not already there. By default, Org enables only `emacs-lisp' `src' code blocks for execution. See *note Languages:: for identifiers to enable other languages. Org provides many ways to execute `src' code blocks. `C-c C-c' or `C-c C-v e' with the point on a `src' code block(1) calls the `org-babel-execute-src-block' function, which executes the code in the block, collects the results, and inserts them in the buffer. By calling a named code block(2) from an Org mode buffer or a table. Org can call the named `src' code blocks from the current Org mode buffer or from the "Library of Babel" (*note Library of Babel::). Whether inline syntax or the `#+CALL:' syntax is used, the result is wrapped based on the variable `org-babel-inline-result-wrap', which by default is set to `"=%s="' to produce verbatim text suitable for markup. The syntax for `#+CALL:' is #+CALL: () #+CALL: []() The syntax for inline named code block is ... call_() ... ... call_[]()[] ... `' This is the name of the code block to be evaluated (*note Structure of code blocks::). `' Org passes arguments to the code block using standard function call syntax. For example, a `#+CALL:' line that passes `4' to a code block named `double', which declares the header argument `:var n=2', would be written as `#+CALL: double(n=4)'. Note how this function call syntax is different from the header argument syntax. `' Org passes inside header arguments to the named `src' code block using the header argument syntax. Inside header arguments apply to code block evaluation. For example, `[:results output]' collects results printed to `STDOUT' during code execution of that block. Note how this header argument syntax is different from the function call syntax. `' End header arguments affect the results returned by the code block. For example, `:results html' wraps the results in a `BEGIN_EXPORT html' block before inserting the results in the Org buffer. For more examples of header arguments for `#+CALL:' lines, *note Arguments in function calls::. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The option `org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c' can be used to remove code evaluation from the `C-c C-c' key binding. (2) Actually, the constructs call_() and src_{} are not evaluated when they appear in a keyword line (i.e. lines starting with `#+KEYWORD:', *note In-buffer settings::).  File: org, Node: Library of Babel, Next: Languages, Prev: Evaluating code blocks, Up: Working with source code 14.6 Library of Babel ===================== The "Library of Babel" is a collection of code blocks. Like a function library, these code blocks can be called from other Org files. A collection of useful code blocks is available on Worg (http://orgmode.org/worg/library-of-babel.html). For remote code block evaluation syntax, *note Evaluating code blocks::. For any user to add code to the library, first save the code in regular `src' code blocks of an Org file, and then load the Org file with `org-babel-lob-ingest', which is bound to `C-c C-v i'.  File: org, Node: Languages, Next: Header arguments, Prev: Library of Babel, Up: Working with source code 14.7 Languages ============== Org supports the following languages for the `src' code blocks: Language Identifier Language Identifier ---------------------------------------------------------------------------- Asymptote asymptote Awk awk C C C++ C++ Clojure clojure CSS css D d ditaa ditaa Graphviz dot Emacs Calc calc Emacs Lisp emacs-lisp Fortran fortran gnuplot gnuplot Haskell haskell Java java Javascript js LaTeX latex Ledger ledger Lisp lisp Lilypond lilypond Lua lua MATLAB matlab Mscgen mscgen Objective Caml ocaml Octave octave Org mode org Oz oz Perl perl Plantuml plantuml Processing.js processing Python python R R Ruby ruby Sass sass Scheme scheme GNU Screen screen Sed sed shell sh SQL sql SQLite sqlite Vala vala Additional documentation for some languages are at `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html'. By default, only `emacs-lisp' is enabled for evaluation. To enable or disable other languages, customize the `org-babel-load-languages' variable either through the Emacs customization interface, or by adding code to the init file as shown next: In this example, evaluation is disabled for `emacs-lisp', and enabled for `R'. (org-babel-do-load-languages 'org-babel-load-languages '((emacs-lisp . nil) (R . t))) Note that this is not the only way to enable a language. Org also enables languages when loaded with `require' statement. For example, the following enables execution of `clojure' code blocks: (require 'ob-clojure)  File: org, Node: Header arguments, Next: Results of evaluation, Prev: Languages, Up: Working with source code 14.8 Header arguments ===================== Details of configuring header arguments are shown here. * Menu: * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments  File: org, Node: Using header arguments, Next: Specific header arguments, Up: Header arguments 14.8.1 Using header arguments ----------------------------- Since header arguments can be set in several ways, Org prioritizes them in case of overlaps or conflicts by giving local settings a higher priority. Header values in function calls, for example, override header values from global defaults. * Menu: * System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific * Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file * Language-specific mode properties:: * Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method * Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority  File: org, Node: System-wide header arguments, Next: Language-specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments System-wide header arguments ............................ System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by adapting the `org-babel-default-header-args' variable: :session => "none" :results => "replace" :exports => "code" :cache => "no" :noweb => "no" This example sets `:noweb' header arguments to `yes', which makes Org expand `:noweb' references by default. (setq org-babel-default-header-args (cons '(:noweb . "yes") (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))  File: org, Node: Language-specific header arguments, Next: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Prev: System-wide header arguments, Up: Using header arguments Language-specific header arguments .................................. Each language can have separate default header arguments by customizing the variable `org-babel-default-header-args:', where `' is the name of the language. For details, see the language-specific online documentation at `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel'.  File: org, Node: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Next: Language-specific mode properties, Prev: Language-specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments Header arguments in Org mode properties ....................................... For header arguments applicable to the buffer, use `#+PROPERTY:' lines anywhere in the Org mode file (*note Property syntax::). The following example sets only for `R' code blocks to `session', making all the `R' code blocks execute in the same session. Setting `results' to `silent' ignores the results of executions for all blocks, not just `R' code blocks; no results inserted for any block. #+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R* #+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent Header arguments set through Org's property drawers (*note Property syntax::) apply at the sub-tree level on down. Since these property drawers can appear anywhere in the file hierarchy, Org uses outermost call or source block to resolve the values. Org ignores `org-use-property-inheritance' setting. In this example, `:cache' defaults to `yes' for all code blocks in the sub-tree starting with `sample header'. * sample header :PROPERTIES: :header-args: :cache yes :END: Properties defined through `org-set-property' function, bound to `C-c C-x p', apply to all active languages. They override properties set in `org-babel-default-header-args'.  File: org, Node: Language-specific mode properties, Next: Code block specific header arguments, Prev: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Up: Using header arguments Language-specific mode properties ................................. Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties `header-args:' where `' is the language identifier. For example, * Heading :PROPERTIES: :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1* :header-args:R: :session *R* :END: ** Subheading :PROPERTIES: :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2* :END: would force separate sessions for clojure blocks in Heading and Subheading, but use the same session for all `R' blocks. Blocks in Subheading inherit settings from Heading.  File: org, Node: Code block specific header arguments, Next: Arguments in function calls, Prev: Language-specific mode properties, Up: Using header arguments Code block specific header arguments .................................... Header arguments are most commonly set at the `src' code block level, on the `#+BEGIN_SRC' line. Arguments set at this level take precedence over those set in the `org-babel-default-header-args' variable, and also those set as header properties. In the following example, setting `results' to `silent' makes it ignore results of the code execution. Setting `:exports' to `code' exports only the body of the `src' code block to HTML or LaTeX.: #+NAME: factorial #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0 fac 0 = 1 fac n = n * fac (n-1) #+END_SRC The same header arguments in an inline `src' code block: src_haskell[:exports both]{fac 5} Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using `#+HEADER:' on each line. Note that Org currently accepts the plural spelling of `#+HEADER:' only as a convenience for backward-compatibility. It may be removed at some point. Multi-line header arguments on an unnamed `src' code block: #+HEADER: :var data1=1 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : data1:1, data2:2 Multi-line header arguments on a named `src' code block: #+NAME: named-block #+HEADER: :var data=2 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp (message "data:%S" data) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: named-block : data:2  File: org, Node: Arguments in function calls, Prev: Code block specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments Arguments in function calls ........................... Header arguments in function calls are the most specific and override all other settings in case of an overlap. They get the highest priority. Two `#+CALL:' examples are shown below. For the complete syntax of `#+CALL:' lines, see *note Evaluating code blocks::. In this example, `:exports results' header argument is applied to the evaluation of the `#+CALL:' line. #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results In this example, `:session special' header argument is applied to the evaluation of `factorial' code block. #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)  File: org, Node: Specific header arguments, Prev: Using header arguments, Up: Header arguments 14.8.2 Specific header arguments -------------------------------- Org comes with many header arguments common to all languages. New header arguments are added for specific languages as they become available for use in `src' code blocks. A header argument is specified with an initial colon followed by the argument's name in lowercase. Common header arguments are: * Menu: * var:: Pass arguments to `src' code blocks * results:: Specify results type; how to collect * file:: Specify a path for output file * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results * file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output * output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file * dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution * exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none * tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name * mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target * noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables * colnames:: Handle column names in tables * rownames:: Handle row names in tables * shebang:: Make tangled files executable * tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results * post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation * prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block * epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block For language-specific header arguments, see *note Languages::.  File: org, Node: var, Next: results, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.1 `:var' ............... Use `:var' for passing arguments to `src' code blocks. The specifics of variables in `src' code blocks vary by the source language and are covered in the language-specific documentation. The syntax for `:var', however, is the same for all languages. This includes declaring a variable, and assigning a default value. Arguments can take values as literals, or as references, or even as Emacs Lisp code (*note Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables: var.). References are names from the Org file from the lines `#+NAME:' or `#+RESULTS:'. References can also refer to tables, lists, `#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE' blocks, other types of `src' code blocks, or the results of execution of `src' code blocks. For better performance, Org can cache results of evaluations. But caching comes with severe limitations (*note cache::). Argument values are indexed like arrays (*note Indexable variable values: var.). The following syntax is used to pass arguments to `src' code blocks using the `:var' header argument. :var name=assign The `assign' is a literal value, such as a string `"string"', a number `9', a reference to a table, a list, a literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the results from evaluating a code block. Here are examples of passing values by reference: "table" an Org mode table named with either a `#+NAME:' line #+NAME: example-table | 1 | | 2 | | 3 | | 4 | #+NAME: table-length #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table (length table) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: table-length : 4 "list" a simple list named with a `#+NAME:' line. Note that only the top level list items are passed along. Nested list items are ignored. #+NAME: example-list - simple - not - nested - list #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list (print x) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | simple | list | "code block without arguments" a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by `#+NAME:', optionally followed by parentheses #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length() (* 2 length) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : 8 "code block with arguments" a `src' code block name, as assigned by `#+NAME:', followed by parentheses and optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the `src' code block name using standard function call syntax #+NAME: double #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8 (* 2 input) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: double : 16 #+NAME: squared #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=2) (* input input) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: squared : 4 "literal example" a literal example block named with a `#+NAME:' line #+NAME: literal-example #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE A literal example on two lines #+END_EXAMPLE #+NAME: read-literal-example #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example (concatenate 'string x " for you.") #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: read-literal-example : A literal example : on two lines for you. Indexable variable values ......................... Indexing variable values enables referencing portions of a variable. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting backwards from the end. If an index is separated by `,'s then each subsequent section will index as the next dimension. Note that this indexing occurs _before_ other table-related header arguments are applied, such as `:hlines', `:colnames' and `:rownames'. The following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table `example-table' to the variable `data': #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : a Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a `:', in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For example the following assigns the middle three rows of `example-table' to `data'. #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | | 5 | 3 | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | To pick the entire range, use an empty index, or the single character `*'. `0:-1' does the same thing. Example below shows how to reference the first column only. #+NAME: example-table | 1 | a | | 2 | b | | 3 | c | | 4 | d | #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | Index referencing can be used for tables and code blocks. Index referencing can handle any number of dimensions. Commas delimit multiple dimensions, as shown below. #+NAME: 3D #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9)) ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18)) ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27))) #+END_SRC #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1] data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: | 11 | 14 | 17 | Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables .................................. Emacs lisp code can set the values for variables. To differentiate a value from lisp code, Org interprets any value starting with `(', `[', `'' or ``' as Emacs Lisp code. The result of evaluating that code is then assigned to the value of that variable. The following example shows how to reliably query and pass file name of the Org mode buffer to a code block using headers. We need reliability here because the file's name could change once the code in the block starts executing. #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both wc -w $filename #+END_SRC Note that values read from tables and lists will not be mistakenly evaluated as Emacs Lisp code, as illustrated in the following example. #+NAME: table | (a b c) | #+HEADER: :var data=table[0,0] #+BEGIN_SRC perl $data #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : (a b c)  File: org, Node: results, Next: file, Prev: var, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.2 `:results' ................... There are four classes of `:results' header arguments. Each `src' code block can take only one option per class. * collection for how the results should be collected from the `src' code block * type for which type of result the code block will return; affects how Org processes and inserts results in the Org buffer * format for the result; affects how Org processes and inserts results in the Org buffer * handling for processing results after evaluation of the `src' code block Collection .......... Collection options specify the results. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. * `value' Default. Functional mode. Result is the value returned by the last statement in the `src' code block. Languages like Python may require an explicit `return' statement in the `src' code block. Usage example: `:results value'. * `output' Scripting mode. Result is collected from STDOUT during execution of the code in the `src' code block. Usage example: `:results output'. Type .... Type tells what result types to expect from the execution of the code block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default behavior is to automatically determine the result type. * `table', `vector' Interpret the results as an Org table. If the result is a single value, create a table with one row and one column. Usage example: `:results value table'. * `list' Interpret the results as an Org list. If the result is a single value, create a list of one element. * `scalar', `verbatim' Interpret literally and insert as quoted text. Do not create a table. Usage example: `:results value verbatim'. * `file' Interpret as path to a file. Inserts a link to the file. Usage example: `:results value file'. Format ...... Format pertains to the type of the result returned by the `src' code block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The default follows from the type specified above. * `raw' Interpreted as raw Org mode. Inserted directly into the buffer. Aligned if it is a table. Usage example: `:results value raw'. * `org' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_SRC org' block. For comma-escape, either `TAB' in the block, or export the file. Usage example: `:results value org'. * `html' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_EXPORT html' block. Usage example: `:results value html'. * `latex' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_EXPORT latex' block. Usage example: `:results value latex'. * `code' Result enclosed in a `src' code block. Useful for parsing. Usage example: `:results value code'. * `pp' Result converted to pretty-print source code. Enclosed in a `src' code block. Languages supported: Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. Usage example: `:results value pp'. * `drawer' Result wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. Useful for containing `raw' or `org' results for later scripting and automated processing. Usage example: `:results value drawer'. Handling ........ Handling options after collecting the results. * `silent' Do not insert results in the Org mode buffer, but echo them in the minibuffer. Usage example: `:results output silent'. * `replace' Default. Insert results in the Org buffer. Remove previous results. Usage example: `:results output replace'. * `append' Append results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the bottom. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: `:results output append'. * `prepend' Prepend results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at the top. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: `:results output prepend'.  File: org, Node: file, Next: file-desc, Prev: results, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.3 `:file' ................ An external `:file' that saves the results of execution of the code block. The `:file' is either a file name or two strings, where the first is the file name and the second is the description. A link to the file is inserted. It uses an Org mode style `[[file:]]' link (*note Link format::). Some languages, such as `R', `dot', `ditaa', and `gnuplot', automatically wrap the source code in additional boilerplate code. Such code wrapping helps recreate the output, especially graphics output, by executing just the `:file' contents.  File: org, Node: file-desc, Next: file-ext, Prev: file, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.4 `:file-desc' ..................... A description of the results file. Org uses this description for the link (see *note Link format::) it inserts in the Org file. If the `:file-desc' has no value, Org will use file name for both the "link" and the "description" portion of the Org mode link.  File: org, Node: file-ext, Next: output-dir, Prev: file-desc, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.5 `:file-ext' .................... File name extension for the output file. Org generates the file's complete name, and extension by combining `:file-ext', `#+NAME:' of the source block, and the *note output-dir:: header argument. To override this auto generated file name, use the `:file' header argument.  File: org, Node: output-dir, Next: dir, Prev: file-ext, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.6 `:output-dir' ...................... Specifies the `:output-dir' for the results file. Org accepts an absolute path (beginning with `/') or a relative directory (without `/'). The value can be combined with `#+NAME:' of the source block and *note file:: or *note file-ext:: header arguments.  File: org, Node: dir, Next: exports, Prev: output-dir, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.7 `:dir' and remote execution .................................... While the `:file' header argument can be used to specify the path to the output file, `:dir' specifies the default directory during `src' code block execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current buffer is used. In other words, supplying `:dir path' temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with `M-x cd path RET', and then not supplying `:dir'. Under the surface, `:dir' simply sets the value of the Emacs variable `default-directory'. When using `:dir', relative paths (for example, `:file myfile.jpg' or `:file results/myfile.jpg') become relative to the default directory. For example, to save the plot file in the `Work' folder of the home directory (notice tilde is expanded): #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l") #+END_SRC Remote execution ................ To evaluate the `src' code block on a remote machine, supply a remote s directory name using `Tramp' syntax. For example: #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu: plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE)) #+END_SRC Org first captures the text results as usual for insertion in the Org file. Then Org also inserts a link to the remote file, thanks to Emacs `Tramp'. Org constructs the remote path to the file name from `:dir' and `default-directory', as illustrated here: [[file:/scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]] Some more warnings .................. * When `:dir' is used with `:session', Org sets the starting directory for a new session. But Org will not alter the directory of an already existing session. * Do not use `:dir' with `:exports results' or with `:exports both' to avoid Org inserting incorrect links to remote files. That is because Org does not expand `default directory' to avoid some underlying portability issues.  File: org, Node: exports, Next: tangle, Prev: dir, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.8 `:exports' ................... The `:exports' header argument is to specify if that part of the Org file is exported to, say, HTML or LaTeX formats. Note that `:exports' affects only `src' code blocks and not inline code. * `code' The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. Example: `:exports code'. * `results' The results of evaluation of the code is included in the exported file. Example: `:exports results'. * `both' Both the code and results of evaluation are included in the exported file. Example: `:exports both'. * `none' Neither the code nor the results of evaluation is included in the exported file. Whether the code is evaluated at all depends on other options. Example: `:exports none'.  File: org, Node: tangle, Next: mkdirp, Prev: exports, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.9 `:tangle' .................. The `:tangle' header argument specifies if the `src' code block is exported to source file(s). * `tangle' Export the `src' code block to source file. The file name for the source file is derived from the name of the Org file, and the file extension is derived from the source code language identifier. Example: `:tangle yes'. * `no' The default. Do not extract the code a source code file. Example: `:tangle no'. * other Export the `src' code block to source file whose file name is derived from any string passed to the `:tangle' header argument. Org derives the file name as being relative to the directory of the Org file's location. Example: `:tangle path'.  File: org, Node: mkdirp, Next: comments, Prev: tangle, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.10 `:mkdirp' ................... The `:mkdirp' header argument creates parent directories for tangled files if the directory does not exist. `yes' enables directory creation and `no' inhibits directory creation.  File: org, Node: comments, Next: padline, Prev: mkdirp, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.11 `:comments' ..................... Controls inserting comments into tangled files. These are above and beyond whatever comments may already exist in the `src' code block. * `no' The default. Do not insert any extra comments during tangling. * `link' Wrap the `src' code block in comments. Include links pointing back to the place in the Org file from where the code was tangled. * `yes' Kept for backward compatibility; same as "link". * `org' Nearest headline text from Org file is inserted as comment. The exact text that is inserted is picked from the leading context of the source block. * `both' Includes both "link" and "org" comment options. * `noweb' Includes "link" comment option, expands noweb references, and wraps them in link comments inside the body of the `src' code block.  File: org, Node: padline, Next: no-expand, Prev: comments, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.12 `:padline' .................... Control insertion of newlines to pad `src' code blocks in the tangled file. * `yes' Default. Insert a newline before and after each `src' code block in the tangled file. * `no' Do not insert newlines to pad the tangled `src' code blocks.  File: org, Node: no-expand, Next: session, Prev: padline, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.13 `:no-expand' ...................... By default Org expands `src' code blocks during tangling. The `:no-expand' header argument turns off such expansions. Note that one side-effect of expansion by `org-babel-expand-src-block' also assigns values to `:var' (*note var::) variables. Expansions also replace Noweb references with their targets (*note Noweb reference syntax::). Some of these expansions may cause premature assignment, hence this option. This option makes a difference only for tangling. It has no effect when exporting since `src' code blocks for execution have to be expanded anyway.  File: org, Node: session, Next: noweb, Prev: no-expand, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.14 `:session' .................... The `:session' header argument is for running multiple source code blocks under one session. Org runs `src' code blocks with the same session name in the same interpreter process. * `none' Default. Each `src' code block gets a new interpreter process to execute. The process terminates once the block is evaluated. * `other' Any string besides `none' turns that string into the name of that session. For example, `:session mysession' names it `mysession'. If `:session' has no argument, then the session name is derived from the source language identifier. Subsequent blocks with the same source code language use the same session. Depending on the language, state variables, code from other blocks, and the overall interpreted environment may be shared. Some interpreted languages support concurrent sessions when subsequent source code language blocks change session names.  File: org, Node: noweb, Next: noweb-ref, Prev: session, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.15 `:noweb' .................. The `:noweb' header argument controls expansion of Noweb syntax references (*note Noweb reference syntax::). Expansions occur when source code blocks are evaluated, tangled, or exported. * `no' Default. No expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the code when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. * `yes' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the `src' code block when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. * `tangle' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the `src' code block when tangling. No expansion when evaluating or exporting. * `no-export' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the `src' code block when evaluating or tangling. No expansion when exporting. * `strip-export' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the `src' code block when expanding prior to evaluating or tangling. Removes Noweb syntax references when exporting. * `eval' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the `src' code block only before evaluating. Noweb prefix lines .................. Noweb insertions now honor prefix characters that appear before the Noweb syntax reference. This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the `<>' noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax, each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented. With: #+NAME: example #+BEGIN_SRC text this is the multi-line body of example #+END_SRC this `src' code block: #+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes -- <> #+END_SRC expands to: -- this is the -- multi-line body of example Since this change will not affect noweb replacement text without newlines in them, inline noweb references are acceptable. This feature can also be used for management of indentation in exported code snippets. With: #+NAME: if-true #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none print('Do things when True') #+END_SRC #+NAME: if-false #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none print('Do things when False') #+END_SRC this `src' code block: #+BEGIN_SRC python :noweb yes :results output if True: <> else: <> #+END_SRC expands to: if True: print('Do things when True') else: print('Do things when False') and evaluates to: Do things when True  File: org, Node: noweb-ref, Next: noweb-sep, Prev: noweb, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.16 `:noweb-ref' ...................... When expanding Noweb style references, Org concatenates `src' code blocks by matching the reference name to either the code block name or the `:noweb-ref' header argument. For simple concatenation, set this `:noweb-ref' header argument at the sub-tree or file level. In the example Org file shown next, the body of the source code in each block is extracted for concatenation to a pure code file when tangled. #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh <> #+END_SRC * the mount point of the fullest disk :PROPERTIES: :header-args: :noweb-ref fullest-disk :END: ** query all mounted disks #+BEGIN_SRC sh df \ #+END_SRC ** strip the header row #+BEGIN_SRC sh |sed '1d' \ #+END_SRC ** output mount point of fullest disk #+BEGIN_SRC sh |awk '{if (u < +$5) {u = +$5; m = $6}} END {print m}' #+END_SRC  File: org, Node: noweb-sep, Next: cache, Prev: noweb-ref, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.17 `:noweb-sep' ...................... By default a newline separates each noweb reference concatenation. To change this newline separator, edit the `:noweb-sep' (*note noweb-sep::) header argument.  File: org, Node: cache, Next: sep, Prev: noweb-sep, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.18 `:cache' .................. The `:cache' header argument is for caching results of evaluating code blocks. Caching results can avoid re-evaluating `src' code blocks that have not changed since the previous run. To benefit from the cache and avoid redundant evaluations, the source block must have a result already present in the buffer, and neither the header arguments (including the value of `:var' references) nor the text of the block itself has changed since the result was last computed. This feature greatly helps avoid long-running calculations. For some edge cases, however, the cached results may not be reliable. The caching feature is best for when `src' blocks are pure functions, that is functions that return the same value for the same input arguments (*note var::), and that do not have side effects, and do not rely on external variables other than the input arguments. Functions that depend on a timer, file system objects, and random number generators are clearly unsuitable for caching. A note of warning: when `:cache' is used for a `:session', caching may cause unexpected results. When the caching mechanism tests for any source code changes, it will not expand Noweb style references (*note Noweb reference syntax::). For reasons why, see `http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.emacs.orgmode/79046'. The `:cache' header argument can have one of two values: `yes' or `no'. * `no' Default. No caching of results; `src' code block evaluated every time. * `yes' Whether to run the code or return the cached results is determined by comparing the SHA1 hash value of the combined `src' code block and arguments passed to it. This hash value is packed on the `#+RESULTS:' line from previous evaluation. When hash values match, Org does not evaluate the `src' code block. When hash values mismatch, Org evaluates the `src' code block, inserts the results, recalculates the hash value, and updates `#+RESULTS:' line. In this example, both functions are cached. But `caller' runs only if the result from `random' has changed since the last run. #+NAME: random #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes runif(1) #+END_SRC #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random 0.4659510825295 #+NAME: caller #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes x #+END_SRC #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller 0.254227238707244  File: org, Node: sep, Next: hlines, Prev: cache, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.19 `:sep' ................ The `:sep' header argument is the delimiter for saving results as tables to files (*note file::) external to Org mode. Org defaults to tab delimited output. The function, `org-open-at-point', which is bound to `C-c C-o', also uses `:sep' for opening tabular results.  File: org, Node: hlines, Next: colnames, Prev: sep, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.20 `:hlines' ................... In-between each table row or below the table headings, sometimes results have horizontal lines, which are also known as hlines. The `:hlines' argument with the value `yes' accepts such lines. The default is `no'. * `no' Strips horizontal lines from the input table. For most code, this is desirable, or else those `hline' symbols raise unbound variable errors. The default is `:hlines no'. The example shows hlines removed from the input table. #+NAME: many-cols | a | b | c | |---+---+---| | d | e | f | |---+---+---| | g | h | i | #+NAME: echo-table #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols return tab #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: echo-table | a | b | c | | d | e | f | | g | h | i | * `yes' For `:hlines yes', the example shows hlines unchanged. #+NAME: many-cols | a | b | c | |---+---+---| | d | e | f | |---+---+---| | g | h | i | #+NAME: echo-table #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes return tab #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: echo-table | a | b | c | |---+---+---| | d | e | f | |---+---+---| | g | h | i |  File: org, Node: colnames, Next: rownames, Prev: hlines, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.21 `:colnames' ..................... The `:colnames' header argument accepts `yes', `no', or `nil' values. The default value is `nil', which is unassigned. But this header argument behaves differently depending on the source code language. * `nil' If an input table has column names (because the second row is an hline), then Org removes the column names, processes the table, puts back the column names, and then writes the table to the results block. #+NAME: less-cols | a | |---| | b | | c | #+NAME: echo-table-again #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab] #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: echo-table-again | a | |----| | b* | | c* | Note that column names have to accounted for when using variable indexing (*note Indexable variable values: var.) because column names are not removed for indexing. * `no' Do not pre-process column names. * `yes' For an input table that has no hlines, process it like the `nil' value. That is, Org removes the column names, processes the table, puts back the column names, and then writes the table to the results block.  File: org, Node: rownames, Next: shebang, Prev: colnames, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.22 `:rownames' ..................... The `:rownames' header argument can take on values `yes' or `no' values. The default is `no'. Note that `emacs-lisp' code blocks ignore `:rownames' header argument because of the ease of table-handling in Emacs. * `no' Org will not pre-process row names. * `yes' If an input table has row names, then Org removes the row names, processes the table, puts back the row names, and then writes the table to the results block. #+NAME: with-rownames | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | #+NAME: echo-table-once-again #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab] #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 | | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 | Note that row names have to accounted for when using variable indexing (*note Indexable variable values: var.) because row names are not removed for indexing.  File: org, Node: shebang, Next: tangle-mode, Prev: rownames, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.23 `:shebang' .................... This header argument can turn results into executable script files. By setting the `:shebang' header argument to a string value (for example, `:shebang "#!/bin/bash"'), Org inserts that string as the first line of the tangled file that the `src' code block is extracted to. Org then turns on the tangled file's executable permission.  File: org, Node: tangle-mode, Next: eval, Prev: shebang, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.24 `:tangle-mode' ........................ The `tangle-mode' header argument specifies what permissions to set for tangled files by `set-file-modes'. For example, to make read-only tangled file, use `:tangle-mode (identity #o444)'. To make it executable, use `:tangle-mode (identity #o755)'. On `src' code blocks with `shebang' (*note shebang::) header argument, Org will automatically set the tangled file to executable permissions. But this can be overridden with custom permissions using `tangle-mode' header argument. When multiple `src' code blocks tangle to a single file with different and conflicting `tangle-mode' header arguments, Org's behavior is undefined.  File: org, Node: eval, Next: wrap, Prev: tangle-mode, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.25 `:eval' ................. The `:eval' header argument can limit evaluation of specific code blocks. It is useful for protection against evaluating untrusted `src' code blocks by prompting for a confirmation. This protection is independent of the `org-confirm-babel-evaluate' setting. `never or no' Org will never evaluate this `src' code block. `query' Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate this `src' code block. `never-export or no-export' Org will not evaluate this `src' code block when exporting, yet the user can evaluate this source block interactively. `query-export' Org prompts the user for permission to export this `src' code block. If `:eval' header argument is not set for a source block, then Org determines whether to evaluate from the `org-confirm-babel-evaluate' variable (*note Code evaluation security::).  File: org, Node: wrap, Next: post, Prev: eval, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.26 `:wrap' ................. The `:wrap' header argument marks the results block by appending strings to `#+BEGIN_' and `#+END_'. If no string is specified, Org wraps the results in a `#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS' block.  File: org, Node: post, Next: prologue, Prev: wrap, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.27 `:post' ................. The `:post' header argument is for post-processing results from `src' block evaluation. When `:post' has any value, Org binds the results to `*this*' variable for easy passing to *note var:: header argument specifications. That makes results available to other `src' code blocks, or for even direct Emacs Lisp code execution. The following two examples illustrate `:post' header argument in action. The first one shows how to attach `#+ATTR_LATEX:' line using `:post'. #+name: attr_wrap #+begin_src sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output echo "#+ATTR_LATEX: :width $width" echo "$data" #+end_src #+header: :file /tmp/it.png #+begin_src dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer digraph{ a -> b; b -> c; c -> a; } #+end_src #+RESULTS: :RESULTS: #+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm [[file:/tmp/it.png]] :END: The second example shows use of `:colnames' in `:post' to pass data between `src' code blocks. #+name: round-tbl #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var tbl="" fmt="%.3f" (mapcar (lambda (row) (mapcar (lambda (cell) (if (numberp cell) (format fmt cell) cell)) row)) tbl) #+end_src #+begin_src R :colnames yes :post round-tbl[:colnames yes](*this*) set.seed(42) data.frame(foo=rnorm(1)) #+end_src #+RESULTS: | foo | |-------| | 1.371 |  File: org, Node: prologue, Next: epilogue, Prev: post, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.28 `:prologue' ..................... The `prologue' header argument is for appending to the top of the code block for execution. For example, a clear or reset code at the start of new execution of a `src' code block. A `reset' for `gnuplot': `:prologue "reset"'. See also *note epilogue::. (add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot '((:prologue . "reset")))  File: org, Node: epilogue, Prev: prologue, Up: Specific header arguments 14.8.2.29 `:epilogue' ..................... The value of the `epilogue' header argument is for appending to the end of the code block for execution. See also *note prologue::.  File: org, Node: Results of evaluation, Next: Noweb reference syntax, Prev: Header arguments, Up: Working with source code 14.9 Results of evaluation ========================== How Org handles results of a code block execution depends on many header arguments working together. Here is only a summary of these. For an enumeration of all the header arguments that affect results, see *note results::. The primary determinant is the execution context. Is it in a `:session' or not? Orthogonal to that is if the expected result is a `:results value' or `:results output', which is a concatenation of output from start to finish of the `src' code block's evaluation. Non-session Session `:results value' value of last value of last expression expression `:results output' contents of STDOUT concatenation of interpreter output For `:session' and non-session, the `:results value' turns the results into an Org mode table format. Single values are wrapped in a one dimensional vector. Rows and columns of a table are wrapped in a two-dimensional vector. 14.9.1 Non-session ------------------ 14.9.1.1 `:results value' ......................... Default. Org gets the value by wrapping the code in a function definition in the language of the `src' block. That is why when using `:results value', code should execute like a function and return a value. For languages like Python, an explicit `return' statement is mandatory when using `:results value'. This is one of four evaluation contexts where Org automatically wraps the code in a function definition. 14.9.1.2 `:results output' .......................... For `:results output', the code is passed to an external process running the interpreter. Org returns the contents of the standard output stream as as text results. 14.9.2 Session -------------- 14.9.2.1 `:results value' ......................... For `:results value' from a `:session', Org passes the code to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. So only languages that provide interactive evaluation can have session support. Not all languages provide this support, such as `C' and `ditaa'. Even those that do support, such as `Python' and `Haskell', they impose limitations on allowable language constructs that can run interactively. Org inherits those limitations for those `src' code blocks running in a `:session'. Org gets the value from the source code interpreter's last statement output. Org has to use language-specific methods to obtain the value. For example, from the variable `_' in `Python' and `Ruby', and the value of `.Last.value' in `R'). 14.9.2.2 `:results output' .......................... For `:results output', Org passes the code to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org concatenates whatever text output emitted by the interpreter to return the collection as a result. Note that this collection is not the same as collected from `STDOUT' of a non-interactive interpreter running as an external process. Compare for example these two blocks: #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output print "hello" 2 print "bye" #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : hello : bye In the above non-session mode, the "2" is not printed; so does not appear in results. #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session print "hello" 2 print "bye" #+END_SRC #+RESULTS: : hello : 2 : bye In the above `:session' mode, the interactive interpreter receives and prints "2". Results show that.  File: org, Node: Noweb reference syntax, Next: Key bindings and useful functions, Prev: Results of evaluation, Up: Working with source code 14.10 Noweb reference syntax ============================ Org supports named blocks in Noweb style syntax. For Noweb literate programming details, see `http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/'). <> For the header argument `:noweb yes', Org expands Noweb style references in the `src' code block before evaluation. For the header argument `:noweb no', Org does not expand Noweb style references in the `src' code block before evaluation. The default is `:noweb no'. Org defaults to `:noweb no' so as not to cause errors in languages where Noweb syntax is ambiguous. Change Org's default to `:noweb yes' for languages where there is no risk of confusion. Org offers a more flexible way to resolve Noweb style references (*note noweb-ref::). Org can include the _results_ of a code block rather than its body. To that effect, append parentheses, possibly including arguments, to the code block name, as show below. <> Note that when using the above approach to a code block's results, the code block name set by `#+NAME' keyword is required; the reference set by `:noweb-ref' will not work. Here is an example that demonstrates how the exported content changes when Noweb style references are used with parentheses versus without. With: #+NAME: some-code #+BEGIN_SRC python :var num=0 :results output :exports none print(num*10) #+END_SRC this code block: #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes <> #+END_SRC expands to: print(num*10) Below, a similar Noweb style reference is used, but with parentheses, while setting a variable `num' to 10: #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes <> #+END_SRC Note that now the expansion contains the _results_ of the code block `some-code', not the code block itself: 100 For faster tangling of large Org mode files, set `org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion' variable to `t'. The speedup comes at the expense of not correctly resolving inherited values of the `:noweb-ref' header argument.  File: org, Node: Key bindings and useful functions, Next: Batch execution, Prev: Noweb reference syntax, Up: Working with source code 14.11 Key bindings and useful functions ======================================= Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on the context. Active key bindings in code blocks: `C-c C-c' `org-babel-execute-src-block' `C-c C-o' `org-babel-open-src-block-result' `M-' `org-babel-load-in-session' `M-' `org-babel-switch-to-session' Active key bindings in Org mode buffer: `C-c C-v p' or `C-c C-v C-p' `org-babel-previous-src-block' `C-c C-v n' or `C-c C-v C-n' `org-babel-next-src-block' `C-c C-v e' or `C-c C-v C-e' `org-babel-execute-maybe' `C-c C-v o' or `C-c C-v C-o' `org-babel-open-src-block-result' `C-c C-v v' or `C-c C-v C-v' `org-babel-expand-src-block' `C-c C-v u' or `C-c C-v C-u' `org-babel-goto-src-block-head' `C-c C-v g' or `C-c C-v C-g' `org-babel-goto-named-src-block' `C-c C-v r' or `C-c C-v C-r' `org-babel-goto-named-result' `C-c C-v b' or `C-c C-v C-b' `org-babel-execute-buffer' `C-c C-v s' or `C-c C-v C-s' `org-babel-execute-subtree' `C-c C-v d' or `C-c C-v C-d' `org-babel-demarcate-block' `C-c C-v t' or `C-c C-v C-t' `org-babel-tangle' `C-c C-v f' or `C-c C-v C-f' `org-babel-tangle-file' `C-c C-v c' or `C-c C-v C-c' `org-babel-check-src-block' `C-c C-v j' or `C-c C-v C-j' `org-babel-insert-header-arg' `C-c C-v l' or `C-c C-v C-l' `org-babel-load-in-session' `C-c C-v i' or `C-c C-v C-i' `org-babel-lob-ingest' `C-c C-v I' or `C-c C-v C-I' `org-babel-view-src-block-info' `C-c C-v z' or `C-c C-v C-z' `org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code' `C-c C-v a' or `C-c C-v C-a' `org-babel-sha1-hash' `C-c C-v h' or `C-c C-v C-h' `org-babel-describe-bindings' `C-c C-v x' or `C-c C-v C-x' `org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer'  File: org, Node: Batch execution, Prev: Key bindings and useful functions, Up: Working with source code 14.12 Batch execution ===================== Org mode features, including working with source code facilities can be invoked from the command line. This enables building shell scripts for batch processing, running automated system tasks, and expanding Org mode's usefulness. The sample script shows batch processing of multiple files using `org-babel-tangle'. #!/bin/sh # tangle files with org-mode # emacs -Q --batch --eval " (progn (require 'ob-tangle) (dolist (file command-line-args-left) (with-current-buffer (find-file-noselect file) (org-babel-tangle)))) " "$@"  File: org, Node: Miscellaneous, Next: Hacking, Prev: Working with source code, Up: Top 15 Miscellaneous **************** * Menu: * Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions * Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code * Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty * Interaction:: With other Emacs packages * org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files  File: org, Node: Completion, Next: Easy templates, Up: Miscellaneous 15.1 Completion =============== Org has in-buffer completions. Unlike minibuffer completions, which are useful for quick command interactions, Org's in-buffer completions are more suitable for content creation in Org documents. Type one or more letters and invoke the hot key to complete the text in-place. Depending on the context and the keys, Org will offer different types of completions. No minibuffer is involved. Such mode-specific hot keys have become an integral part of Emacs and Org provides several shortcuts. `M-' Complete word at point * At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords. * After `\', complete TeX symbols supported by the exporter. * After `*', complete headlines in the current buffer so that they can be used in search links like `[[*find this headline]]'. * After `:' in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken from the variable `org-tag-alist' (possibly set through the `#+TAGS' in-buffer option, *note Setting tags::), or it is created dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer. * After `:' and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current buffer. * After `[', complete link abbreviations (*note Link abbreviations::). * After `#+', complete the special keywords like `TYP_TODO' or file-specific `OPTIONS'. After option keyword is complete, pressing `M-' again will insert example settings for that option. * After `#+STARTUP: ', complete startup keywords. * When the point is anywhere else, complete dictionary words using Ispell. If your desktop intercepts the combo `M-' to switch windows, use `C-M-i' or ` ' as an alternative or customize your environment.  File: org, Node: Easy templates, Next: Speed keys, Prev: Completion, Up: Miscellaneous 15.2 Easy templates =================== With just a few keystrokes, Org's easy templates inserts empty pairs of structural elements, such as `#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC'. Easy templates use an expansion mechanism, which is native to Org, in a process similar to `yasnippet' and other Emacs template expansion packages. `<' `s' `' expands to a `src' code block. `<' `l' `' expands to: #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex #+END_EXPORT Org comes with these pre-defined easy templates: `s' `#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC' `e' `#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE' `q' `#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE' `v' `#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE' `c' `#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER' `C' `#+BEGIN_COMMENT ... #+END_COMMENT' `l' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex ... #+END_EXPORT' `L' `#+LATEX:' `h' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT html ... #+END_EXPORT' `H' `#+HTML:' `a' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii ... #+END_EXPORT' `A' `#+ASCII:' `i' `#+INDEX:' line `I' `#+INCLUDE:' line More templates can added by customizing the variable `org-structure-template-alist', whose docstring has additional details.  File: org, Node: Speed keys, Next: Code evaluation security, Prev: Easy templates, Up: Miscellaneous 15.3 Speed keys =============== Single keystrokes can execute custom commands in an Org file when the cursor is on a headline. Without the extra burden of a meta or modifier key, Speed Keys can speed navigation or execute custom commands. Besides faster navigation, Speed Keys may come in handy on small mobile devices that do not have full keyboards. Speed Keys may also work on TTY devices known for their problems when entering Emacs keychords. By default, Org has Speed Keys disabled. To activate Speed Keys, set the variable `org-use-speed-commands' to a non-`nil' value. To trigger a Speed Key, the cursor must be at the beginning of an Org headline, before any of the stars. Org comes with a pre-defined list of Speed Keys. To add or modify Speed Keys, customize the variable, `org-speed-commands-user'. For more details, see the variable's docstring. With Speed Keys activated, `M-x org-speed-command-help', or `?' when cursor is at the beginning of an Org headline, shows currently active Speed Keys, including the user-defined ones.  File: org, Node: Code evaluation security, Next: Customization, Prev: Speed keys, Up: Miscellaneous 15.4 Code evaluation and security issues ======================================== Unlike plain text, running code comes with risk. Each `src' code block, in terms of risk, is equivalent to an executable file. Org therefore puts a few confirmation prompts by default. This is to alert the casual user from accidentally running untrusted code. For users who do not run code blocks or write code regularly, Org's default settings should suffice. However, some users may want to tweak the prompts for fewer interruptions. To weigh the risks of automatic execution of code blocks, here are some details about code evaluation. Org evaluates code in the following circumstances: Source code blocks Org evaluates `src' code blocks in an Org file during export. Org also evaluates a `src' code block with the `C-c C-c' key chord. Users exporting or running code blocks must load files only from trusted sources. Be wary of customizing variables that remove or alter default security measures. -- User Option: org-confirm-babel-evaluate When `t', Org prompts the user for confirmation before executing each code block. When `nil', Org executes code blocks without prompting the user for confirmation. When this option is set to a custom function, Org invokes the function with these two arguments: the source code language and the body of the code block. The custom function must return either a `t' or `nil', which determines if the user is prompted. Each source code language can be handled separately through this function argument. For example, this function enables execution of `ditaa' code +blocks without prompting: (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body) (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate) Following `shell' and `elisp' links Org has two link types that can also directly evaluate code (*note External links::). Because such code is not visible, these links have a potential risk. Org therefore prompts the user when it encounters such links. The customization variables are: -- User Option: org-confirm-shell-link-function Function that prompts the user before executing a shell link. -- User Option: org-confirm-elisp-link-function Function that prompts the user before executing an Emacs Lisp link. Formulas in tables Org executes formulas in tables (*note The spreadsheet::) either through the _calc_ or the _Emacs Lisp_ interpreters.  File: org, Node: Customization, Next: In-buffer settings, Prev: Code evaluation security, Up: Miscellaneous 15.5 Customization ================== Org has more than 500 variables for customization. They can be accessed through the usual `M-x org-customize RET' command. Or through the Org menu, `Org->Customization->Browse Org Group'. Org also has per-file settings for some variables (*note In-buffer settings::).  File: org, Node: In-buffer settings, Next: The very busy C-c C-c key, Prev: Customization, Up: Miscellaneous 15.6 Summary of in-buffer settings ================================== In-buffer settings start with `#+', followed by a keyword, a colon, and then a word for each setting. Org accepts multiple settings on the same line. Org also accepts multiple lines for a keyword. This manual describes these settings throughout. A summary follows here. `C-c C-c' activates any changes to the in-buffer settings. Closing and reopening the Org file in Emacs also activates the changes. `#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::' Sets the archive location of the agenda file. This location applies to the lines until the next `#+ARCHIVE' line, if any, in the Org file. The first archive location in the Org file also applies to any entries before it. The corresponding variable is `org-archive-location'. `#+CATEGORY:' Sets the category of the agenda file, which applies to the entire document. `#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ...' Sets the default format for columns view. Org uses this format for column views where there is no `COLUMNS' property. `#+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...' Set file-local values for constants that table formulas can use. This line sets the local variable `org-table-formula-constants-local'. The global version of this variable is `org-table-formula-constants'. `#+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:' Set tags that all entries in the file will inherit from here, including the top-level entries. `#+LINK: linkword replace' Each line specifies one abbreviation for one link. Use multiple `#+LINK:' lines for more, *note Link abbreviations::. The corresponding variable is `org-link-abbrev-alist'. `#+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default' This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority. `#+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value' This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property. `#+SETUPFILE: file or URL' The setup file or a URL pointing to such file is for additional in-buffer settings. Org loads this file and parses it for any settings in it only when Org opens the main file. If URL is specified, the contents are downloaded and stored in a temporary file cache. `C-c C-c' on the settings line will parse and load the file, and also reset the temporary file cache. Org also parses and loads the document during normal exporting process. Org parses the contents of this document as if it was included in the buffer. It can be another Org file. To visit the file (not a URL), `C-c '' while the cursor is on the line with the file name. `#+STARTUP:' Startup options Org uses when first visiting a file. The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is `org-startup-folded' with a default value of `t', which is the same as `overview'. overview top-level headlines only content all headlines showall no folding of any entries showeverything show even drawer contents Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable `org-startup-indented' indent start with `org-indent-mode' turned on noindent start with `org-indent-mode' turned off Aligns tables consistently upon visiting a file; useful for restoring narrowed table columns. The corresponding variable is `org-startup-align-all-tables' with `nil' as default value. align align all tables noalign don't align tables on startup Whether Org should automatically display inline images. The corresponding variable is `org-startup-with-inline-images', with a default value `nil' to avoid delays when visiting a file. inlineimages show inline images noinlineimages don't show inline images on startup Whether Org should automatically convert LaTeX fragments to images. The variable `org-startup-with-latex-preview', which controls this setting, is set to `nil' by default to avoid startup delays. latexpreview preview LaTeX fragments nolatexpreview don't preview LaTeX fragments Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be configured using these options (see variables `org-log-done', `org-log-note-clock-out' and `org-log-repeat') logdone record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE lognotedone record timestamp and a note when DONE nologdone don't record when items are marked DONE logrepeat record a time when reinstating a repeating item lognoterepeat record a note when reinstating a repeating item nologrepeat do not record when reinstating repeating item lognoteclock-out record a note when clocking out nolognoteclock-out don't record a note when clocking out logreschedule record a timestamp when scheduling time changes lognotereschedule record a note when scheduling time changes nologreschedule do not record when a scheduling date changes logredeadline record a timestamp when deadline changes lognoteredeadline record a note when deadline changes nologredeadline do not record when a deadline date changes logrefile record a timestamp when refiling lognoterefile record a note when refiling nologrefile do not record when refiling logdrawer store log into drawer nologdrawer store log outside of drawer logstatesreversed reverse the order of states notes nologstatesreversed do not reverse the order of states notes These options hide leading stars in outline headings, and indent outlines. The corresponding variables are `org-hide-leading-stars' and `org-odd-levels-only', both with a default setting of `nil' (meaning `showstars' and `oddeven'). hidestars hide all stars on the headline except one. showstars show all stars on the headline indent virtual indents according to the outline level noindent no virtual indents odd show odd outline levels only (1,3,...) oddeven show all outline levels To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables `org-put-time-stamp-overlays' and `org-time-stamp-overlay-formats'), use customtime overlay custom time format The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable `constants-unit-system'). constcgs `constants.el' should use the c-g-s unit system constSI `constants.el' should use the SI unit system For footnote settings, use the following keywords. The corresponding variables are `org-footnote-define-inline', `org-footnote-auto-label', and `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. fninline define footnotes inline fnnoinline define footnotes in separate section fnlocal define footnotes near first reference, but not inline fnprompt prompt for footnote labels fnauto create `[fn:1]'-like labels automatically (default) fnconfirm offer automatic label for editing or confirmation fnplain create `[1]'-like labels automatically fnadjust automatically renumber and sort footnotes nofnadjust do not renumber and sort automatically To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is `org-hide-block-startup'. hideblocks Hide all begin/end blocks on startup nohideblocks Do not hide blocks on startup The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable `org-pretty-entities' and the keywords entitiespretty Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible entitiesplain Leave entities plain `#+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)' These lines specify valid tags for this file. Org accepts multiple tags lines. Tags could correspond to the _fast tag selection_ keys. The corresponding variable is `org-tag-alist'. `#+TBLFM:' This line is for formulas for the table directly above. A table can have multiple `#+TBLFM:' lines. On table recalculation, Org applies only the first `#+TBLFM:' line. For details see *note Using multiple #+TBLFM lines:: in *note Editing and debugging formulas::. `#+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+DATE:,' `#+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:,' `#+SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXCLUDE_TAGS:' These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see *note Export settings::. `#+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:' These lines set the TODO keywords and their significance to the current file. The corresponding variable is `org-todo-keywords'.  File: org, Node: The very busy C-c C-c key, Next: Clean view, Prev: In-buffer settings, Up: Miscellaneous 15.7 The very busy C-c C-c key ============================== The `C-c C-c' key in Org serves many purposes depending on the context. It is probably the most over-worked, multi-purpose key combination in Org. Its uses are well-documented through out this manual, but here is a consolidated list for easy reference. - If any highlights shown in the buffer from the creation of a sparse tree, or from clock display, remove such highlights. - If the cursor is in one of the special `#+KEYWORD' lines, scan the buffer for these lines and update the information. Also reset the Org file cache used to temporary store the contents of URLs used as values for keywords like `#+SETUPFILE'. - If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. The table realigns even if automatic table editor is turned off. - If the cursor is on a `#+TBLFM' line, re-apply the formulas to the entire table. - If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it. With a prefix argument, also jump to the target location after saving the note. - If the cursor is on a `<<>>', update radio targets and corresponding links in this buffer. - If the cursor is on a property line or at the start or end of a property drawer, offer property commands. - If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding definition, and _vice versa_. - If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it. - If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status of the checkbox. - If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the ordered list. - If the cursor is on the `#+BEGIN' line of a dynamic block, the block is updated. - If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.  File: org, Node: Clean view, Next: TTY keys, Prev: The very busy C-c C-c key, Up: Miscellaneous 15.8 A cleaner outline view =========================== Org's default outline with stars and no indents can become too cluttered for short documents. For _book-like_ long documents, the effect is not as noticeable. Org provides an alternate stars and indentation scheme, as shown on the right in the following table. It uses only one star and indents text to line with the heading: * Top level headline | * Top level headline ** Second level | * Second level *** 3rd level | * 3rd level some text | some text *** 3rd level | * 3rd level more text | more text * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline To turn this mode on, use the minor mode, `org-indent-mode'. Text lines that are not headlines are prefixed with spaces to vertically align with the headline text(1). To make more horizontal space, the headlines are shifted by two stars. This can be configured by the `org-indent-indentation-per-level' variable. Only one star on each headline is visible, the rest are masked with the same font color as the background. This font face can be configured with the `org-hide' variable. Note that turning on `org-indent-mode' sets `org-hide-leading-stars' to `t' and `org-adapt-indentation' to `nil'; `2.' below shows how this works. To globally turn on `org-indent-mode' for all files, customize the variable `org-startup-indented'. To turn on indenting for individual files, use `#+STARTUP' option as follows: #+STARTUP: indent Indent on startup makes Org use hard spaces to align text with headings as shown in examples below. 1. _Indentation of text below headlines_ Indent text to align with the headline. *** 3rd level more text, now indented Org adapts indentations with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure editing(2). 2. _Hiding leading stars_ Org can make leading stars invisible. For global preference, configure the variable `org-hide-leading-stars'. For per-file preference, use these file `#+STARTUP' options: #+STARTUP: hidestars #+STARTUP: showstars With stars hidden, the tree is shown as: * Top level headline * Second level * 3rd level ... Because Org makes the font color same as the background color to hide to stars, sometimes `org-hide' face may need tweaking to get the effect right. For some black and white combinations, `grey90' on a white background might mask the stars better. 3. Using stars for only odd levels, 1, 3, 5, ..., can also clean up the clutter. This removes two stars from each level(3). For Org to properly handle this cleaner structure during edits and exports, configure the variable `org-odd-levels-only'. To set this per-file, use either one of the following lines: #+STARTUP: odd #+STARTUP: oddeven To switch between single and double stars layouts, use `M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels RET' and `M-x org-convert-to-oddeven-levels'. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The `org-indent-mode' also sets the `wrap-prefix' correctly for indenting and wrapping long lines of headlines or text. This minor mode handles `visual-line-mode' and directly applied settings through `word-wrap'. (2) Also see the variable `org-adapt-indentation'. (3) Because `LEVEL=2' has 3 stars, `LEVEL=3' has 4 stars, and so on  File: org, Node: TTY keys, Next: Interaction, Prev: Clean view, Up: Miscellaneous 15.9 Using Org on a tty ======================= Org provides alternative key bindings for TTY and modern mobile devices that cannot handle cursor keys and complex modifier key chords. Some of these workarounds may be more cumbersome than necessary. Users should look into customizing these further based on their usage needs. For example, the normal `S-' for editing timestamp might be better with `C-c .' chord. Default Alternative 1 Speed Alternative 2 key `S-' `C-u ' `C' `M-' `C-c C-x l' `l' ` ' `M-S-'`C-c C-x L' `L' `M-' `C-c C-x r' `r' ` ' `M-S-'`C-c C-x R' `R' `M-' `C-c C-x u' ` ' ` ' `M-S-' `C-c C-x U' `U' `M-' `C-c C-x d' ` ' ` ' `M-S-'`C-c C-x D' `D' `S-' `C-c C-x c' ` ' `M-' `C-c C-x m' ` ' ` ' `M-S-' `C-c C-x M' ` ' `S-' `C-c ' ` ' `S-' `C-c ' ` ' `S-' `C-c ' ` ' `S-' `C-c ' ` ' `C-S-'`C-c C-x ` ' ' `C-S-'`C-c C-x ` ' '  File: org, Node: Interaction, Next: org-crypt, Prev: TTY keys, Up: Miscellaneous 15.10 Interaction with other packages ===================================== Org's compatibility and the level of interaction with other Emacs packages are documented here. * Menu: * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts  File: org, Node: Cooperation, Next: Conflicts, Up: Interaction 15.10.1 Packages that Org cooperates with ----------------------------------------- `calc.el' by Dave Gillespie Org uses the Calc package for tables to implement spreadsheet functionality (*note The spreadsheet::). Org also uses Calc for embedded calculations. *Note Embedded Mode: (calc)Embedded Mode. `constants.el' by Carsten Dominik Org can use names for constants in formulas in tables. Org can also use calculation suffixes for units, such as `M' for `Mega'. For a standard collection of such constants, install the `constants' package. Install version 2.0 of this package, available at `https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/'. Org checks if the function `constants-get' has been autoloaded. Installation instructions are in the file, `constants.el'. `cdlatex.el' by Carsten Dominik Org mode can use CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter LaTeX fragments into Org files (*note CDLaTeX mode::). `imenu.el' by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg Imenu creates dynamic menus based on an index of items in a file. Org mode supports Imenu menus. Enable it with a mode hook as follows: (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu"))) By default the Imenu index is two levels deep. Change the index depth using thes variable, `org-imenu-depth'. `speedbar.el' by Eric M. Ludlam Speedbar package creates a special Emacs frame for displaying files and index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar; users can drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. The `<' in the Speedbar frame tweaks the agenda commands to that file or to a subtree. `table.el' by Takaaki Ota Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota. Org mode recognizes such tables and export them properly. `C-c '' to edit these tables in a special buffer, much like Org's `src' code blocks. Because of interference with other Org mode functionality, Takaaki Ota tables cannot be edited directly in the Org buffer. `C-c ' (`org-edit-special')' Edit a `table.el' table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table. `C-c ~ (`org-table-create-with-table.el')' Insert a `table.el' table. If there is already a table at point, this command converts it between the `table.el' format and the Org mode format. See the documentation string of the command `org-convert-table' for details.  File: org, Node: Conflicts, Prev: Cooperation, Up: Interaction 15.10.2 Packages that conflict with Org mode -------------------------------------------- In Emacs, `shift-selection-mode' combines cursor motions with shift key to enlarge regions. Emacs sets this mode by default. This conflicts with Org's use of `S-' commands to change timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types, etc. Since `S-' commands outside of specific contexts don't do anything, Org offers the variable `org-support-shift-select' for customization. Org mode accommodates shift selection by (i) making it available outside of the special contexts where special commands apply, and (ii) extending an existing active region even if the cursor moves across a special context. `CUA.el' by Kim. F. Storm Org key bindings conflict with `S-' keys used by CUA mode. For Org to relinquish these bindings to CUA mode, configure the variable `org-replace-disputed-keys'. When set, Org moves the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda buffer (but not during date selection). S-UP => M-p S-DOWN => M-n S-LEFT => M-- S-RIGHT => M-+ C-S-LEFT => M-S-- C-S-RIGHT => M-S-+ Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. To define a different replacement keys, look at the variable `org-disputed-keys'. `ecomplete.el' by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen Ecomplete provides "electric" address completion in address header lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts ecompletes power supply: No completion happens when Orgtbl mode is enabled in message buffers while entering text in address header lines. If one wants to use ecomplete one should _not_ follow the advice to automagically turn on Orgtbl mode in message buffers (see *note Orgtbl mode::), but instead--after filling in the message headers--turn on Orgtbl mode manually when needed in the messages body. `filladapt.el' by Kyle Jones Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and other elements. Many users reported problems using both `filladapt.el' and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable filladapt like this: (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode) `yasnippet.el' The way Org mode binds the key (binding to `[tab]' instead of `"\t"') overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code fixed this problem: (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (setq-local yas/trigger-key [tab]) (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand))) The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the above code does not fix the conflict, first define the following function: (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand () (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand))) Then tell Org mode to use that function: (add-hook 'org-mode-hook (lambda () (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key) (setq yas/trigger-key [tab]) (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand) (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field))) `windmove.el' by Hovav Shacham This package also uses the `S-' keys, so everything written in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have special functionality on `S-', add this to your configuration: ;; Make windmove work in org-mode: (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up) (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left) (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down) (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right) `viper.el' by Michael Kifer Viper uses `C-c /' and therefore makes this key not access the corresponding Org mode command `org-sparse-tree'. You need to find another key for this command, or override the key in `viper-vi-global-user-map' with (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)  File: org, Node: org-crypt, Prev: Interaction, Up: Miscellaneous 15.11 org-crypt.el ================== Org crypt encrypts the text of an Org entry, but not the headline, or properties. Org crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt. Any text below a headline that has a `:crypt:' tag will be automatically be encrypted when the file is saved. To use a different tag, customize the `org-crypt-tag-matcher' variable. Suggested Org crypt settings in Emacs init file: (require 'org-crypt) (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic) (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt"))) (setq org-crypt-key nil) ;; GPG key to use for encryption ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption. (setq auto-save-default nil) ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often. ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you ;; start Org. ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this: ;; ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*- Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents encrypting previously encrypted text.  File: org, Node: Hacking, Next: MobileOrg, Prev: Miscellaneous, Up: Top Appendix A Hacking ****************** This appendix covers some areas where users can extend the functionality of Org. * Menu: * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals * Add-on packages:: Available extensions * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types * Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks * Special agenda views:: Customized views * Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas * Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries  File: org, Node: Hooks, Next: Add-on packages, Up: Hacking A.1 Hooks ========= Org has a large number of hook variables for adding functionality. This appendix illustrates using a few. A complete list of hooks with documentation is maintained by the Worg project at `http://orgmode.org/worg/doc.html#hooks'.  File: org, Node: Add-on packages, Next: Adding hyperlink types, Prev: Hooks, Up: Hacking A.2 Add-on packages =================== Various authors wrote a large number of add-on packages for Org. These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed packages with the separate release available at `http://orgmode.org'. See the `contrib/README' file in the source code directory for a list of contributed files. Worg page with more information is at: `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/'.  File: org, Node: Adding hyperlink types, Next: Adding export back-ends, Prev: Add-on packages, Up: Hacking A.3 Adding hyperlink types ========================== Org has many built-in hyperlink types (*note Hyperlinks::), and an interface for adding new link types. The example file, `org-man.el', shows the process of adding Org links to Unix man pages, which look like this: `[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]': ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org (require 'org) (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open) (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link) (defcustom org-man-command 'man "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page." :group 'org-link :type '(choice (const man) (const woman))) (defun org-man-open (path) "Visit the manpage on PATH. PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command." (funcall org-man-command path)) (defun org-man-store-link () "Store a link to a manpage." (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode)) ;; This is a man page, we do make this link (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name)) (link (concat "man:" page)) (description (format "Manpage for %s" page))) (org-store-link-props :type "man" :link link :description description)))) (defun org-man-get-page-name () "Extract the page name from the buffer name." ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'. (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name)) (match-string 1 (buffer-name)) (error "Cannot create link to this man page"))) (provide 'org-man) ;;; org-man.el ends here To activate links to man pages in Org, enter this in the init file: (require 'org-man) A review of `org-man.el': 1. First, `(require 'org)' ensures `org.el' is loaded. 2. The `org-add-link-type' defines a new link type with `man' prefix. The call contains the function to call that follows the link type. 3. The next line adds a function to `org-store-link-functions' that records a useful link with the command `C-c l' in a buffer displaying a man page. The rest of the file defines necessary variables and functions. First is the customization variable `org-man-command'. It has two options, `man' and `woman'. Next is a function whose argument is the link path, which for man pages is the topic of the man command. To follow the link, the function calls the `org-man-command' to display the man page. `C-c l' constructs and stores the link. `C-c l' calls the function `org-man-store-link', which first checks if the `major-mode' is appropriate. If check fails, the function returns `nil'. Otherwise the function makes a link string by combining the `man:' prefix with the man topic. The function then calls `org-store-link-props' with `:type' and `:link' properties. A `:description' property is an optional string that is displayed when the function inserts the link in the Org buffer. `C-c C-l' inserts the stored link. To define new link types, define a function that implements completion support with `C-c C-l'. This function should not accept any arguments but return the appropriate prefix and complete link string.  File: org, Node: Adding export back-ends, Next: Context-sensitive commands, Prev: Adding hyperlink types, Up: Hacking A.4 Adding export back-ends =========================== Org's export engine makes it easy for writing new back-ends. The framework on which the engine was built makes it easy to derive new back-ends from existing ones. The two main entry points to the export engine are: `org-export-define-backend' and `org-export-define-derived-backend'. To grok these functions, see `ox-latex.el' for an example of defining a new back-end from scratch, and `ox-beamer.el' for an example of deriving from an existing engine. For creating a new back-end from scratch, first set its name as a symbol in an alist consisting of elements and export functions. To make the back-end visible to the export dispatcher, set `:menu-entry' keyword. For export options specific to this back-end, set the `:options-alist'. For creating a new back-end from an existing one, set `:translate-alist' to an alist of export functions. This alist replaces the parent back-end functions. For complete documentation, see the Org Export Reference on Worg (http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html).  File: org, Node: Context-sensitive commands, Next: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Prev: Adding export back-ends, Up: Hacking A.5 Context-sensitive commands ============================== Org has facilities for building context sensitive commands. Authors of Org add-ons can tap into this functionality. Some Org commands change depending on the context. The most important example of this behavior is the `C-c C-c' (*note The very busy C-c C-c key::). Other examples are `M-cursor' and `M-S-cursor'. These context sensitive commands work by providing a function that detects special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for that context.  File: org, Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Next: Dynamic blocks, Prev: Context-sensitive commands, Up: Hacking A.6 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax ======================================== Because of Org's success in handling tables with Orgtbl, a frequently asked feature is to Org's usability functions to other table formats native to other modem's, such as LaTeX. This would be hard to do in a general way without complicated customization nightmares. Moreover, that would take Org away from its simplicity roots that Orgtbl has proven. There is, however, an alternate approach to accomplishing the same. This approach involves implementing a custom _translate_ function that operates on a native Org _source table_ to produce a table in another format. This strategy would keep the excellently working Orgtbl simple and isolate complications, if any, confined to the translate function. To add more alien table formats, we just add more translate functions. Also the burden of developing custom translate functions for new table formats will be in the hands of those who know those formats best. For an example of how this strategy works, see Orgstruct mode. In that mode, Bastien added the ability to use Org's facilities to edit and re-structure lists. He did by turning `orgstruct-mode' on, and then exporting the list locally to another format, such as HTML, LaTeX or Texinfo. * Menu: * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial * Translator functions:: Copy and modify * Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists  File: org, Node: Radio tables, Next: A LaTeX example, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax A.6.1 Radio tables ------------------ Radio tables are target locations for translated tables that are not near their source. Org finds the target location and inserts the translated table. The key to finding the target location are the magic words `BEGIN/END RECEIVE ORGTBL'. They have to appear as comments in the current mode. If the mode is C, then: /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ At the location of source, Org needs a special line to direct Orgtbl to translate and to find the target for inserting the translated table. For example: #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments... `table_name' is the table's reference name, which is also used in the receiver lines, and the `translation_function' is the Lisp function that translates. This line, in addition, may also contain alternating key and value arguments at the end. The translation function gets these values as a property list. A few standard parameters are already recognized and acted upon before the translation function is called: `:skip N' Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count; include them if they are to be skipped. `:skipcols (n1 n2 ...)' List of columns to be skipped. First Org automatically discards columns with calculation marks and then sends the table to the translator function, which then skips columns as specified in `skipcols'. To keep the source table intact in the buffer without being disturbed when the source file is compiled or otherwise being worked on, use one of these strategies: * Place the table in a block comment. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between `/*' and `*/' lines. * Put the table after an `END' statement. For example `\bye' in TeX and `\end{document}' in LaTeX. * Comment and uncomment each line of the table during edits. The `M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment RET' command makes toggling easy.  File: org, Node: A LaTeX example, Next: Translator functions, Prev: Radio tables, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax A.6.2 A LaTeX example of radio tables ------------------------------------- To wrap a source table in LaTeX, use the `comment' environment provided by `comment.sty'. To activate it, put `\usepackage{comment}' in the document header. Orgtbl mode inserts a radio table skeleton(1) with the command `M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table RET', which prompts for a table name. For example, if `salesfigures' is the name, the template inserts: % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \begin{comment} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | | | \end{comment} The line `#+ORGTBL: SEND' tells Orgtbl mode to use the function `orgtbl-to-latex' to convert the table to LaTeX format, then insert the table at the target (receive) location named `salesfigures'. Now the table is ready for data entry. It can even use spreadsheet features(2): % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \begin{comment} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | |-------+------+---------+---------| | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote) \end{comment} After editing, `C-c C-c' inserts translated table at the target location, between the two marker lines. For hand-made custom tables, note that the translator needs to skip the first two lines of the source table. Also the command has to _splice_ out the target table without the header and footer. \begin{tabular}{lrrr} Month & \multicolumn{1}{c}{Days} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\ % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures \end{tabular} % \begin{comment} #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | |-------+------+---------+---------| | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f \end{comment} The LaTeX translator function `orgtbl-to-latex' is already part of Orgtbl mode and uses `tabular' environment by default to typeset the table and mark the horizontal lines with `\hline'. For additional parameters to control output, *note Translator functions::: `:splice nil/t' When non-`nil', returns only table body lines; not wrapped in tabular environment. Default is `nil'. `:fmt fmt' Format to warp each field. It should contain `%s' for the original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollar symbol, you could use `:fmt "$%s$"'. Format can also wrap a property list with column numbers and formats, for example `:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")'. In place of a string, a function of one argument can be used; the function must return a formatted string. `:efmt efmt' Format numbers as exponentials. The spec should have `%s' twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example `"%s\\times10^{%s}"'. This may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example `:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^{%s}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^{%s}$")'. After `efmt' has been applied to a value, `fmt' will also be applied. Functions with two arguments can be supplied instead of strings. By default, no special formatting is applied. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) By default this works only for LaTeX, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the variable `orgtbl-radio-table-templates' to install templates for other export formats. (2) If the `#+TBLFM' line contains an odd number of dollar characters, this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the `comment' environment that is used to balance the dollar expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a much better solution is to add the `comment' environment to the variable `LaTeX-verbatim-environments'.  File: org, Node: Translator functions, Next: Radio lists, Prev: A LaTeX example, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax A.6.3 Translator functions -------------------------- Orgtbl mode has built-in translator functions: `orgtbl-to-csv' (comma-separated values), `orgtbl-to-tsv' (TAB-separated values), `orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-html', `orgtbl-to-texinfo', `orgtbl-to-unicode' and `orgtbl-to-orgtbl'. They use the generic translator, `orgtbl-to-generic', which delegates translations to various export back-ends. Properties passed to the function through the `ORGTBL SEND' line take precedence over properties defined inside the function. For example, this overrides the default LaTeX line endings, `\\', with `\\[2mm]': #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]" For a new language translator, define a converter function. It can be a generic function, such as shown in this example. It marks a beginning and ending of a table with `!BTBL!' and `!ETBL!'; a beginning and ending of lines with `!BL!' and `!EL!'; and uses a TAB for a field separator: (defun orgtbl-to-language (table params) "Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to language." (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists '(:tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" :lstart "!BL!" :lend "!EL!" :sep "\t") params))) The documentation for the `orgtbl-to-generic' function shows a complete list of parameters, each of which can be passed through to `orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-texinfo', and any other function using that generic function. For complicated translations the generic translator function could be replaced by a custom translator function. Such a custom function must take two arguments and return a single string containing the formatted table. The first argument is the table whose lines are a list of fields or the symbol `hline'. The second argument is the property list consisting of parameters specified in the `#+ORGTBL: SEND' line. Please share your translator functions by posting them to the Org users mailing list, .  File: org, Node: Radio lists, Prev: Translator functions, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax A.6.4 Radio lists ----------------- Call the `org-list-insert-radio-list' function to insert a radio list template in HTML, LaTeX, and Texinfo mode documents. Sending and receiving radio lists works is the same as for radio tables (*note Radio tables::) except for these differences: - Orgstruct mode must be active. - Use `ORGLST' keyword instead of `ORGTBL'. - `C-c C-c' works only on the first list item. Built-in translators functions are: `org-list-to-latex', `org-list-to-html' and `org-list-to-texinfo'. They use the `org-list-to-generic' translator function. See its documentation for parameters for accurate customizations of lists. Here is a LaTeX example: % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy \begin{comment} #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex - a new house - a new computer + a new keyboard + a new mouse - a new life \end{comment} `C-c C-c' on `a new house' inserts the translated LaTeX list in-between the BEGIN and END marker lines.  File: org, Node: Dynamic blocks, Next: Special agenda views, Prev: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Up: Hacking A.7 Dynamic blocks ================== Org supports _dynamic blocks_ in Org documents. They are inserted with begin and end markers like any other `src' code block, but the contents are updated automatically by a user function. For example, `C-c C-x C-r' inserts a dynamic table that updates the work time (*note Clocking work time::). Dynamic blocks can have names and function parameters. The syntax is similar to `src' code block specifications: #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ... #+END: These command update dynamic blocks: `C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' Update dynamic block at point. `C-u C-c C-x C-u' Update all dynamic blocks in the current file. Before updating a dynamic block, Org removes content between the BEGIN and END markers. Org then reads the parameters on the BEGIN line for passing to the writer function. If the function expects to access the removed content, then Org expects an extra parameter, `:content', on the BEGIN line. To syntax for calling a writer function with a named block, `myblock' is: `org-dblock-write:myblock'. Parameters come from the BEGIN line. The following is an example of a dynamic block and a block writer function that updates the time when the function was last run: #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M" #+END: The dynamic block's writer function: (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params) (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y"))) (insert "Last block update at: " (format-time-string fmt)))) To keep dynamic blocks up-to-date in an Org file, use the function, `org-update-all-dblocks' in hook, such as `before-save-hook'. The `org-update-all-dblocks' function does not run if the file is not in Org mode. Dynamic blocks, like any other block, can be narrowed with `org-narrow-to-block'.  File: org, Node: Special agenda views, Next: Speeding up your agendas, Prev: Dynamic blocks, Up: Hacking A.8 Special agenda views ======================== Org provides a special hook to further limit items in agenda views: `agenda', `agenda*'(1), `todo', `alltodo', `tags', `tags-todo', `tags-tree'. Specify a custom function that tests inclusion of every matched item in the view. This function can also skip as much as is needed. For a global condition applicable to agenda views, use the `org-agenda-skip-function-global' variable. Org uses a global condition with `org-agenda-skip-function' for custom searching. This example defines a function for a custom view showing TODO items with WAITING status. Manually this is a multi step search process, but with a custom view, this can be automated as follows: The custom function searches the subtree for the WAITING tag and returns `nil' on match. Otherwise it gives the location from where the search continues. (defun my-skip-unless-waiting () "Skip trees that are not waiting" (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t)))) (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t) nil ; tag found, do not skip subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree To use this custom function in a custom agenda command: (org-add-agenda-custom-command '("b" todo "PROJECT" ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting) (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) Note that this also binds `org-agenda-overriding-header' to a more meaningful string suitable for the agenda view. Search for entries with a limit set on levels for the custom search. This is a general approach to creating custom searches in Org. To include all levels, use `LEVEL>0'(2). Then to selectively pick the matched entries, use `org-agenda-skip-function', which also accepts Lisp forms, such as `org-agenda-skip-entry-if' and `org-agenda-skip-subtree-if'. For example: `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)' Skip current entry if it has been scheduled. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)' Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)' Skip current entry if it has a deadline. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)' Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))' Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)' Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)' Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")' Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry. `(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")' Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches. `(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")' Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree. The following is an example of a search for `WAITING' without the special function: (org-add-agenda-custom-command '("b" todo "PROJECT" ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp ":waiting:")) (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) The `agenda*' view is the same as `agenda' except that it only considers _appointments_, i.e., scheduled and deadline items that have a time specification `[h]h:mm' in their time-stamps. (2) Note that, for `org-odd-levels-only', a level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of stars.  File: org, Node: Speeding up your agendas, Next: Extracting agenda information, Prev: Special agenda views, Up: Hacking A.9 Speeding up your agendas ============================ Some agenda commands slow down when the Org files grow in size or number. Here are tips to speed up: 1. Reduce the number of Org agenda files to avoid slowdowns due to hard drive accesses. 2. Reduce the number of `DONE' and archived headlines so agenda operations that skip over these can finish faster. 3. Do not dim blocked tasks: (setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil) 4. Stop preparing agenda buffers on startup: (setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup nil) 5. Disable tag inheritance for agendas: (setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil) These options can be applied to selected agenda views. For more details about generation of agenda views, see the docstrings for the relevant variables, and this dedicated Worg page (http://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html) for agenda optimization.  File: org, Node: Extracting agenda information, Next: Using the property API, Prev: Speeding up your agendas, Up: Hacking A.10 Extracting agenda information ================================== Org provides commands to access agendas through Emacs batch mode. Through this command-line interface, agendas are automated for further processing or printing. `org-batch-agenda' creates an agenda view in ASCII and outputs to STDOUT. This command takes one string parameter. When string length=1, Org uses it as a key to `org-agenda-custom-commands'. These are the same ones available through `C-c a'. This example command line directly prints the TODO list to the printer: emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr When the string parameter length is two or more characters, Org matches it with tags/TODO strings. For example, this example command line prints items tagged with `shop', but excludes items tagged with `NewYork': emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr An example showing on-the-fly parameter modifications: emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \ org-agenda-span (quote month) \ org-agenda-include-diary nil \ org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ | lpr which will produce an agenda for the next 30 days from just the `~/org/projects.org' file. For structured processing of agenda output, use `org-batch-agenda-csv' with the following fields: category The category of the item head The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY type The type of the agenda entry, can be todo selected in TODO match tagsmatch selected in tags match diary imported from diary deadline a deadline scheduled scheduled timestamp appointment, selected by timestamp closed entry was closed on date upcoming-deadline warning about nearing deadline past-scheduled forwarded scheduled item block entry has date block including date todo The TODO keyword, if any tags All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons date The relevant date, like 2007-2-14 time The time, like 15:00-16:50 extra String with extra planning info priority-l The priority letter if any was given priority-n The computed numerical priority If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp, including those items with `DEADLINE' and `SCHEDULED' keywords, then Org includes date and time in the output. If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled), then Org includes date and time in the output. Here is an example of a post-processing script in Perl. It takes the CSV output from Emacs and prints with a checkbox: #!/usr/bin/perl # define the Emacs command to run $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'"; # run it and capture the output $agenda = qx{$cmd 2>/dev/null}; # loop over all lines foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) { # get the individual values ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra, $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line); # process and print print "[ ] $head\n"; }  File: org, Node: Using the property API, Next: Using the mapping API, Prev: Extracting agenda information, Up: Hacking A.11 Using the property API =========================== Functions for working with properties. -- Function: org-entry-properties &optional pom which Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM. This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline, scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times if the property key was used several times. POM may also be `nil', in which case the current entry is used. If WHICH is `nil' or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is `special' or `standard', only get that subclass. -- Function: org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit Get value of `PROPERTY' for entry at point-or-marker `POM'. By default, this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If `INHERIT' is non-`nil' and the entry does not have the property, then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. If `INHERIT' is the symbol `selective', use inheritance if and only if the setting of `org-use-property-inheritance' selects `PROPERTY' for inheritance. -- Function: org-entry-delete pom property Delete the property `PROPERTY' from entry at point-or-marker POM. -- Function: org-entry-put pom property value Set `PROPERTY' to `VALUE' for entry at point-or-marker POM. -- Function: org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials Get all property keys in the current buffer. -- Function: org-insert-property-drawer Insert a property drawer for the current entry. -- Function: org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values Set `PROPERTY' at point-or-marker `POM' to `VALUES'. `VALUES' should be a list of strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators. -- Function: org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a whitespace-separated list of values and return the values as a list of strings. -- Function: org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that `VALUE' is in this list. -- Function: org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that `VALUE' is _not_ in this list. -- Function: org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a whitespace-separated list of values and check if `VALUE' is in this list. -- User Option: org-property-allowed-value-functions Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property. The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and return a flat list of allowed values. If `:ETC' is one of the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values to be entered. The functions must return `nil' if they are not responsible for this property.  File: org, Node: Using the mapping API, Prev: Using the property API, Up: Hacking A.12 Using the mapping API ========================== Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities for finding entries. Org uses this functionality internally for generating agenda views. Org also exposes an API for executing arbitrary functions for each selected entry. The API's main entry point is: -- Function: org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip Call `FUNC' at each headline selected by `MATCH' in `SCOPE'. `FUNC' is a function or a Lisp form. With the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline, call the function without arguments. Org returns an alist of return values of calls to the function. To avoid preserving point, Org wraps the call to `FUNC' in save-excursion form. After evaluation, Org moves the cursor to the end of the line that was just processed. Search continues from that point forward. This may not always work as expected under some conditions, such as if the current sub-tree was removed by a previous archiving operation. In such rare circumstances, Org skips the next entry entirely when it should not. To stop Org from such skips, make `FUNC' set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to a specific buffer position. `MATCH' is a tags/property/TODO match. Org iterates only matched headlines. Org iterates over all headlines when `MATCH' is `nil' or `t'. `SCOPE' determines the scope of this command. It can be any of: nil the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any tree the subtree started with the entry at point region The entries within the active region, if any file the current buffer, without restriction file-with-archives the current buffer, and any archives associated with it agenda all agenda files agenda-with-archives all agenda files with any archive files associated with them (file1 file2 ...) if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned The remaining args are treated as settings for the scanner's skipping facilities. Valid args are: archive skip trees with the archive tag comment skip trees with the COMMENT keyword function or Lisp form will be used as value for `org-agenda-skip-function', so whenever the function returns t, FUNC will not be called for that entry and search will continue from the point where the function leaves it The mapping routine can call any arbitrary function, even functions that change meta data or query the property API (*note Using the property API::). Here are some handy functions: -- Function: org-todo &optional arg Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for the many possible values for the argument `ARG'. -- Function: org-priority &optional action Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the possible values for `ACTION'. -- Function: org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff Toggle the tag `TAG' in the current entry. Setting `ONOFF' to either `on' or `off' will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off. -- Function: org-promote Promote the current entry. -- Function: org-demote Demote the current entry. This example turns all entries tagged with `TOMORROW' into TODO entries with keyword `UPCOMING'. Org ignores entries in comment trees and archive trees. (org-map-entries '(org-todo "UPCOMING") "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment) The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword `WAITING', in all agenda files. (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))  File: org, Node: MobileOrg, Next: History and acknowledgments, Prev: Hacking, Up: Top Appendix B MobileOrg ******************** MobileOrg is a companion mobile app that runs on iOS and Android devices. MobileOrg enables offline-views and capture support for an Org mode system that is rooted on a "real" computer. MobileOrg can record changes to existing entries. The iOS implementation (https://github.com/MobileOrg/) for the _iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad_ series of devices, was started by Richard Moreland and is now in the hands Sean Escriva. Android users should check out MobileOrg Android (http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/) by Matt Jones. Though the two implementations are not identical, they offer similar features. This appendix describes Org's support for agenda view formats compatible with MobileOrg. It also describes synchronizing changes, such as to notes, between MobileOrg and the computer. To change tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, first customize the variables `org-todo-keywords' and `org-tag-alist'. These should cover all the important tags and TODO keywords, even if Org files use only some of them. Though MobileOrg has in-buffer settings, it understands TODO states _sets_ (*note Per-file keywords::) and _mutually exclusive_ tags (*note Setting tags::) only for those set in these variables. * Menu: * Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items  File: org, Node: Setting up the staging area, Next: Pushing to MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg B.1 Setting up the staging area =============================== MobileOrg needs access to a file directory on a server to interact with Emacs. With a public server, consider encrypting the files. MobileOrg version 1.5 supports encryption for the iPhone. Org also requires `openssl' installed on the local computer. To turn on encryption, set the same password in MobileOrg and in Emacs. Set the password in the variable `org-mobile-use-encryption'(1). Note that even after MobileOrg encrypts the file contents, the file names will remain visible on the file systems of the local computer, the server, and the mobile device. For a server to host files, consider options like Dropbox.com (http://dropbox.com) account(2). On first connection, MobileOrg creates a directory `MobileOrg/' on Dropbox. Pass its location to Emacs through an init file variable as follows: (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg") Org copies files to the above directory for MobileOrg. Org also uses the same directory for sharing notes between Org and MobileOrg. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) If Emacs is configured for safe storing of passwords, then configure the variable, `org-mobile-encryption-password'; please read the docstring of that variable. (2) An alternative is to use webdav server. MobileOrg documentation has details of webdav server configuration. Additional help is at FAQ entry (http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav).  File: org, Node: Pushing to MobileOrg, Next: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Setting up the staging area, Up: MobileOrg B.2 Pushing to MobileOrg ======================== Org pushes files listed in `org-mobile-files' to `org-mobile-directory'. Files include agenda files (as listed in `org-agenda-files'). Customize `org-mobile-files' to add other files. File names will be staged with paths relative to `org-directory', so all files should be inside this directory(1). Push creates a special Org file `agendas.org' with custom agenda views defined by the user(2). Org writes the file `index.org', containing links to other files. MobileOrg reads this file first from the server to determine what other files to download for agendas. For faster downloads, MobileOrg will read only those files whose checksums(3) have changed. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) Symbolic links in `org-directory' should have the same name as their targets. (2) While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified if MobileOrg flags them for further action. To avoid setting properties configure the variable `org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items' to `nil'. Org mode will then rely on outline paths, assuming they are unique. (3) Checksums are stored automatically in the file `checksums.dat'.  File: org, Node: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Pushing to MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg B.3 Pulling from MobileOrg ========================== When MobileOrg synchronizes with the server, it pulls the Org files for viewing. It then appends to the file `mobileorg.org' on the server the captured entries, pointers to flagged and changed entries. Org integrates its data in an inbox file format. 1. Org moves all entries found in `mobileorg.org'(1) and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable `org-mobile-inbox-for-pull'. Each captured entry and each editing event is a top-level entry in the inbox file. 2. After moving the entries, Org attempts changes to MobileOrg. Some changes are applied directly and without user interaction. Examples include changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body text. Entries for further action are tagged as `:FLAGGED:'. Org marks entries with problems with an error message in the inbox. They have to be resolved manually. 3. Org generates an agenda view for flagged entries for user intervention to clean up. For notes stored in flagged entries, MobileOrg displays them in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding agenda item. `?' Pressing `?' displays the entire flagged note in another window. Org also pushes it to the kill ring. To store flagged note as a normal note, use `? z C-y C-c C-c'. Pressing `?' twice does these things: first it removes the `:FLAGGED:' tag; second, it removes the flagged note from the property drawer; third, it signals that manual editing of the flagged entry is now finished. `C-c a ?' returns to the agenda view to finish processing flagged entries. Note that these entries may not be the most recent since MobileOrg searches files that were last pulled. To get an updated agenda view with changes since the last pull, pull again. ---------- Footnotes ---------- (1) `mobileorg.org' will be empty after this operation.  File: org, Node: History and acknowledgments, Next: GNU Free Documentation License, Prev: MobileOrg, Up: Top Appendix C History and acknowledgments ************************************** C.1 From Carsten ================ Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it paralleling my thoughts and plans. _Visibility cycling_ and _structure editing_ were originally implemented in the package `outline-magic.el', but quickly moved to the more general `org.el'. As this environment became comfortable for project planning, the next step was adding _TODO entries_, basic _timestamps_, and _table support_. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file. Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to have provided a constant stream of bug reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and let me know. Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order: Bastien Guerry Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain list parser. His support during the early days was central to the success of this project. Bastien also invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored hosting costs for the orgmode.org website. Bastien stepped in as maintainer of Org between 2011 and 2013, at a time when I desperately needed a break. Eric Schulte and Dan Davison Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate programming and reproducible research. This has become one of Org's killer features that define what Org is today. John Wiegley John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org, including the attachment system (`org-attach.el'), integration with Apple Mail (`org-mac-message.el'), hierarchical dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (`org-habits.el'), and encryption (`org-crypt.el'). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy of his great `remember.el'. Sebastian Rose Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much higher level. He also wrote `org-info.js', a Java script for displaying web pages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with single-key navigation. See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please let me know what I am missing here! C.2 From Bastien ================ I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org between 2011 and 2013. This appendix would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgments and thanks. I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really helped me getting more confident over time, with both the community and the code. When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers, either of the code or the community: Eric Schulte Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts. Nicolas Goaziou Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work on `org-element.el' and `ox.el' has been outstanding, and it opened the doors for many new ideas and features. He rewrote many of the old exporters to use the new export engine, and helped with documenting this major change. More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more than reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very reactive on the mailing list. Achim Gratz Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some _ad hoc_ tools into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the many hiccups that such a change can create for users. Nick Dokos The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such a great help, and the list would not be so active without him. I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual. C.3 List of contributions ========================= * Russel Adams came up with the idea for drawers. * Suvayu Ali has steadily helped on the mailing list, providing useful feedback on many features and several patches. * Luis Anaya wrote `ox-man.el'. * Thomas Baumann wrote `org-bbdb.el' and `org-mhe.el'. * Michael Brand helped by reporting many bugs and testing many features. He also implemented the distinction between empty fields and 0-value fields in Org's spreadsheets. * Christophe Bataillon created the great unicorn logo that we use on the Org mode website. * Alex Bochannek provided a patch for rounding timestamps. * Jan Böcker wrote `org-docview.el'. * Brad Bozarth showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files. * Tom Breton wrote `org-choose.el'. * Charles Cave's suggestion sparked the implementation of templates for Remember, which are now templates for capture. * Pavel Chalmoviansky influenced the agenda treatment of items with specified time. * Gregory Chernov patched support for Lisp forms into table calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting `nouline.el' to XEmacs. * Sacha Chua suggested copying some linking code from Planner, and helped make Org popular through her blog. * Toby S. Cubitt contributed to the code for clock formats. * Baoqiu Cui contributed the first DocBook exporter. In Org 8.0, we go a different route: you can now export to Texinfo and export the `.texi' file to DocBook using `makeinfo'. * Eddward DeVilla proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for them. * Nick Dokos tracked down several nasty bugs. * Kees Dullemond used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also asked for a way to narrow wide table columns. * Jason Dunsmore has been maintaining the Org-Mode server at Rackspace for several years now. He also sponsored the hosting costs until Rackspace started to host us for free. * Thomas S. Dye contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating the Org-Babel documentation into the manual. * Christian Egli converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote `org-taskjuggler.el', which has been rewritten by Nicolas Goaziou as `ox-taskjuggler.el' for Org 8.0. * David Emery provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported HTML agendas. * Sean Escriva took over MobileOrg development on the iPhone platform. * Nic Ferrier contributed mailcap and XOXO support. * Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva implemented hierarchical checkboxes. * John Foerch figured out how to make incremental search show context around a match in a hidden outline tree. * Raimar Finken wrote `org-git-line.el'. * Mikael Fornius works as a mailing list moderator. * Austin Frank works as a mailing list moderator. * Eric Fraga drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and testing. * Barry Gidden did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book publication through Network Theory Ltd. * Niels Giesen had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees. * Nicolas Goaziou rewrote much of the plain list code. He also wrote `org-element.el' and `org-export.el', which was a huge step forward in implementing a clean framework for Org exporters. * Kai Grossjohann pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages. * Brian Gough of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a book. * Bernt Hansen has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks, task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system. * Manuel Hermenegildo has contributed various ideas, small fixes and patches. * Phil Jackson wrote `org-irc.el'. * Scott Jaderholm proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between folded entries, and column view for properties. * Matt Jones wrote MobileOrg Android. * Tokuya Kameshima wrote `org-wl.el' and `org-mew.el'. * Jonathan Leech-Pepin wrote `ox-texinfo.el'. * Shidai Liu ("Leo") asked for embedded LaTeX and tested it. He also provided frequent feedback and some patches. * Matt Lundin has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ. * David Maus wrote `org-atom.el', maintains the issues file for Org, and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies, small fixes and patches. * Jason F. McBrayer suggested agenda export to CSV format. * Max Mikhanosha came up with the idea of refiling and sticky agendas. * Dmitri Minaev sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file basis. * Stefan Monnier provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler happy. * Richard Moreland wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone. * Rick Moynihan proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree. * Todd Neal provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms. * Greg Newman refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form. * Tim O'Callaghan suggested in-file links, search options for general file links, and TAGS. * Osamu Okano wrote `orgcard2ref.pl', a Perl program to create a text version of the reference card. * Takeshi Okano translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial into Japanese. * Oliver Oppitz suggested multi-state TODO items. * Scott Otterson sparked the introduction of descriptive text for links, among other things. * Pete Phillips helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and provided frequent feedback. * Francesco Pizzolante provided patches that helped speeding up the agenda generation. * Martin Pohlack provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion into bundles of 20 for undo. * Rackspace.com is hosting our website for free. Thank you Rackspace! * T.V. Raman reported bugs and suggested improvements. * Matthias Rempe (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality control. * Paul Rivier provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He also acted as mailing list moderator for some time. * Kevin Rogers contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts. * Frank Ruell solved the mystery of the `keymapp nil' bug, a conflict with `allout.el'. * Jason Riedy generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with extensive patches. * Philip Rooke created the Org reference card, provided lots of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation. * Christian Schlauer proposed angular brackets around links, among other things. * Christopher Schmidt reworked `orgstruct-mode' so that users can enjoy folding in non-org buffers by using Org headlines in comments. * Paul Sexton wrote `org-ctags.el'. * Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by Tom Shannon's `organizer-mode.el'. * Ilya Shlyakhter proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines. * Stathis Sideris wrote the `ditaa.jar' ASCII to PNG converter that is now packaged into Org's `contrib' directory. * Daniel Sinder came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking subtrees. * Dale Smith proposed link abbreviations. * James TD Smith has contributed a large number of patches for useful tweaks and features. * Adam Spiers asked for global linking commands, inspired the link extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API. * Ulf Stegemann created the table to translate special symbols to HTML, LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII. * Andy Stewart contributed code to `org-w3m.el', to copy HTML content with links transformation to Org syntax. * David O'Toole wrote `org-publish.el' and drafted the manual chapter about publishing. * Jambunathan K contributed the ODT exporter and rewrote the HTML exporter. * Sebastien Vauban reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and enabled source code highlighting in Gnus. * Stefan Vollmar organized a video-recorded talk at the Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a concept index for HTML export. * Jürgen Vollmer contributed code generating the table of contents in HTML output. * Samuel Wales has provided important feedback and bug reports. * Chris Wallace provided a patch implementing the `QUOTE' keyword. * David Wainberg suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking system. * Carsten Wimmer suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in linking to Gnus. * Roland Winkler requested additional key bindings to make Org work on a tty. * Piotr Zielinski wrote `org-mouse.el', proposed agenda blocks and contributed various ideas and code snippets. * Marco Wahl wrote `org-eww.el'.  File: org, Node: GNU Free Documentation License, Next: Main Index, Prev: History and acknowledgments, Up: Top Appendix D GNU Free Documentation License ***************************************** Version 1.3, 3 November 2008 Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008, 2013, 2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc. `http://fsf.org/' Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. 0. PREAMBLE The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document "free" in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered responsible for modifications made by others. This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft license designed for free software. We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference. 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law. A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language. A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position regarding them. The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words. A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy that is not "Transparent" is called "Opaque". Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only. The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document to the public. A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".) To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according to this definition. The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License. 2. VERBATIM COPYING You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow the conditions in section 3. You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, and you may publicly display copies. 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The front cover must present the full title with all words of the title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in other respects. If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto adjacent pages. If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document numbering more than 100, you must either include a machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from which the general network-using public has access to download using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated location until at least one year after the last time you distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or retailers) of that edition to the public. It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of the Document well before redistributing any large number of copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated version of the Document. 4. MODIFICATIONS You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in the Modified Version: A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document, and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original publisher of that version gives permission. B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you from this requirement. C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher. D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright notices. F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in the Addendum below. G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's license notice. H. Include an unaltered copy of this License. I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence. J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the "History" section. You may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission. K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications", Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles. M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section may not be included in the Modified Version. N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant Section. O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified Version's license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other section titles. You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard. You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous publisher that added the old one. The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS You may combine the Document with other documents released under this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for modified versions, provided that you include in the combination all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all their Warranty Disclaimers. The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name but different contents, make the title of each such section unique by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the combined work. In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled "History" in the various original documents, forming one section Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements." 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other documents released under this License, and replace the individual copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the documents in all other respects. You may extract a single document from such a collection, and distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of that document. 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which are not themselves derivative works of the Document. If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket the whole aggregate. 8. TRANSLATION Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permission from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail. If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual title. 9. TERMINATION You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice. Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does not give you any rights to use it. 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See `http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/'. Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that specified version or of any later version that has been published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document does not specify a version number of this License, you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. 11. RELICENSING "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC site. "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license published by that same organization. "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or in part, as part of another Document. An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this License, and if all works that were first published under this License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008. The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing. ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents ==================================================== To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of the License in the document and put the following copyright and license notices just after the title page: Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME. Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''. If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this: with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts being LIST. If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the situation. If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to permit their use in free software.  File: org, Node: Main Index, Next: Key Index, Prev: GNU Free Documentation License, Up: Top Concept index ************* [index] * Menu: * #+ARCHIVE: Moving subtrees. (line 35) * #+ASCII: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 57) * #+ATTR_ASCII: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 68) * #+ATTR_BEAMER: Beamer specific syntax. (line 35) * #+ATTR_HTML <1>: Images in HTML export. (line 29) * #+ATTR_HTML <2>: Tables in HTML export. (line 11) * #+ATTR_HTML: Links in HTML export. (line 27) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in example blocks: Example blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in horizontal rules: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in images: Images in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in plain lists: Plain lists in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in source blocks: Source blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in special blocks: Special blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_LATEX, in tables: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_ODT <1>: Customizing tables in ODT export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_ODT <2>: Images in ODT export. (line 31) * #+ATTR_ODT: Tables in ODT export. (line 20) * #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in images: Images in Texinfo export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in plain lists: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in special blocks: Special blocks in Texinfo export. (line 6) * #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in tables: Tables in Texinfo export. (line 6) * #+AUTHOR: Export settings. (line 25) * #+BEAMER: Beamer specific syntax. (line 19) * #+BEAMER_FONT_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. (line 16) * #+BEAMER_HEADER: Beamer specific export settings. (line 25) * #+BEAMER_INNER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. (line 19) * #+BEAMER_OUTER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. (line 22) * #+BEAMER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. (line 11) * #+BEGIN, clocktable: The clock table. (line 35) * #+BEGIN, columnview: Capturing column view. (line 11) * #+BEGIN:dynamic block: Dynamic blocks. (line 15) * #+BEGIN_CENTER: Paragraphs. (line 31) * #+BEGIN_COMMENT: Comment lines. (line 10) * #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE: Literal examples. (line 8) * #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 57) * #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer: Beamer specific syntax. (line 19) * #+BEGIN_EXPORT html: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12) * #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 17) * #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo: Quoting Texinfo code. (line 9) * #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 78) * #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 78) * #+BEGIN_QUOTE: Paragraphs. (line 26) * #+BEGIN_SRC <1>: Structure of code blocks. (line 6) * #+BEGIN_SRC: Literal examples. (line 28) * #+BEGIN_VERSE: Paragraphs. (line 13) * #+BIND: Export settings. (line 211) * #+CALL: Evaluating code blocks. (line 25) * #+CAPTION <1>: Images in HTML export. (line 29) * #+CAPTION <2>: Tables in HTML export. (line 11) * #+CAPTION: Images and tables. (line 6) * #+CATEGORY: Categories. (line 6) * #+CINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * #+COLUMNS: Scope of column definitions. (line 8) * #+CONSTANTS: References. (line 110) * #+CREATOR: Export settings. (line 28) * #+DATE: Export settings. (line 32) * #+DESCRIPTION (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. (line 29) * #+DESCRIPTION (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. (line 10) * #+DESCRIPTION (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. (line 11) * #+DESCRIPTION (ODT): ODT specific export settings. (line 11) * #+EMAIL: Export settings. (line 35) * #+EXCLUDE_TAGS: Export settings. (line 52) * #+EXPORT_FILE_NAME: Export settings. (line 64) * #+FILETAGS: Tag inheritance. (line 20) * #+FINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * #+HEADER:: Code block specific header arguments. (line 30) * #+HTML: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12) * #+HTML_CONTAINER: HTML Specific export settings. (line 19) * #+HTML_DOCTYPE: HTML Specific export settings. (line 16) * #+HTML_HEAD <1>: CSS support. (line 48) * #+HTML_HEAD: HTML Specific export settings. (line 35) * #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA <1>: CSS support. (line 48) * #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: HTML Specific export settings. (line 39) * #+HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE: CSS support. (line 43) * #+HTML_LINK_HOME: HTML Specific export settings. (line 23) * #+HTML_LINK_UP: HTML Specific export settings. (line 26) * #+HTML_MATHJAX: HTML Specific export settings. (line 30) * #+INCLUDE: Include files. (line 7) * #+INDEX: Generating an index. (line 16) * #+INFOJS_OPT: JavaScript support. (line 20) * #+KEYWORDS (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. (line 36) * #+KEYWORDS (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. (line 43) * #+KEYWORDS (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. (line 46) * #+KEYWORDS (ODT): ODT specific export settings. (line 16) * #+KINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * #+LANGUAGE: Export settings. (line 38) * #+LATEX: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 13) * #+LATEX_CLASS <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 23) * #+LATEX_CLASS: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 20) * #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 23) * #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 28) * #+LATEX_COMPILER: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 32) * #+LATEX_HEADER <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 30) * #+LATEX_HEADER: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 36) * #+LATEX_HEADER (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. (line 48) * #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 30) * #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 41) * #+LINK: Link abbreviations. (line 49) * #+MACRO: Macro replacement. (line 6) * #+NAME <1>: Structure of code blocks. (line 6) * #+NAME <2>: Images and tables. (line 6) * #+NAME: Internal links. (line 21) * #+NAME, for table: References. (line 131) * #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: Applying custom styles. (line 25) * #+OPTIONS: Export settings. (line 6) * #+ORGLST: Radio lists. (line 11) * #+ORGTBL: Radio tables. (line 19) * #+ORGTBL, SEND: A LaTeX example. (line 13) * #+PINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * #+PLOT: Org-Plot. (line 6) * #+PRIORITIES: Priorities. (line 43) * #+PROPERTY: Property syntax. (line 44) * #+RESULTS: Evaluating code blocks. (line 6) * #+SELECT_TAGS: Export settings. (line 44) * #+SEQ_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) * #+SETUPFILE <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 52) * #+SETUPFILE: Export settings. (line 13) * #+STARTUP: In-buffer settings. (line 67) * #+SUBAUTHOR <1>: Texinfo title and copyright page. (line 12) * #+SUBAUTHOR: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 14) * #+SUBTITLE (ASCII): ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 40) * #+SUBTITLE (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. (line 44) * #+SUBTITLE (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. (line 53) * #+SUBTITLE (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. (line 55) * #+SUBTITLE (Texinfo): Texinfo specific export settings. (line 11) * #+TAGS: Setting tags. (line 29) * #+TBLFM <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 176) * #+TBLFM <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 99) * #+TBLFM: Field and range formulas. (line 12) * #+TBLFM line, multiple: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 99) * #+TBLFM, switching: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 99) * #+TEXINFO: Quoting Texinfo code. (line 9) * #+TEXINFO_CLASS <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_CLASS <2>: Texinfo file header. (line 11) * #+TEXINFO_CLASS: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 20) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 30) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 36) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 33) * #+TEXINFO_FILENAME <1>: Texinfo file header. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 17) * #+TEXINFO_HEADER <1>: Texinfo file header. (line 11) * #+TEXINFO_HEADER: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 24) * #+TEXINFO_POST_HEADER: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 27) * #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE <1>: Texinfo title and copyright page. (line 6) * #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 39) * #+TINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * #+TITLE: Export settings. (line 60) * #+TOC: Table of contents. (line 6) * #+TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) * #+TYP_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) * #+VINDEX: Indices. (line 6) * %:annotation template expansion in capture: capture protocol. (line 23) * %:description template expansion in capture: capture protocol. (line 23) * %:link template expansion in capture: capture protocol. (line 23) * :base-url property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 13) * :cache, src header argument <1>: cache. (line 6) * :cache, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. (line 9) * :colnames, src header argument: colnames. (line 6) * :comments, src header argument: comments. (line 6) * :dir, src header argument: dir. (line 6) * :epilogue, src header argument: epilogue. (line 6) * :eval, src header argument: eval. (line 6) * :exports, src header argument <1>: exports. (line 6) * :exports, src header argument <2>: System-wide header arguments. (line 9) * :exports, src header argument: Exporting code blocks. (line 20) * :file, src header argument: file. (line 6) * :file-ext, src header argument: file-ext. (line 6) * :hlines, src header argument: hlines. (line 6) * :indic attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 12) * :mkdirp, src header argument: mkdirp. (line 6) * :no-expand, src header argument: no-expand. (line 6) * :noweb, src header argument <1>: noweb. (line 6) * :noweb, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. (line 9) * :noweb-ref, src header argument: noweb-ref. (line 6) * :noweb-sep, src header argument: noweb-sep. (line 6) * :online-suffix property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 13) * :output-dir, src header argument: output-dir. (line 6) * :padline, src header argument: padline. (line 6) * :post, src header argument: post. (line 6) * :prologue, src header argument: prologue. (line 6) * :results, src header argument <1>: Results of evaluation. (line 33) * :results, src header argument <2>: results. (line 6) * :results, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. (line 9) * :rewrites property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 43) * :rownames, src header argument: rownames. (line 6) * :sep attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 17) * :sep, src header argument: sep. (line 6) * :session, src header argument <1>: session. (line 6) * :session, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. (line 9) * :shebang, src header argument: shebang. (line 6) * :table-type attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 6) * :tangle, src header argument <1>: tangle. (line 6) * :tangle, src header argument: Extracting source code. (line 23) * :tangle-mode, src header argument: tangle-mode. (line 6) * :var, src header argument: var. (line 6) * :working-directory property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 13) * :working-suffix property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 13) * :wrap, src header argument: wrap. (line 6) * abbreviation, links: Link abbreviations. (line 6) * abstract, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * acknowledgments: History and acknowledgments. (line 6) * action, for publishing: Publishing action. (line 6) * activation: Activation. (line 6) * active region <1>: ODT export commands. (line 6) * active region <2>: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * active region: Structure editing. (line 139) * add-on packages: Add-on packages. (line 6) * add-ons, context-sensitive commands: Context-sensitive commands. (line 6) * agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) * agenda dispatcher: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6) * agenda files: Agenda files. (line 6) * agenda files, removing buffers: Agenda commands. (line 519) * agenda views: Agenda views. (line 6) * agenda views, custom: Custom agenda views. (line 6) * agenda views, exporting <1>: Exporting agenda views. (line 6) * agenda views, exporting: Agenda commands. (line 505) * agenda views, main example: Storing searches. (line 9) * agenda views, optimization: Speeding up your agendas. (line 6) * agenda views, user-defined: Special agenda views. (line 6) * agenda*, as an agenda views: Storing searches. (line 9) * agenda, as an agenda views: Storing searches. (line 9) * agenda, column view: Agenda column view. (line 6) * agenda, pipe: Extracting agenda information. (line 6) * agenda, sticky: Agenda dispatcher. (line 50) * agenda, with block views: Block agenda. (line 6) * align, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 88) * alignment in tables: Column width and alignment. (line 6) * anniversaries, from BBDB: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 79) * API, for mapping: Using the mapping API. (line 6) * API, for properties <1>: Using the property API. (line 6) * API, for properties: Property API. (line 6) * appointment <1>: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) * appointment: Timestamps. (line 14) * appointment reminders: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) * appt.el: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) * archive locations: Moving subtrees. (line 25) * archive tag: Internal archiving. (line 6) * archived entries, in agenda views: Agenda views. (line 37) * Archives mode: Agenda commands. (line 134) * archiving: Archiving. (line 6) * ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 6) * Atom feeds: RSS feeds. (line 6) * attachments: Attachments. (line 6) * author: Feedback. (line 6) * author, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) * autoload: Activation. (line 6) * babel, languages: Languages. (line 6) * babel, library of: Library of Babel. (line 6) * backtrace of an error: Feedback. (line 66) * BBDB links: External links. (line 6) * BBDB, anniversaries: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 79) * Beamer export: Beamer export. (line 6) * begin block, end block: Structure of code blocks. (line 46) * block agenda: Block agenda. (line 6) * blocking, of checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 46) * blocks, folding: Blocks. (line 6) * bold text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * Boolean logic, for tag/property searches: Matching tags and properties. (line 34) * bug reports: Feedback. (line 6) * C-c C-c, overview: The very busy C-c C-c key. (line 6) * calc package: The spreadsheet. (line 6) * calc.el: Cooperation. (line 6) * calculations, in tables <1>: The spreadsheet. (line 6) * calculations, in tables: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * calendar commands, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 454) * calendar integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 32) * calendar, for selecting date: The date/time prompt. (line 76) * capture <1>: Capture. (line 6) * capture: Capture - Refile - Archive. (line 6) * capture protocol: capture protocol. (line 6) * capture, %:annotation placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) * capture, %:description placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) * capture, %:link placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) * capturing, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 348) * category: Categories. (line 6) * category filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * category, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties. (line 72) * CDLaTeX: CDLaTeX mode. (line 6) * cdlatex.el: Cooperation. (line 21) * center blocks: Paragraphs. (line 31) * center image (LaTeX export): Images in LaTeX export. (line 50) * checkbox blocking: Checkboxes. (line 46) * checkbox statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30) * checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 6) * checkboxes and TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 52) * children, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * clean outline view: Clean view. (line 6) * clocking time: Clocking work time. (line 6) * clocktable, dynamic block: The clock table. (line 6) * code block, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6) * code block, editing: Editing source code. (line 6) * code block, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks. (line 6) * code block, exporting: Exporting code blocks. (line 6) * code block, extracting source code: Extracting source code. (line 6) * code block, header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6) * code block, key bindings: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 6) * code block, languages: Languages. (line 6) * code block, library: Library of Babel. (line 6) * code block, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax. (line 6) * code block, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation. (line 6) * code block, structure: Structure of code blocks. (line 6) * code line references, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6) * code text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * column formula: Column formulas. (line 6) * column view, for properties: Defining columns. (line 6) * column view, in agenda: Agenda column view. (line 6) * column, of field coordinates: References. (line 86) * commands, in agenda buffer: Agenda commands. (line 6) * comment lines: Comment lines. (line 6) * comment trees: Comment lines. (line 13) * commented entries, in agenda views: Agenda views. (line 37) * completion, of dictionary words: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of file names: Handling links. (line 89) * completion, of link abbreviations: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of links: Handling links. (line 66) * completion, of option keywords <1>: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of option keywords: Per-file keywords. (line 23) * completion, of property keys: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of tags <1>: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of tags: Setting tags. (line 11) * completion, of TeX symbols: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of TODO keywords <1>: Completion. (line 6) * completion, of TODO keywords: Workflow states. (line 15) * concept index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * constants, in calculations: References. (line 110) * constants.el: Cooperation. (line 12) * constcgs, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 146) * constSI, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 146) * content, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) * content, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) * contents, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * context-sensitive commands, hooks: Context-sensitive commands. (line 6) * continuous clocking: Resolving idle time. (line 78) * convert: Configuring a document converter. (line 6) * converter: Configuring a document converter. (line 6) * coordinates, of field: References. (line 86) * copying notes: Refile and copy. (line 6) * copying, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * countdown timer: Timers. (line 6) * counter, macro: Macro replacement. (line 55) * creating timestamps: Creating timestamps. (line 6) * CSS, for HTML export: CSS support. (line 6) * CUA.el: Conflicts. (line 18) * custom agenda views: Custom agenda views. (line 6) * custom date/time format: Custom time format. (line 6) * custom search strings: Custom searches. (line 6) * customization: Customization. (line 6) * customtime, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 142) * cutting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * cycling, in plain lists: Plain lists. (line 69) * cycling, of agenda files: Agenda files. (line 22) * cycling, of TODO states: TODO basics. (line 14) * cycling, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6) * daily agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) * dash, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) * data type index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * date format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6) * date range: Timestamps. (line 42) * date stamp: Dates and times. (line 6) * date stamps: Timestamps. (line 6) * date tree: Using capture. (line 9) * date, macro: Macro replacement. (line 29) * date, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt. (line 6) * dates: Dates and times. (line 6) * Davison, Dan: Working with source code. (line 6) * DEADLINE keyword: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 11) * deadlines: Timestamps. (line 6) * debugging, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 132) * defining new protocols: Protocols. (line 25) * demotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * dependencies, of TODO states: TODO dependencies. (line 6) * diary entries, creating from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 459) * diary integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 32) * dictionary word completion: Completion. (line 6) * dir file, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. (line 6) * directories, for publishing: Sources and destinations. (line 6) * dispatching agenda commands: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6) * display changing, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 69) * doc, docx, rtf: Configuring a document converter. (line 6) * document structure: Document structure. (line 6) * document title: Export settings. (line 60) * Dominik, Carsten: Cooperation. (line 12) * DONE, final TODO keyword: Per-file keywords. (line 26) * dragging, agenda lines: Agenda commands. (line 353) * drawer, for properties: Property syntax. (line 6) * drawer, for state change recording: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 6) * drawers: Drawers. (line 6) * Duration, computing: Durations and time values. (line 6) * dvipng <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 48) * dvipng: Math formatting in HTML export. (line 6) * dvisvgm <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 48) * dvisvgm: Math formatting in HTML export. (line 6) * dynamic blocks: Dynamic blocks. (line 6) * dynamic indentation: Clean view. (line 6) * ecomplete.el: Conflicts. (line 33) * editing tables: Tables. (line 6) * editing, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 6) * edits, catching invisible: Catching invisible edits. (line 6) * effort estimates: Effort estimates. (line 6) * effort filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * Elisp links: External links. (line 6) * ellipsis, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) * ELPA: Activation. (line 6) * email, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) * embedding images in ODT: Images in ODT export. (line 6) * entitiesplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 169) * entitiespretty, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 169) * entitiespretty, STARTUP keyword: Special symbols. (line 34) * escaping characters: Special symbols. (line 27) * evaluate time range: Creating timestamps. (line 62) * even, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) * example blocks, in LaTeX export: Example blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * export back-end: Exporting. (line 12) * export back-ends, built-in: Other built-in back-ends. (line 6) * Export, dispatcher: The export dispatcher. (line 6) * export, OpenDocument: OpenDocument Text export. (line 6) * Export, settings: Export settings. (line 6) * Export, writing back-ends: Adding export back-ends. (line 6) * exporting: Exporting. (line 6) * exporting agenda views <1>: Exporting agenda views. (line 13) * exporting agenda views: Agenda commands. (line 505) * exporting, not: Comment lines. (line 6) * extended TODO keywords: TODO extensions. (line 6) * external archiving: Moving subtrees. (line 6) * external links: External links. (line 6) * external links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. (line 6) * faces, for TODO keywords: Faces for TODO keywords. (line 6) * FAQ: Summary. (line 49) * feedback: Feedback. (line 6) * field coordinates: References. (line 86) * field formula: Field and range formulas. (line 6) * field references: References. (line 15) * file links: External links. (line 6) * file links, searching: Search options. (line 6) * file name completion: Handling links. (line 89) * files for agenda: Agenda files. (line 6) * files, adding to agenda list: Agenda files. (line 15) * files, selecting for publishing: Selecting files. (line 6) * filladapt.el: Conflicts. (line 44) * filtering, by tag, category, top headline and effort, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * Filters, exporting: Advanced configuration. (line 32) * fnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fnauto, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fnconfirm, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fnlocal, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fnplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * fnprompt, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * folded, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * folding, sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6) * following links: Handling links. (line 101) * footnotes: Footnotes. (line 6) * format specifier: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 14) * format, of links: Link format. (line 6) * formatting source code, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 23) * formula debugging: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 132) * formula editing: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 6) * formula syntax, Calc: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 6) * formula, for individual table field: Field and range formulas. (line 6) * formula, for range of fields: Field and range formulas. (line 6) * formula, for table column: Column formulas. (line 6) * formula, in tables: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * function index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * Gillespie, Dave: Cooperation. (line 6) * global cycling: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * global key bindings: Activation. (line 6) * global TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 6) * global visibility states: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * Gnus links: External links. (line 6) * graph, in tables: Org-Plot. (line 6) * group tags: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) * group tags, as regular expressions: Matching tags and properties. (line 65) * grouping columns in tables: Column groups. (line 6) * habits: Tracking your habits. (line 6) * hacking: Hacking. (line 6) * handle rewritten URL in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 32) * header, for LaTeX files: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 6) * headline navigation: Motion. (line 6) * headline tagging: Tags. (line 6) * headline, promotion and demotion: Structure editing. (line 6) * headlines: Headlines. (line 6) * hide text: Visibility cycling. (line 6) * hideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 164) * hideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13) * hidestars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) * hiding leading stars: Clean view. (line 6) * history: History and acknowledgments. (line 6) * hooks: Hooks. (line 6) * horizontal rules, in ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 68) * horizontal rules, in LaTeX export: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export. (line 6) * horizontal rules, markup rules: Horizontal rules. (line 6) * HTML entities: Special symbols. (line 6) * HTML export: HTML export. (line 6) * HTML export, CSS: CSS support. (line 6) * HTML, and Orgtbl mode: Translator functions. (line 6) * HTML5, export new elements: HTML doctypes. (line 33) * hyperlinks: Hyperlinks. (line 6) * hyperlinks, adding new types: Adding hyperlink types. (line 6) * iCalendar export: iCalendar export. (line 6) * identify, ImageMagick: Images in ODT export. (line 34) * idle, resolve, dangling: Resolving idle time. (line 9) * image, centering (LaTeX export): Images in LaTeX export. (line 50) * imagemagick <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 48) * imagemagick: Math formatting in HTML export. (line 6) * images, embedding in ODT: Images in ODT export. (line 6) * images, inline in HTML: Images in HTML export. (line 6) * images, inline in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export. (line 6) * images, inlining: Handling links. (line 136) * imenu.el: Cooperation. (line 25) * in-buffer settings: In-buffer settings. (line 6) * inactive timestamp: Timestamps. (line 51) * include files, during export: Include files. (line 6) * indent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 79) * indentation, in source blocks <1>: Editing source code. (line 38) * indentation, in source blocks: Literal examples. (line 72) * index, in a publishing project: Generating an index. (line 6) * Info directory file, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. (line 6) * Info links: External links. (line 6) * inheritance, of properties: Property inheritance. (line 6) * inheritance, of tags: Tag inheritance. (line 6) * inline, in LaTeX export: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 10) * inlined images, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 22) * inlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 93) * inlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 136) * inlining images: Handling links. (line 136) * inlining images in HTML: Images in HTML export. (line 6) * inlining images in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export. (line 6) * input file, macro: Macro replacement. (line 44) * inserting links: Handling links. (line 66) * insertion, of templates: Easy templates. (line 6) * install-info parameters, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. (line 6) * installation: Installation. (line 6) * Installing Org protocol: Protocols. (line 14) * internal links: Internal links. (line 6) * internal links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. (line 6) * introduction: Introduction. (line 6) * iPhone: MobileOrg. (line 6) * IRC links: External links. (line 6) * italic text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * jumping, to headlines: Motion. (line 6) * key bindings, global: Activation. (line 6) * keystroke index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * keyword options: Per-file keywords. (line 6) * LaTeX class: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 6) * LaTeX entities: Special symbols. (line 6) * LaTeX export: LaTeX export. (line 6) * LaTeX fragments: LaTeX fragments. (line 6) * LaTeX fragments, preview: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 6) * LaTeX header: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 6) * LaTeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6) * LaTeX sectioning structure: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 6) * LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode: A LaTeX example. (line 6) * latexpreview, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 100) * Latin-1 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 6) * level, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties. (line 72) * LibreOffice <1>: Extending ODT export. (line 12) * LibreOffice: OpenDocument Text export. (line 6) * limits, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 118) * link abbreviations: Link abbreviations. (line 6) * link abbreviations, completion of: Completion. (line 6) * link completion: Handling links. (line 66) * link format: Link format. (line 6) * links, external: External links. (line 6) * links, finding next/previous: Handling links. (line 156) * links, handling: Handling links. (line 6) * links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. (line 6) * links, in ODT export: Links in ODT export. (line 6) * links, internal: Internal links. (line 6) * links, publishing: Publishing links. (line 6) * links, radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6) * links, returning to: Handling links. (line 149) * linter: Org syntax. (line 24) * Lisp forms, as table formulas: Formula syntax for Lisp. (line 6) * list of listings: Table of contents. (line 6) * list of tables: Table of contents. (line 6) * lists, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax. (line 6) * lists, ordered: Plain lists. (line 6) * lists, plain: Plain lists. (line 6) * literal examples, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6) * logdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logdrawer, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logging, of progress: Progress logging. (line 6) * lognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lognotedone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lognoteredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lognoterefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lognoterepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lognotereschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * logstatesreversed, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * lookup functions in tables: Lookup functions. (line 6) * Ludlam, Eric M.: Cooperation. (line 34) * macro replacement, during export: Macro replacement. (line 6) * maintainer: Feedback. (line 6) * mapping entries, API: Using the mapping API. (line 6) * mark ring: Handling links. (line 145) * Markdown export: Markdown export. (line 6) * marking characters, tables: Advanced features. (line 39) * match view: Matching tags and properties. (line 6) * matching, of properties: Matching tags and properties. (line 6) * matching, of tags: Matching tags and properties. (line 6) * matching, tags: Tags. (line 6) * math symbols: Special symbols. (line 6) * MathJax: Math formatting in HTML export. (line 6) * MathML: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 9) * MH-E links: External links. (line 6) * minor mode for structure editing: Orgstruct mode. (line 6) * minor mode for tables: Orgtbl mode. (line 6) * MobileOrg: MobileOrg. (line 6) * mode, for calc: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 14) * modification time, macro: Macro replacement. (line 36) * motion commands in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 19) * motion, between headlines: Motion. (line 6) * Multiple entries in two-column tables, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 17) * n, macro: Macro replacement. (line 55) * name, of column or field: References. (line 110) * named references: References. (line 110) * names as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6) * narrow columns in tables: Column width and alignment. (line 6) * noalign, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 88) * nofnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * nofninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) * nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 164) * nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13) * noindent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 79) * noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 93) * noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 136) * nolatexpreview, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 100) * nologdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologdrawer, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nolognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * nologstatesreversed, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) * occur, command: Sparse trees. (line 6) * occur-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) * odd, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) * odd-levels-only outlines: Clean view. (line 6) * ODT: OpenDocument Text export. (line 6) * ODT_STYLES_FILE: ODT specific export settings. (line 22) * open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 6) * OpenDocument: OpenDocument Text export. (line 6) * option keyword completion: Completion. (line 6) * options, for custom agenda views: Setting options. (line 6) * options, for customization: Customization. (line 6) * options, for publishing: Publishing options. (line 6) * ordered lists: Plain lists. (line 6) * Org entities: Special symbols. (line 6) * Org export: Org export. (line 6) * Org mode, turning on: Activation. (line 21) * Org protocol, set-up: Protocols. (line 14) * Org syntax: Org syntax. (line 6) * org-agenda, command: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) * org-capture-last-stored: Using capture. (line 50) * org-crypt.el: org-crypt. (line 6) * org-decrypt-entry: org-crypt. (line 6) * org-hide-block-startup: In-buffer settings. (line 163) * org-insert-drawer <1>: Property syntax. (line 90) * org-insert-drawer: Drawers. (line 6) * org-list-insert-radio-list: Radio lists. (line 6) * org-pretty-entities: In-buffer settings. (line 168) * org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6) * Orgstruct mode: Orgstruct mode. (line 6) * Orgtbl mode <1>: Tables in arbitrary syntax. (line 6) * Orgtbl mode: Orgtbl mode. (line 6) * Ota, Takaaki: Cooperation. (line 41) * Outline mode: Outlines. (line 6) * outline tree: Headlines. (line 6) * outlines: Outlines. (line 6) * overview, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * overview, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) * overview, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) * packages, interaction with other: Interaction. (line 6) * paragraphs, markup rules: Paragraphs. (line 6) * pasting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * PDF export: LaTeX export. (line 6) * per-file keywords: Per-file keywords. (line 6) * plain lists: Plain lists. (line 6) * plain lists, in LaTeX export: Plain lists in LaTeX export. (line 6) * plain text external links: External links. (line 68) * plot tables using Gnuplot: Org-Plot. (line 6) * presentation, of agenda items: Presentation and sorting. (line 6) * print edition: Summary. (line 52) * printing sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 53) * priorities: Priorities. (line 6) * priorities, of agenda items: Sorting agenda items. (line 6) * program index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * progress logging: Progress logging. (line 6) * projects, for publishing: Project alist. (line 6) * promotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * proof, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * properties: Properties and columns. (line 6) * properties, API <1>: Using the property API. (line 6) * properties, API: Property API. (line 6) * properties, column view: Defining columns. (line 6) * properties, inheritance: Property inheritance. (line 6) * properties, searching: Property searches. (line 6) * properties, special: Special properties. (line 6) * property EXPORT_FILE_NAME: ODT export commands. (line 7) * property syntax: Property syntax. (line 6) * property, +: Property syntax. (line 52) * property, _ALL: Property syntax. (line 44) * property, ALT_TITLE: Table of contents. (line 41) * property, APPENDIX: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 20) * property, ARCHIVE <1>: Moving subtrees. (line 37) * property, ARCHIVE: Property inheritance. (line 34) * property, ATTACH_DIR: Attachments. (line 74) * property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT: Attachments. (line 79) * property, BEAMER_ACT: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 41) * property, BEAMER_COL: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 49) * property, BEAMER_ENV: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 14) * property, BEAMER_OPT: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 41) * property, BEAMER_REF: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 27) * property, CATEGORY <1>: Categories. (line 12) * property, CATEGORY: Property inheritance. (line 30) * property, COLUMNS <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 26) * property, COLUMNS: Property inheritance. (line 22) * property, COOKIE_DATA <1>: Checkboxes. (line 30) * property, COOKIE_DATA: Breaking down tasks. (line 21) * property, COPYING: Texinfo title and copyright page. (line 19) * property, CUSTOM_ID <1>: Handling links. (line 21) * property, CUSTOM_ID: Internal links. (line 6) * property, DESCRIPTION <1>: iCalendar export. (line 51) * property, DESCRIPTION: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 24) * property, Effort: Effort estimates. (line 6) * property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 23) * property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 23) * property, ID <1>: iCalendar export. (line 26) * property, ID <2>: Capturing column view. (line 22) * property, ID: Handling links. (line 21) * property, INDEX: Indices. (line 14) * property, LOCATION: iCalendar export. (line 51) * property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER <1>: Clocking commands. (line 7) * property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 6) * property, LOGGING <1>: Property inheritance. (line 38) * property, LOGGING: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 45) * property, macro: Macro replacement. (line 48) * property, ORDERED <1>: Checkboxes. (line 46) * property, ORDERED: TODO dependencies. (line 6) * property, special, ALLTAGS: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, BLOCKED: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, CLOCKSUM <1>: Agenda column view. (line 28) * property, special, CLOCKSUM: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, CLOCKSUM_T <1>: Agenda column view. (line 51) * property, special, CLOCKSUM_T: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, CLOSED: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, DEADLINE: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, FILE: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, ITEM: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, PRIORITY: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, SCHEDULED: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, TAGS: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, TIMESTAMP: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA: Special properties. (line 13) * property, special, TODO: Special properties. (line 13) * property, SUMMARY: iCalendar export. (line 51) * property, TIMEZONE: iCalendar export. (line 51) * property, UNNUMBERED: Export settings. (line 149) * property, VISIBILITY: Initial visibility. (line 17) * property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL: Clocking commands. (line 20) * property: LAST_REPEAT: Clocking commands. (line 20) * protocol, capture: capture protocol. (line 6) * protocol, new protocol: Protocols. (line 25) * protocol, open-source: open-source protocol. (line 6) * protocol, open-source rewritten URL: open-source protocol. (line 32) * protocol, open-source, :base-url property: open-source protocol. (line 13) * protocol, open-source, :online-suffix property: open-source protocol. (line 13) * protocol, open-source, :rewrites property: open-source protocol. (line 43) * protocol, open-source, :working-directory property: open-source protocol. (line 13) * protocol, open-source, :working-suffix property: open-source protocol. (line 13) * protocol, open-source, set-up mapping: open-source protocol. (line 67) * protocol, store-link: store-link protocol. (line 6) * protocols, for external access: Protocols. (line 6) * publishing: Publishing. (line 6) * query editing, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * quote blocks: Paragraphs. (line 26) * radio lists: Radio lists. (line 6) * radio tables: Radio tables. (line 6) * radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6) * range formula: Field and range formulas. (line 6) * range references: References. (line 63) * ranges, time: Timestamps. (line 6) * recomputing table fields: Updating the table. (line 6) * references: References. (line 6) * references, named: References. (line 110) * references, remote: References. (line 131) * references, to a different table: References. (line 131) * references, to fields: References. (line 15) * references, to ranges: References. (line 63) * refiling notes: Refile and copy. (line 6) * region, active <1>: ODT export commands. (line 6) * region, active <2>: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * region, active: Structure editing. (line 139) * regular expressions, with tags search: Matching tags and properties. (line 61) * relative timer: Timers. (line 6) * reminders: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) * remote editing, bulk, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 364) * remote editing, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 227) * remote editing, undo: Agenda commands. (line 228) * remote references: References. (line 131) * repeated tasks: Repeated tasks. (line 6) * report, of clocked time: The clock table. (line 6) * resolve idle time: Resolving idle time. (line 9) * revealing context: Global and local cycling. (line 38) * RMAIL links: External links. (line 6) * Rose, Sebastian: JavaScript support. (line 6) * row, of field coordinates: References. (line 86) * RSS feeds: RSS feeds. (line 6) * rsync: Uploading files. (line 6) * SCHEDULED keyword: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 31) * scheduling: Timestamps. (line 6) * Schulte, Eric: Working with source code. (line 6) * Scripts, for agenda processing: Extracting agenda information. (line 6) * search option in file links: Search options. (line 6) * search strings, custom: Custom searches. (line 6) * search view: Search view. (line 6) * searching for tags: Tag searches. (line 6) * searching, for text: Search view. (line 6) * searching, of properties: Property searches. (line 6) * sectioning structure, for LaTeX export: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 6) * set startup visibility, command: Global and local cycling. (line 33) * set-up mappings in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. (line 67) * setting tags: Setting tags. (line 6) * SHELL links: External links. (line 6) * shift-selection-mode <1>: Conflicts. (line 6) * shift-selection-mode: Plain lists. (line 94) * show all, command: Global and local cycling. (line 35) * show all, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * show branches, command: Global and local cycling. (line 47) * show children, command: Global and local cycling. (line 51) * show hidden text: Visibility cycling. (line 6) * showall, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) * showall, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) * showeverything, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) * showeverything, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) * showstars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) * shy hyphen, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) * sitemap, of published pages: Sitemap. (line 6) * sorting, of agenda items: Sorting agenda items. (line 6) * sorting, of plain list: Plain lists. (line 154) * sorting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) * source blocks, in LaTeX export: Source blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * source code, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6) * source code, block header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6) * source code, block structure: Structure of code blocks. (line 6) * source code, editing: Editing source code. (line 6) * source code, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks. (line 6) * source code, exporting: Exporting code blocks. (line 6) * source code, extracting: Extracting source code. (line 6) * source code, inline: Structure of code blocks. (line 24) * source code, language: Structure of code blocks. (line 51) * source code, languages: Languages. (line 6) * source code, library: Library of Babel. (line 6) * source code, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax. (line 6) * source code, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation. (line 6) * source code, switches: Structure of code blocks. (line 56) * source code, working with: Working with source code. (line 6) * sparse tree, for deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 24) * sparse tree, for TODO: TODO basics. (line 41) * sparse tree, tag based: Tags. (line 6) * sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6) * special blocks, in ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 78) * special blocks, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * special keywords: In-buffer settings. (line 6) * special symbols: Special symbols. (line 6) * special symbols, in-buffer display: Special symbols. (line 31) * speed keys: Speed keys. (line 6) * speedbar.el: Cooperation. (line 34) * spreadsheet capabilities: The spreadsheet. (line 6) * square brackets, around links: External links. (line 68) * statistics, for checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 30) * statistics, for TODO items: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) * store-link protocol: store-link protocol. (line 6) * storing links: Handling links. (line 10) * Storm, Kim. F.: Conflicts. (line 18) * strike-through text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * structure editing: Structure editing. (line 6) * structure of document: Document structure. (line 6) * styles, custom <1>: Working with OpenDocument style files. (line 6) * styles, custom: Applying custom styles. (line 6) * sublevels, inclusion into tags match: Tag inheritance. (line 6) * sublevels, inclusion into TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 35) * subscript: Subscripts and superscripts. (line 6) * SUBTITLE (ODT): ODT specific export settings. (line 26) * subtree cycling: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * subtree visibility states: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * subtree, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6) * subtree, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * subtrees, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6) * summary: Summary. (line 6) * superscript: Subscripts and superscripts. (line 6) * syntax checker: Org syntax. (line 24) * syntax, noweb: Noweb reference syntax. (line 6) * syntax, of formulas: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 6) * table editor, built-in: Built-in table editor. (line 6) * table editor, table.el: Cooperation. (line 41) * table lookup functions: Lookup functions. (line 6) * table of contents: Table of contents. (line 6) * table.el: Cooperation. (line 38) * tables: Tables. (line 6) * tables, in HTML: Tables in HTML export. (line 6) * tables, in LaTeX export: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 6) * tables, in ODT export <1>: Customizing tables in ODT export. (line 6) * tables, in ODT export: Tables in ODT export. (line 6) * tables, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax. (line 6) * tables, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 6) * tag completion: Completion. (line 6) * tag filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * tag hierarchy: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) * tag inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 6) * tag searches: Tag searches. (line 6) * tags: Tags. (line 6) * tags view: Matching tags and properties. (line 6) * tags, as an agenda view: Storing searches. (line 9) * tags, groups: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) * tags, setting: Setting tags. (line 6) * tags-todo: Storing searches. (line 9) * tags-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) * tangling: Extracting source code. (line 6) * targets, for links: Internal links. (line 6) * targets, radio: Radio targets. (line 6) * tasks, breaking down: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) * tasks, repeated: Repeated tasks. (line 6) * template insertion: Easy templates. (line 6) * template, custom <1>: Working with OpenDocument style files. (line 6) * template, custom: Applying custom styles. (line 6) * templates, for Capture: Capture templates. (line 6) * TeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6) * TeX symbol completion: Completion. (line 6) * Texinfo export: Texinfo export. (line 6) * Texinfo export, data type index: Indices. (line 6) * Texinfo export, dir file: Info directory file. (line 6) * Texinfo export, index, concept: Indices. (line 6) * Texinfo export, index, function: Indices. (line 6) * Texinfo export, Info directory file: Info directory file. (line 6) * Texinfo export, install-info parameters: Info directory file. (line 6) * Texinfo export, keystroke index: Indices. (line 6) * Texinfo export, program index: Indices. (line 6) * Texinfo export, Top node: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 37) * Texinfo export, variable index: Indices. (line 6) * text areas, in HTML: Text areas in HTML export. (line 6) * text search: Search view. (line 6) * thanks: History and acknowledgments. (line 6) * The Top node, in Texinfo export: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 37) * time clocking: Clocking work time. (line 6) * time format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6) * time grid: Time-of-day specifications. (line 26) * Time, computing: Durations and time values. (line 6) * time, macro: Macro replacement. (line 36) * time, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt. (line 6) * time-of-day specification: Time-of-day specifications. (line 6) * timerange: Timestamps. (line 42) * times: Dates and times. (line 6) * timestamp <1>: Timestamps. (line 14) * timestamp: Dates and times. (line 6) * timestamp, inactive: Timestamps. (line 51) * timestamp, with repeater interval: Timestamps. (line 25) * timestamps: Timestamps. (line 6) * timestamps, creating: Creating timestamps. (line 6) * title, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) * TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6) * TODO dependencies, NOBLOCKING: TODO dependencies. (line 6) * TODO items: TODO items. (line 6) * TODO keyword matching: Global TODO list. (line 18) * TODO keyword matching, with tags search: Matching tags and properties. (line 72) * TODO keyword sets: Multiple sets in one file. (line 6) * TODO keywords completion: Completion. (line 6) * TODO list, global: Global TODO list. (line 6) * TODO types: TODO types. (line 6) * TODO workflow: Workflow states. (line 6) * todo, as an agenda view: Storing searches. (line 9) * todo-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) * top headline filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * transient mark mode <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * transient mark mode: Structure editing. (line 139) * transient-mark-mode: ODT export commands. (line 6) * translator function: Translator functions. (line 6) * trees, sparse: Sparse trees. (line 6) * trees, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6) * tty key bindings: TTY keys. (line 6) * Two-column tables, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 6) * types as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6) * underlined text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * undoing remote-editing events: Agenda commands. (line 228) * unison: Uploading files. (line 6) * unoconv: Extending ODT export. (line 12) * updating, table: Updating the table. (line 6) * URL links: External links. (line 6) * USENET links: External links. (line 6) * UTF-8 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 6) * variable index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) * variables, for customization: Customization. (line 6) * vectors, in table calculations: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 11) * verbatim blocks, in LaTeX export: Example blocks in LaTeX export. (line 6) * verbatim text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * verse blocks: Paragraphs. (line 13) * viper.el: Conflicts. (line 91) * visibility cycling: Visibility cycling. (line 6) * visibility cycling, drawers: Drawers. (line 6) * visibility, initialize: Initial visibility. (line 6) * visible text, printing: Sparse trees. (line 53) * VM links: External links. (line 41) * WANDERLUST links: External links. (line 41) * weekly agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) * windmove.el: Conflicts. (line 78) * workflow states as TODO keywords: Workflow states. (line 6) * yasnippet.el: Conflicts. (line 52) * zip: Pre-requisites for ODT export. (line 6)  File: org, Node: Key Index, Next: Command and Function Index, Prev: Main Index, Up: Top Key index ********* [index] * Menu: * $: Agenda commands. (line 262) * %: Agenda commands. (line 381) * ': CDLaTeX mode. (line 43) * *: Agenda commands. (line 366) * +: Agenda commands. (line 284) * ,: Agenda commands. (line 276) * -: Agenda commands. (line 289) * .: Agenda commands. (line 102) * / <1>: Agenda commands. (line 203) * /: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * :: Agenda commands. (line 272) * ;: Timers. (line 6) * < <1>: Agenda commands. (line 207) * < <2>: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 67) * < <3>: Agenda files. (line 57) * < <4>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * <: Using column view. (line 71) * <1>: Agenda commands. (line 42) * <2>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * <3>: Setting tags. (line 117) * <4>: Handling links. (line 122) * : Built-in table editor. (line 69) * <1>: Agenda commands. (line 34) * : Setting tags. (line 114) * <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 23) * <2>: Agenda commands. (line 39) * <3>: Setting tags. (line 108) * <4>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 57) * <5>: Plain lists. (line 68) * <6>: Structure editing. (line 35) * : Global and local cycling. (line 10) * = <1>: Agenda commands. (line 215) * =: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 81) * > <1>: Agenda commands. (line 325) * > <2>: Agenda files. (line 61) * > <3>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * >: Using column view. (line 71) * ?: Pulling from MobileOrg. (line 28) * [ <1>: Agenda commands. (line 126) * [: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 57) * ]: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 57) * ^ <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) * ^ <2>: Agenda commands. (line 211) * ^: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 77) * _ <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) * _ <2>: Agenda commands. (line 218) * _: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 91) * `: CDLaTeX mode. (line 39) * a: Agenda commands. (line 250) * A: Agenda commands. (line 69) * a: Using column view. (line 60) * B: Agenda commands. (line 384) * b: Agenda commands. (line 99) * C: Agenda commands. (line 487) * c: Agenda commands. (line 454) * C-#: Advanced features. (line 10) * C-': Agenda files. (line 22) * C-,: Agenda files. (line 22) * C-0 C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 47) * C-: Structure editing. (line 23) * C-_: Agenda commands. (line 228) * C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 15) * C-c #: Checkboxes. (line 85) * C-c $: Moving subtrees. (line 9) * C-c %: Handling links. (line 142) * C-c &: Handling links. (line 146) * C-c ' <1>: Cooperation. (line 48) * C-c ' <2>: Editing source code. (line 6) * C-c ' <3>: Include files. (line 59) * C-c ' <4>: Literal examples. (line 87) * C-c ' <5>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 36) * C-c ': Footnotes. (line 85) * C-c * <1>: Updating the table. (line 13) * C-c * <2>: Plain lists. (line 139) * C-c *: Structure editing. (line 128) * C-c +: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * C-c ,: Priorities. (line 24) * C-c - <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 105) * C-c -: Plain lists. (line 127) * C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 10) * C-c / <1>: Conflicts. (line 91) * C-c /: Sparse trees. (line 15) * C-c / /: Sparse trees. (line 17) * C-c / a: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 31) * C-c / b: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 28) * C-c / d: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 21) * C-c / m <1>: Property searches. (line 10) * C-c / m: Tag searches. (line 9) * C-c / p: Property searches. (line 29) * C-c / r: Sparse trees. (line 17) * C-c / t: TODO basics. (line 38) * C-c ;: Comment lines. (line 19) * C-c <: Creating timestamps. (line 29) * C-c : Built-in table editor. (line 109) * C-c : Global and local cycling. (line 51) * C-c = <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 13) * C-c =: Column formulas. (line 32) * C-c >: Creating timestamps. (line 33) * C-c ?: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 22) * C-c @: Structure editing. (line 65) * C-c [: Agenda files. (line 15) * C-c \ <1>: Property searches. (line 10) * C-c \: Tag searches. (line 9) * C-c ]: Agenda files. (line 19) * C-c ^ <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 113) * C-c ^ <2>: Plain lists. (line 154) * C-c ^: Structure editing. (line 107) * C-c `: Built-in table editor. (line 180) * C-c a: Conventions. (line 35) * C-c a !: Stuck projects. (line 14) * C-c a #: Stuck projects. (line 13) * C-c a ?: Pulling from MobileOrg. (line 37) * C-c a a: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) * C-c a C: Storing searches. (line 9) * C-c a e: Exporting agenda views. (line 64) * C-c a M: Matching tags and properties. (line 17) * C-c a m: Matching tags and properties. (line 12) * C-c a M: Property searches. (line 16) * C-c a m: Property searches. (line 12) * C-c a M: Tag searches. (line 17) * C-c a m: Tag searches. (line 13) * C-c a s: Search view. (line 9) * C-c a T: Global TODO list. (line 15) * C-c a t <1>: Global TODO list. (line 9) * C-c a t: TODO basics. (line 49) * C-c c <1>: Using capture. (line 6) * C-c c: Conventions. (line 35) * C-c c C: Capture templates. (line 10) * C-c C-*: Plain lists. (line 144) * C-c C-a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 297) * C-c C-a: Attachments. (line 26) * C-c C-a a: Attachments. (line 31) * C-c C-a c: Attachments. (line 37) * C-c C-a D: Attachments. (line 69) * C-c C-a d: Attachments. (line 66) * C-c C-a F: Attachments. (line 63) * C-c C-a f: Attachments. (line 60) * C-c C-a i: Attachments. (line 78) * C-c C-a l: Attachments. (line 37) * C-c C-a m: Attachments. (line 37) * C-c C-a n: Attachments. (line 44) * C-c C-a O: Attachments. (line 57) * C-c C-a o: Attachments. (line 51) * C-c C-a s: Attachments. (line 73) * C-c C-a u: Attachments. (line 41) * C-c C-a z: Attachments. (line 47) * C-c C-b <1>: Editing support. (line 11) * C-c C-b: Motion. (line 15) * C-c C-c <1>: Cooperation. (line 41) * C-c C-c <2>: The very busy C-c C-c key. (line 6) * C-c C-c <3>: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 11) * C-c C-c <4>: Evaluating code blocks. (line 20) * C-c C-c <5>: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 23) * C-c C-c <6>: Using capture. (line 15) * C-c C-c <7>: The clock table. (line 16) * C-c C-c <8>: Clocking commands. (line 51) * C-c C-c <9>: Creating timestamps. (line 26) * C-c C-c <10>: Capturing column view. (line 54) * C-c C-c <11>: Using column view. (line 53) * C-c C-c <12>: Property syntax. (line 92) * C-c C-c <13>: Setting tags. (line 20) * C-c C-c <14>: Checkboxes. (line 52) * C-c C-c <15>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 47) * C-c C-c <16>: Built-in table editor. (line 58) * C-c C-c <17>: Footnotes. (line 74) * C-c C-c: Plain lists. (line 122) * C-c C-c c: Property syntax. (line 110) * C-c C-c D: Property syntax. (line 107) * C-c C-c d: Property syntax. (line 104) * C-c C-c s: Property syntax. (line 96) * C-c C-d <1>: Agenda commands. (line 304) * C-c C-d: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 9) * C-c C-e: The export dispatcher. (line 15) * C-c C-e c a: iCalendar export. (line 40) * C-c C-e c c: iCalendar export. (line 44) * C-c C-e c f: iCalendar export. (line 38) * C-c C-e C-v: Sparse trees. (line 53) * C-c C-e h H: HTML Export commands. (line 11) * C-c C-e h h: HTML Export commands. (line 6) * C-c C-e i i: Texinfo export commands. (line 8) * C-c C-e i t: Texinfo export commands. (line 6) * C-c C-e l B: Beamer export commands. (line 8) * C-c C-e l b: Beamer export commands. (line 6) * C-c C-e l L: LaTeX export commands. (line 11) * C-c C-e l l: LaTeX export commands. (line 6) * C-c C-e l p: LaTeX export commands. (line 12) * C-c C-e l P: Beamer export commands. (line 11) * C-c C-e m M: Markdown export. (line 18) * C-c C-e m m: Markdown export. (line 16) * C-c C-e O O: Org export. (line 17) * C-c C-e O o: Org export. (line 13) * C-c C-e o o: ODT export commands. (line 6) * C-c C-e P a: Triggering publication. (line 16) * C-c C-e P f: Triggering publication. (line 13) * C-c C-e P p: Triggering publication. (line 10) * C-c C-e P x: Triggering publication. (line 8) * C-c C-e t A/L/U: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 27) * C-c C-e t a/l/u: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 23) * C-c C-f: Motion. (line 12) * C-c C-j: Motion. (line 21) * C-c C-k <1>: Using capture. (line 31) * C-c C-k: Global and local cycling. (line 47) * C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 65) * C-c C-n: Motion. (line 8) * C-c C-o <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 11) * C-c C-o <2>: Agenda commands. (line 61) * C-c C-o <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 38) * C-c C-o <4>: Handling links. (line 101) * C-c C-o: Footnotes. (line 78) * C-c C-p: Motion. (line 9) * C-c C-q <1>: Setting tags. (line 10) * C-c C-q: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 50) * C-c C-r <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 53) * C-c C-r: Global and local cycling. (line 38) * C-c C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 300) * C-c C-s: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 16) * C-c C-t <1>: Clocking commands. (line 67) * C-c C-t: TODO basics. (line 13) * C-c C-u: Motion. (line 18) * C-c C-v a: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 36) * C-c C-v b: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 25) * C-c C-v c: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 30) * C-c C-v C-a: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 36) * C-c C-v C-b: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 25) * C-c C-v C-c: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 30) * C-c C-v C-d: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 27) * C-c C-v C-e: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 19) * C-c C-v C-f: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 29) * C-c C-v C-g: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 23) * C-c C-v C-h: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 37) * C-c C-v C-I: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 34) * C-c C-v C-i: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 33) * C-c C-v C-j: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 31) * C-c C-v C-l: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 32) * C-c C-v C-n: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 18) * C-c C-v C-o: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 20) * C-c C-v C-p: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 18) * C-c C-v C-r: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 24) * C-c C-v C-s: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 26) * C-c C-v C-t: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 28) * C-c C-v C-u: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 22) * C-c C-v C-v: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 21) * C-c C-v C-x: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 38) * C-c C-v C-z: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 35) * C-c C-v d: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 27) * C-c C-v e: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 19) * C-c C-v f: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 29) * C-c C-v g: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 23) * C-c C-v h: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 37) * C-c C-v I: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 34) * C-c C-v i <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 33) * C-c C-v i: Library of Babel. (line 12) * C-c C-v j: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 31) * C-c C-v l: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 32) * C-c C-v n: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 18) * C-c C-v o: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 20) * C-c C-v p: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 18) * C-c C-v r: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 24) * C-c C-v s: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 26) * C-c C-v t <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 28) * C-c C-v t: Extracting source code. (line 36) * C-c C-v u: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 22) * C-c C-v v: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 21) * C-c C-v x: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 38) * C-c C-v z: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 35) * C-c C-w <1>: Agenda commands. (line 247) * C-c C-w <2>: Refile and copy. (line 14) * C-c C-w <3>: Using capture. (line 22) * C-c C-w: Structure editing. (line 103) * C-c C-x ,: Timers. (line 44) * C-c C-x -: Timers. (line 35) * C-c C-x .: Timers. (line 31) * C-c C-x 0: Timers. (line 12) * C-c C-x ;: Timers. (line 20) * C-c C-x <: Agenda files. (line 42) * C-c C-x > <1>: Agenda commands. (line 193) * C-c C-x >: Agenda files. (line 49) * C-c C-x \ <1>: Subscripts and superscripts. (line 20) * C-c C-x \: Special symbols. (line 34) * C-c C-x _: Timers. (line 47) * C-c C-x A: Agenda commands. (line 258) * C-c C-x a: Agenda commands. (line 255) * C-c C-x A: Internal archiving. (line 50) * C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 37) * C-c C-x b <1>: Agenda commands. (line 52) * C-c C-x b: Global and local cycling. (line 55) * C-c C-x c: Structure editing. (line 95) * C-c C-x C-a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 250) * C-c C-x C-a: Archiving. (line 11) * C-c C-x C-b: Checkboxes. (line 56) * C-c C-x C-c <1>: Agenda column view. (line 11) * C-c C-x C-c <2>: Agenda commands. (line 182) * C-c C-x C-c: Using column view. (line 9) * C-c C-x C-d: Clocking commands. (line 80) * C-c C-x C-e <1>: Effort estimates. (line 17) * C-c C-x C-e: Clocking commands. (line 48) * C-c C-x C-i: Clocking commands. (line 6) * C-c C-x C-j: Clocking commands. (line 75) * C-c C-x C-l: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 17) * C-c C-x C-n: Handling links. (line 152) * C-c C-x C-o: Clocking commands. (line 34) * C-c C-x C-p: Handling links. (line 152) * C-c C-x C-q: Clocking commands. (line 71) * C-c C-x C-r: The clock table. (line 10) * C-c C-x C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 262) * C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 9) * C-c C-x C-t: Custom time format. (line 12) * C-c C-x C-u <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21) * C-c C-x C-u <2>: The clock table. (line 16) * C-c C-x C-u: Capturing column view. (line 54) * C-c C-x C-v: Handling links. (line 133) * C-c C-x C-w <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 136) * C-c C-x C-w: Structure editing. (line 69) * C-c C-x C-x: Clocking commands. (line 42) * C-c C-x C-y <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 140) * C-c C-x C-y: Structure editing. (line 77) * C-c C-x d: Drawers. (line 6) * C-c C-x e: Effort estimates. (line 14) * C-c C-x f: Footnotes. (line 41) * C-c C-x G: RSS feeds. (line 27) * C-c C-x g: RSS feeds. (line 23) * C-c C-x i: Capturing column view. (line 52) * C-c C-x M-w <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 132) * C-c C-x M-w: Structure editing. (line 73) * C-c C-x o <1>: Checkboxes. (line 77) * C-c C-x o: TODO dependencies. (line 37) * C-c C-x p <1>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. (line 31) * C-c C-x p: Property syntax. (line 83) * C-c C-x q: Tag hierarchy. (line 86) * C-c C-x v: Global and local cycling. (line 61) * C-c C-y <1>: Clocking commands. (line 51) * C-c C-y: Creating timestamps. (line 59) * C-c C-z <1>: Agenda commands. (line 292) * C-c C-z: Drawers. (line 35) * C-c l <1>: Literal examples. (line 95) * C-c l: Handling links. (line 9) * C-c M-w: Refile and copy. (line 12) * C-c SPC: Built-in table editor. (line 59) * C-c { <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 21) * C-c {: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 32) * C-c |: Built-in table editor. (line 41) * C-c }: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 26) * C-c ~: Cooperation. (line 50) * C-k: Agenda commands. (line 241) * C-M-i: Completion. (line 47) * C-S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 239) * C-S-: Multiple sets in one file. (line 25) * C-S-: Structure editing. (line 30) * C-S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 236) * C-S-: Multiple sets in one file. (line 25) * C-S-: Clocking commands. (line 56) * C-TAB: Internal archiving. (line 47) * C-u C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 19) * C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 16) * C-u C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 19) * C-u C-c = <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 13) * C-u C-c =: Field and range formulas. (line 27) * C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 43) * C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 19) * C-u C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 86) * C-u C-c C-t: TODO basics. (line 27) * C-u C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 33) * C-u C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 40) * C-u C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 11) * C-u C-c C-x C-u <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 22) * C-u C-c C-x C-u <2>: The clock table. (line 19) * C-u C-c C-x C-u: Capturing column view. (line 57) * C-u C-u <1>: Initial visibility. (line 21) * C-u C-u : Global and local cycling. (line 33) * C-u C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 22) * C-u C-u C-c =: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 16) * C-u C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 45) * C-u C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 22) * C-u C-u C-c C-t: Multiple sets in one file. (line 25) * C-u C-u C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 36) * C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 18) * C-u C-u C-u : Global and local cycling. (line 35) * C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t: TODO dependencies. (line 42) * C-v: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * C-x C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 178) * C-x C-s: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 47) * C-x C-w <1>: Exporting agenda views. (line 12) * C-x C-w: Agenda commands. (line 504) * C-x n b: Structure editing. (line 122) * C-x n s: Structure editing. (line 119) * C-x n w: Structure editing. (line 125) * C-y: Structure editing. (line 83) * D: Agenda commands. (line 111) * d: Agenda commands. (line 74) * E: Agenda commands. (line 156) * e: Using column view. (line 47) * f: Agenda commands. (line 93) * F: Agenda commands. (line 45) * g: Agenda commands. (line 175) * G: Agenda commands. (line 164) * g: Using column view. (line 24) * H: Agenda commands. (line 491) * i: Agenda commands. (line 459) * I: Agenda commands. (line 330) * J: Agenda commands. (line 108) * j: Agenda commands. (line 105) * k: Agenda commands. (line 343) * l: Agenda commands. (line 115) * L: Agenda commands. (line 36) * M: Agenda commands. (line 478) * m: Agenda commands. (line 364) * M-*: Agenda commands. (line 378) * M- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 357) * M- <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 77) * M- <3>: Built-in table editor. (line 94) * M- <4>: Plain lists. (line 97) * M-: Structure editing. (line 56) * M- <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 86) * M- <2>: Plain lists. (line 103) * M-: Structure editing. (line 41) * M- <1>: Timers. (line 40) * M- <2>: Built-in table editor. (line 147) * M- <3>: Plain lists. (line 79) * M-: Structure editing. (line 6) * M- <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 86) * M- <2>: Plain lists. (line 103) * M-: Structure editing. (line 44) * M- <1>: Completion. (line 15) * M- <2>: Property syntax. (line 80) * M- <3>: Setting tags. (line 6) * M- <4>: Per-file keywords. (line 23) * M-: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 64) * M- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 353) * M- <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 77) * M- <3>: Built-in table editor. (line 94) * M- <4>: Plain lists. (line 97) * M-: Structure editing. (line 53) * M-a: Built-in table editor. (line 74) * M-down: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 13) * M-e: Built-in table editor. (line 78) * M-g M-n: Sparse trees. (line 29) * M-g M-p: Sparse trees. (line 32) * M-g n: Sparse trees. (line 29) * M-g p: Sparse trees. (line 32) * M-h: Structure editing. (line 59) * M-m: Agenda commands. (line 375) * M-S- <1>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * M-S- <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 72) * M-S-: Built-in table editor. (line 101) * M-S- <1>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * M-S- <2>: Built-in table editor. (line 88) * M-S- <3>: Plain lists. (line 108) * M-S-: Structure editing. (line 47) * M-S- <1>: Checkboxes. (line 74) * M-S- <2>: Plain lists. (line 89) * M-S-: Structure editing. (line 26) * M-S- <1>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * M-S- <2>: Built-in table editor. (line 91) * M-S- <3>: Plain lists. (line 108) * M-S-: Structure editing. (line 50) * M-S- <1>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * M-S- <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 72) * M-S-: Built-in table editor. (line 98) * M-up: Key bindings and useful functions. (line 12) * M-v: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * M-x org-iswitchb: Agenda files. (line 26) * mouse-1 <1>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * mouse-1 <2>: Handling links. (line 124) * mouse-1: Footnotes. (line 78) * mouse-2 <1>: Agenda commands. (line 39) * mouse-2 <2>: Handling links. (line 124) * mouse-2: Footnotes. (line 78) * mouse-3 <1>: Agenda commands. (line 34) * mouse-3: Handling links. (line 129) * N: Agenda commands. (line 23) * n <1>: Agenda commands. (line 19) * n: Using column view. (line 43) * O: Agenda commands. (line 334) * o: Agenda commands. (line 71) * P: Agenda commands. (line 26) * p <1>: Agenda commands. (line 20) * p: Using column view. (line 43) * q <1>: Agenda commands. (line 518) * q: Using column view. (line 27) * r: Agenda commands. (line 168) * R: Agenda commands. (line 137) * r <1>: Global TODO list. (line 23) * r: Using column view. (line 20) * S: Agenda commands. (line 482) * s: Agenda commands. (line 178) * S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 289) * S- <2>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * S- <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 47) * S- <4>: Priorities. (line 28) * S- <5>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * S-: Plain lists. (line 90) * S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 321) * S- <2>: The clock table. (line 23) * S- <3>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * S- <4>: Creating timestamps. (line 42) * S- <5>: Using column view. (line 36) * S- <6>: Property syntax. (line 100) * S- <7>: Multiple sets in one file. (line 32) * S- <8>: TODO basics. (line 33) * S- <9>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * S-: Plain lists. (line 149) * S-: Built-in table editor. (line 165) * S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 307) * S- <2>: The clock table. (line 23) * S- <3>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * S- <4>: Creating timestamps. (line 42) * S- <5>: Using column view. (line 36) * S- <6>: Property syntax. (line 100) * S- <7>: Multiple sets in one file. (line 32) * S- <8>: TODO basics. (line 33) * S- <9>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * S-: Plain lists. (line 149) * S- <1>: Built-in table editor. (line 66) * S-: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * S- <1>: Agenda commands. (line 284) * S- <2>: The date/time prompt. (line 82) * S- <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 47) * S- <4>: Priorities. (line 28) * S-: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * S-M-: Using column view. (line 76) * S-M-: TODO basics. (line 57) * S-M-: Using column view. (line 73) * S-M-: Clocking commands. (line 60) * T: Agenda commands. (line 267) * t: Agenda commands. (line 232) * TAB: Built-in table editor. (line 62) * U: Agenda commands. (line 372) * u: Agenda commands. (line 369) * v: Using column view. (line 56) * v [: Agenda commands. (line 126) * v A: Agenda commands. (line 133) * v a: Agenda commands. (line 130) * v c: Agenda commands. (line 148) * v d: Agenda commands. (line 74) * v E: Agenda commands. (line 156) * v L: Agenda commands. (line 118) * v l: Agenda commands. (line 115) * v m: Agenda commands. (line 79) * v R: Agenda commands. (line 137) * v SPC: Agenda commands. (line 81) * v t: Agenda commands. (line 78) * v w: Agenda commands. (line 77) * v y: Agenda commands. (line 80) * w: Agenda commands. (line 77) * x: Agenda commands. (line 519) * X: Agenda commands. (line 337) * z: Agenda commands. (line 292) * {: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 57) * | <1>: Agenda commands. (line 221) * |: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 112) * }: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 57) * ~: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 154)  File: org, Node: Command and Function Index, Next: Variable Index, Prev: Key Index, Up: Top Command and function index ************************** [index] * Menu: * lisp-complete-symbol: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 64) * next-error: Sparse trees. (line 29) * org-agenda <1>: Conventions. (line 35) * org-agenda: Activation. (line 6) * org-agenda-add-note: Agenda commands. (line 292) * org-agenda-archive: Agenda commands. (line 262) * org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation: Agenda commands. (line 250) * org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling: Agenda commands. (line 258) * org-agenda-archives-mode: Agenda commands. (line 130) * org-agenda-archives-mode 'files: Agenda commands. (line 133) * org-agenda-bulk-action: Agenda commands. (line 384) * org-agenda-bulk-mark: Agenda commands. (line 364) * org-agenda-bulk-mark-all: Agenda commands. (line 366) * org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp: Agenda commands. (line 381) * org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks: Agenda commands. (line 372) * org-agenda-bulk-toggle: Agenda commands. (line 375) * org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all: Agenda commands. (line 378) * org-agenda-bulk-unmark: Agenda commands. (line 369) * org-agenda-capture: Agenda commands. (line 343) * org-agenda-clock-cancel: Agenda commands. (line 337) * org-agenda-clock-goto: Agenda commands. (line 108) * org-agenda-clock-in: Agenda commands. (line 330) * org-agenda-clock-out: Agenda commands. (line 334) * org-agenda-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 137) * org-agenda-columns <1>: Agenda column view. (line 11) * org-agenda-columns: Agenda commands. (line 182) * org-agenda-convert-date: Agenda commands. (line 487) * org-agenda-date-prompt: Agenda commands. (line 325) * org-agenda-day-view: Agenda commands. (line 74) * org-agenda-deadline: Agenda commands. (line 304) * org-agenda-diary-entry: Agenda commands. (line 459) * org-agenda-do-date-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 321) * org-agenda-do-date-later: Agenda commands. (line 307) * org-agenda-drag-line-backward: Agenda commands. (line 353) * org-agenda-drag-line-forward: Agenda commands. (line 357) * org-agenda-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 99) * org-agenda-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 156) * org-agenda-exit: Agenda commands. (line 519) * org-agenda-file-to-front: Agenda files. (line 15) * org-agenda-filter-by-category <1>: Agenda commands. (line 207) * org-agenda-filter-by-category: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 67) * org-agenda-filter-by-effort <1>: Agenda commands. (line 218) * org-agenda-filter-by-effort: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 91) * org-agenda-filter-by-regexp <1>: Agenda commands. (line 215) * org-agenda-filter-by-regexp: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 81) * org-agenda-filter-by-tag <1>: Agenda commands. (line 203) * org-agenda-filter-by-tag: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 17) * org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline <1>: Agenda commands. (line 211) * org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 77) * org-agenda-filter-remove-all <1>: Agenda commands. (line 221) * org-agenda-filter-remove-all: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 112) * org-agenda-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 45) * org-agenda-fortnight-view: Agenda commands. (line 78) * org-agenda-goto: Agenda commands. (line 39) * org-agenda-goto-calendar: Agenda commands. (line 454) * org-agenda-goto-date: Agenda commands. (line 105) * org-agenda-goto-today: Agenda commands. (line 102) * org-agenda-holidays: Agenda commands. (line 491) * org-agenda-kill: Agenda commands. (line 241) * org-agenda-later: Agenda commands. (line 93) * org-agenda-limit-interactively: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 154) * org-agenda-list: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) * org-agenda-list-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 13) * org-agenda-log-mode: Agenda commands. (line 115) * org-agenda-manipulate-query-add: Agenda commands. (line 126) * org-agenda-month-view: Agenda commands. (line 79) * org-agenda-next-item: Agenda commands. (line 23) * org-agenda-next-line: Agenda commands. (line 19) * org-agenda-open-link: Agenda commands. (line 61) * org-agenda-phases-of-moon: Agenda commands. (line 478) * org-agenda-previous-item: Agenda commands. (line 26) * org-agenda-previous-line: Agenda commands. (line 20) * org-agenda-priority-down: Agenda commands. (line 289) * org-agenda-priority-up: Agenda commands. (line 284) * org-agenda-quit: Agenda commands. (line 518) * org-agenda-recenter: Agenda commands. (line 36) * org-agenda-redo: Agenda commands. (line 168) * org-agenda-refile: Agenda commands. (line 247) * org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock <1>: Agenda commands. (line 193) * org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock: Agenda files. (line 49) * org-agenda-reset-view: Agenda commands. (line 81) * org-agenda-schedule: Agenda commands. (line 300) * org-agenda-set-restriction-lock: Agenda files. (line 42) * org-agenda-set-tags: Agenda commands. (line 272) * org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up: Agenda commands. (line 34) * org-agenda-show-priority: Agenda commands. (line 281) * org-agenda-show-tags: Agenda commands. (line 267) * org-agenda-sunrise-sunset: Agenda commands. (line 482) * org-agenda-switch-to: Agenda commands. (line 42) * org-agenda-todo: Agenda commands. (line 232) * org-agenda-todo-nextset: Agenda commands. (line 236) * org-agenda-todo-previousset: Agenda commands. (line 239) * org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag: Agenda commands. (line 255) * org-agenda-toggle-diary: Agenda commands. (line 111) * org-agenda-toggle-time-grid: Agenda commands. (line 164) * org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Agenda commands. (line 52) * org-agenda-undo: Agenda commands. (line 228) * org-agenda-week-view: Agenda commands. (line 77) * org-agenda-write <1>: Exporting agenda views. (line 12) * org-agenda-write: Agenda commands. (line 504) * org-agenda-year-view: Agenda commands. (line 80) * org-archive-subtree: Moving subtrees. (line 9) * org-archive-subtree-default: Archiving. (line 11) * org-archive-to-archive-sibling: Internal archiving. (line 50) * org-ascii-export-as-ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 27) * org-ascii-export-to-ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 23) * org-attach <1>: Agenda commands. (line 297) * org-attach: Attachments. (line 26) * org-attach-attach: Attachments. (line 31) * org-attach-delete-all: Attachments. (line 69) * org-attach-delete-one: Attachments. (line 66) * org-attach-new: Attachments. (line 44) * org-attach-open: Attachments. (line 51) * org-attach-open-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 57) * org-attach-reveal: Attachments. (line 60) * org-attach-reveal-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 63) * org-attach-set-directory: Attachments. (line 73) * org-attach-set-inherit: Attachments. (line 78) * org-attach-sync: Attachments. (line 47) * org-attach-url: Attachments. (line 41) * org-backward-same-level: Motion. (line 15) * org-beamer-export-as-latex: Beamer export commands. (line 8) * org-beamer-export-to-latex: Beamer export commands. (line 6) * org-beamer-export-to-pdf: Beamer export commands. (line 11) * org-beamer-select-environment: Editing support. (line 11) * org-buffer-property-keys: Using the property API. (line 34) * org-calendar-goto-agenda: Agenda commands. (line 455) * org-capture <1>: Using capture. (line 6) * org-capture <2>: Conventions. (line 35) * org-capture: Activation. (line 6) * org-capture-finalize: Using capture. (line 15) * org-capture-kill: Using capture. (line 31) * org-capture-refile: Using capture. (line 22) * org-check-after-date: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 31) * org-check-before-date: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 28) * org-check-deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 21) * org-clock-cancel: Clocking commands. (line 71) * org-clock-display: Clocking commands. (line 80) * org-clock-goto: Clocking commands. (line 75) * org-clock-in: Clocking commands. (line 6) * org-clock-in-last: Clocking commands. (line 42) * org-clock-modify-effort-estimate <1>: Effort estimates. (line 17) * org-clock-modify-effort-estimate: Clocking commands. (line 48) * org-clock-out: Clocking commands. (line 34) * org-clock-report: The clock table. (line 10) * org-clock-timestamps-up/down: Clocking commands. (line 56) * org-clocktable-try-shift: The clock table. (line 23) * org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift: Structure editing. (line 95) * org-columns: Using column view. (line 9) * org-columns-delete: Using column view. (line 76) * org-columns-edit-allowed: Using column view. (line 60) * org-columns-edit-value: Using column view. (line 47) * org-columns-narrow: Using column view. (line 71) * org-columns-new: Using column view. (line 73) * org-columns-next-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 43) * org-columns-previous-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 43) * org-columns-quit: Using column view. (line 27) * org-columns-redo: Using column view. (line 20) * org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle: Using column view. (line 53) * org-columns-show-value: Using column view. (line 56) * org-columns-widen: Using column view. (line 71) * org-compute-property-at-point: Property syntax. (line 110) * org-copy: Refile and copy. (line 12) * org-copy-subtree: Structure editing. (line 73) * org-copy-visible: Global and local cycling. (line 61) * org-cut-subtree: Structure editing. (line 69) * org-cycle <1>: Plain lists. (line 68) * org-cycle <2>: Structure editing. (line 35) * org-cycle: Global and local cycling. (line 10) * org-cycle-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 22) * org-date-from-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 29) * org-dblock-update <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21) * org-dblock-update <2>: The clock table. (line 16) * org-dblock-update: Capturing column view. (line 54) * org-deadline: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 9) * org-delete-property: Property syntax. (line 104) * org-delete-property-globally: Property syntax. (line 107) * org-demote: Using the mapping API. (line 78) * org-demote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 50) * org-do-demote: Structure editing. (line 44) * org-do-promote: Structure editing. (line 41) * org-edit-special: Cooperation. (line 48) * org-entities-help: Special symbols. (line 16) * org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property: Using the property API. (line 51) * org-entry-delete: Using the property API. (line 28) * org-entry-get: Using the property API. (line 19) * org-entry-get-multivalued-property: Using the property API. (line 46) * org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property: Using the property API. (line 63) * org-entry-properties: Using the property API. (line 9) * org-entry-put: Using the property API. (line 31) * org-entry-put-multivalued-property: Using the property API. (line 41) * org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property: Using the property API. (line 57) * org-evaluate-time-range <1>: Clocking commands. (line 51) * org-evaluate-time-range: Creating timestamps. (line 59) * org-export-dispatch: The export dispatcher. (line 15) * org-feed-goto-inbox: RSS feeds. (line 27) * org-feed-update-all: RSS feeds. (line 23) * org-force-cycle-archived: Internal archiving. (line 47) * org-forward-same-level: Motion. (line 12) * org-global-cycle: Global and local cycling. (line 18) * org-goto: Motion. (line 21) * org-goto-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 33) * org-html-export-as-html: HTML Export commands. (line 11) * org-html-export-to-html: HTML Export commands. (line 6) * org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files: iCalendar export. (line 44) * org-icalendar-export-agenda-files: iCalendar export. (line 40) * org-icalendar-export-to-ics: iCalendar export. (line 38) * org-insert-columns-dblock: Capturing column view. (line 52) * org-insert-heading <1>: Timers. (line 40) * org-insert-heading: Plain lists. (line 79) * org-insert-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 23) * org-insert-link: Handling links. (line 65) * org-insert-property-drawer: Using the property API. (line 18) * org-insert-todo-heading <1>: Checkboxes. (line 74) * org-insert-todo-heading <2>: TODO basics. (line 57) * org-insert-todo-heading: Structure editing. (line 26) * org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 30) * org-iswitchb: Activation. (line 6) * org-latex-export-as-latex: LaTeX export commands. (line 11) * org-latex-export-to-latex: LaTeX export commands. (line 6) * org-latex-export-to-pdf: LaTeX export commands. (line 12) * org-lookup-all: Lookup functions. (line 22) * org-lookup-first: Lookup functions. (line 8) * org-lookup-last: Lookup functions. (line 18) * org-map-entries: Using the mapping API. (line 12) * org-mark-element: Structure editing. (line 59) * org-mark-ring-goto: Handling links. (line 146) * org-mark-ring-push: Handling links. (line 142) * org-mark-subtree: Structure editing. (line 65) * org-match-sparse-tree <1>: Property searches. (line 10) * org-match-sparse-tree: Tag searches. (line 9) * org-md-export-as-markdown: Markdown export. (line 18) * org-md-export-to-markdown: Markdown export. (line 16) * org-meta-return: Structure editing. (line 6) * org-move-subtree-down: Structure editing. (line 56) * org-move-subtree-up: Structure editing. (line 53) * org-narrow-to-block: Structure editing. (line 122) * org-narrow-to-subtree: Structure editing. (line 119) * org-next-link: Handling links. (line 152) * org-next-visible-heading: Motion. (line 8) * org-occur: Sparse trees. (line 17) * org-odt-export-to-odt: ODT export commands. (line 6) * org-open-at-point <1>: Creating timestamps. (line 38) * org-open-at-point: Handling links. (line 101) * org-org-export-as-org: Org export. (line 17) * org-org-export-to-org: Org export. (line 13) * org-paste-subtree: Structure editing. (line 77) * org-previous-link: Handling links. (line 152) * org-previous-visible-heading: Motion. (line 9) * org-priority <1>: Using the mapping API. (line 66) * org-priority: Priorities. (line 24) * org-priority-down: Priorities. (line 28) * org-priority-up: Priorities. (line 28) * org-promote: Using the mapping API. (line 75) * org-promote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 47) * org-property-action: Property syntax. (line 92) * org-property-next-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 100) * org-property-previous-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 100) * org-protocol-create: open-source protocol. (line 67) * org-protocol-create-for-org: open-source protocol. (line 67) * org-publish: Triggering publication. (line 8) * org-publish-all: Triggering publication. (line 16) * org-publish-current-file: Triggering publication. (line 13) * org-publish-current-project: Triggering publication. (line 10) * org-refile <1>: Refile and copy. (line 14) * org-refile: Structure editing. (line 103) * org-refile-cache-clear: Refile and copy. (line 47) * org-refile-goto-last-stored: Refile and copy. (line 36) * org-remove-file: Agenda files. (line 19) * org-reveal: Global and local cycling. (line 38) * org-save-all-org-buffers: Agenda commands. (line 178) * org-schedule: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 16) * org-search-view: Search view. (line 9) * org-set-effort: Effort estimates. (line 14) * org-set-property: Property syntax. (line 83) * org-set-startup-visibility <1>: Initial visibility. (line 21) * org-set-startup-visibility: Global and local cycling. (line 33) * org-set-tags-command: Setting tags. (line 10) * org-show-todo-tree: TODO basics. (line 38) * org-sort: Structure editing. (line 107) * org-sparse-tree: Sparse trees. (line 15) * org-speed-command-help: Speed keys. (line 19) * org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction: Agenda files. (line 57) * org-store-agenda-views: Exporting agenda views. (line 64) * org-store-link <1>: Handling links. (line 9) * org-store-link: Activation. (line 6) * org-table-align: Built-in table editor. (line 58) * org-table-beginning-of-field: Built-in table editor. (line 74) * org-table-blank-field: Built-in table editor. (line 59) * org-table-copy-down: Built-in table editor. (line 165) * org-table-copy-region: Built-in table editor. (line 132) * org-table-create-or-convert-from-region: Built-in table editor. (line 41) * org-table-create-with-table.el: Cooperation. (line 50) * org-table-cut-region: Built-in table editor. (line 136) * org-table-delete-column: Built-in table editor. (line 88) * org-table-edit-field: Built-in table editor. (line 180) * org-table-edit-formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 36) * org-table-end-of-field: Built-in table editor. (line 78) * org-table-eval-formula <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 13) * org-table-eval-formula <2>: Column formulas. (line 32) * org-table-eval-formula: Field and range formulas. (line 27) * org-table-export: Built-in table editor. (line 205) * org-table-fedit-abort: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 50) * org-table-fedit-finish: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 47) * org-table-fedit-line-down: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 72) * org-table-fedit-line-up: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 72) * org-table-fedit-lisp-indent: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 57) * org-table-fedit-ref-down: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * org-table-fedit-ref-left: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * org-table-fedit-ref-right: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * org-table-fedit-ref-up: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 67) * org-table-fedit-scroll-down: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 77) * org-table-fedit-scroll-up: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 77) * org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 53) * org-table-field-info: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 22) * org-table-hline-and-move: Built-in table editor. (line 109) * org-table-insert-column: Built-in table editor. (line 91) * org-table-insert-hline: Built-in table editor. (line 105) * org-table-insert-row: Built-in table editor. (line 101) * org-table-iterate: Updating the table. (line 22) * org-table-iterate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 33) * org-table-kill-row: Built-in table editor. (line 98) * org-table-move-column-left: Built-in table editor. (line 86) * org-table-move-column-right: Built-in table editor. (line 86) * org-table-move-row-down: Built-in table editor. (line 94) * org-table-move-row-up: Built-in table editor. (line 94) * org-table-next-field: Built-in table editor. (line 62) * org-table-next-row: Built-in table editor. (line 69) * org-table-paste-rectangle: Built-in table editor. (line 140) * org-table-previous-field: Built-in table editor. (line 66) * org-table-recalculate: Updating the table. (line 13) * org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 30) * org-table-rotate-recalc-marks: Advanced features. (line 10) * org-table-sort-lines: Built-in table editor. (line 113) * org-table-sum: Built-in table editor. (line 162) * org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 26) * org-table-toggle-formula-debugger: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 32) * org-table-wrap-region: Built-in table editor. (line 147) * org-tags-view <1>: Matching tags and properties. (line 12) * org-tags-view <2>: Property searches. (line 12) * org-tags-view: Tag searches. (line 13) * org-texinfo-export-to-info: Texinfo export commands. (line 8) * org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo: Texinfo export commands. (line 6) * org-time-stamp: Creating timestamps. (line 10) * org-time-stamp-inactive: Creating timestamps. (line 15) * org-timer: Timers. (line 31) * org-timer-item: Timers. (line 35) * org-timer-pause-or-continue: Timers. (line 44) * org-timer-set-timer: Timers. (line 20) * org-timer-start: Timers. (line 12) * org-timer-stop: Timers. (line 47) * org-timestamp-down-day: Creating timestamps. (line 42) * org-timestamp-down-down: Creating timestamps. (line 47) * org-timestamp-up: Creating timestamps. (line 47) * org-timestamp-up-day: Creating timestamps. (line 42) * org-timestamp-up/down: Clocking commands. (line 60) * org-todo <1>: Using the mapping API. (line 62) * org-todo <2>: Clocking commands. (line 67) * org-todo: TODO basics. (line 13) * org-todo-list <1>: Global TODO list. (line 9) * org-todo-list: TODO basics. (line 49) * org-toggle-archive-tag: Internal archiving. (line 37) * org-toggle-checkbox: Checkboxes. (line 52) * org-toggle-heading: Structure editing. (line 128) * org-toggle-inline-images: Handling links. (line 133) * org-toggle-ordered-property <1>: Checkboxes. (line 77) * org-toggle-ordered-property: TODO dependencies. (line 37) * org-toggle-tag: Using the mapping API. (line 70) * org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays: Custom time format. (line 12) * org-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Global and local cycling. (line 55) * org-update-all-dblocks: Capturing column view. (line 57) * org-update-statistics-cookies: Checkboxes. (line 85) * org-yank: Structure editing. (line 83) * outline-show-all: Global and local cycling. (line 35) * outline-show-branches: Global and local cycling. (line 47) * outline-show-children: Global and local cycling. (line 51) * outline-up-heading: Motion. (line 18) * pcomplete: Property syntax. (line 80) * previous-error: Sparse trees. (line 32) * widen: Structure editing. (line 125)  File: org, Node: Variable Index, Prev: Command and Function Index, Up: Top Variable index ************** This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are mentioned in the manual. For a complete list, use `M-x org-customize '. [index] * Menu: * cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) * constants-unit-system <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 145) * constants-unit-system: References. (line 117) * htmlize-output-type: Exporting agenda views. (line 20) * LaTeX-verbatim-environments: A LaTeX example. (line 20) * org-adapt-indentation: Clean view. (line 52) * org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines: Exporting agenda views. (line 20) * org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions: Agenda commands. (line 364) * org-agenda-category-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 68) * org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks: Agenda commands. (line 151) * org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum: Effort estimates. (line 41) * org-agenda-confirm-kill: Agenda commands. (line 244) * org-agenda-custom-commands <1>: Extracting agenda information. (line 6) * org-agenda-custom-commands <2>: Setting options. (line 6) * org-agenda-custom-commands <3>: Storing searches. (line 9) * org-agenda-custom-commands: Sparse trees. (line 37) * org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts: Setting options. (line 61) * org-agenda-diary-file: Agenda commands. (line 462) * org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks <1>: Speeding up your agendas. (line 15) * org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks: TODO dependencies. (line 47) * org-agenda-effort-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 92) * org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines: Agenda commands. (line 159) * org-agenda-exporter-settings <1>: Exporting agenda views. (line 13) * org-agenda-exporter-settings: Agenda commands. (line 505) * org-agenda-files <1>: iCalendar export. (line 43) * org-agenda-files <2>: Sorting agenda items. (line 8) * org-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 6) * org-agenda-inhibit-startup <1>: Speeding up your agendas. (line 18) * org-agenda-inhibit-startup: Initial visibility. (line 6) * org-agenda-log-mode-items: Agenda commands. (line 118) * org-agenda-max-effort: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 118) * org-agenda-max-entries: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 118) * org-agenda-max-tags: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 118) * org-agenda-max-todos: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 118) * org-agenda-ndays: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) * org-agenda-overriding-header: Special agenda views. (line 38) * org-agenda-prefix-format: Presentation and sorting. (line 6) * org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 82) * org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit: Agenda views. (line 42) * org-agenda-show-inherited-tags <1>: Speeding up your agendas. (line 21) * org-agenda-show-inherited-tags: Agenda commands. (line 270) * org-agenda-skip-archived-trees <1>: Agenda views. (line 37) * org-agenda-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 22) * org-agenda-skip-comment-trees: Agenda views. (line 37) * org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 14) * org-agenda-skip-function <1>: Using the mapping API. (line 49) * org-agenda-skip-function: Special agenda views. (line 6) * org-agenda-skip-function-global: Special agenda views. (line 6) * org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 42) * org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown: Repeated tasks. (line 72) * org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 34) * org-agenda-sorting-strategy: Sorting agenda items. (line 27) * org-agenda-span <1>: Agenda commands. (line 82) * org-agenda-span: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) * org-agenda-start-day: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) * org-agenda-start-on-weekday: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) * org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 140) * org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 159) * org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 48) * org-agenda-sticky: Agenda dispatcher. (line 50) * org-agenda-tag-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 18) * org-agenda-tags-column: Presentation and sorting. (line 6) * org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options: Matching tags and properties. (line 20) * org-agenda-text-search-extra-files <1>: Search view. (line 24) * org-agenda-text-search-extra-files: Agenda dispatcher. (line 29) * org-agenda-time-grid <1>: Agenda commands. (line 167) * org-agenda-time-grid: Time-of-day specifications. (line 41) * org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines: Global TODO list. (line 38) * org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled: Global TODO list. (line 38) * org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp: Global TODO list. (line 38) * org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date: Global TODO list. (line 38) * org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels <1>: Global TODO list. (line 47) * org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) * org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance <1>: Speeding up your agendas. (line 21) * org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 32) * org-agenda-use-time-grid <1>: Agenda commands. (line 167) * org-agenda-use-time-grid: Time-of-day specifications. (line 41) * org-agenda-window-setup: Agenda views. (line 42) * org-archive-default-command <1>: Agenda commands. (line 253) * org-archive-default-command: Archiving. (line 12) * org-archive-location <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 14) * org-archive-location: Moving subtrees. (line 10) * org-archive-save-context-info: Moving subtrees. (line 41) * org-ascii-links-to-notes: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 16) * org-ascii-text-width: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. (line 13) * org-attach-directory: Attachments. (line 6) * org-attach-method: Attachments. (line 32) * org-babel-default-header-args <1>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. (line 31) * org-babel-default-header-args: System-wide header arguments. (line 6) * org-babel-load-languages: Languages. (line 35) * org-beamer-environments-default: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 21) * org-beamer-environments-extra: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 21) * org-beamer-frame-level: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. (line 10) * org-beamer-subtitle-format: Beamer specific export settings. (line 44) * org-beamer-theme: Beamer specific export settings. (line 11) * org-calc-default-modes: Formula syntax for Calc. (line 14) * org-capture-bookmark: Using capture. (line 50) * org-capture-templates-contexts: Templates in contexts. (line 6) * org-capture-use-agenda-date: Agenda commands. (line 348) * org-catch-invisible-edits: Catching invisible edits. (line 6) * org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30) * org-clock-continuously <1>: Resolving idle time. (line 78) * org-clock-continuously: Clocking commands. (line 7) * org-clock-idle-time: Resolving idle time. (line 14) * org-clock-into-drawer: Clocking commands. (line 7) * org-clock-modeline-total: Clocking commands. (line 20) * org-clock-report-include-clocking-task: Agenda commands. (line 140) * org-clock-x11idle-program-name: Resolving idle time. (line 9) * org-clocktable-defaults: The clock table. (line 37) * org-closed-keep-when-no-todo: Closing items. (line 11) * org-coderef-label-format: Literal examples. (line 75) * org-columns-default-format <1>: Agenda column view. (line 18) * org-columns-default-format <2>: Agenda commands. (line 185) * org-columns-default-format <3>: Effort estimates. (line 31) * org-columns-default-format: Using column view. (line 10) * org-columns-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 32) * org-columns-summary-types: Column attributes. (line 65) * org-confirm-babel-evaluate: Code evaluation security. (line 26) * org-confirm-elisp-link-function: Code evaluation security. (line 53) * org-confirm-shell-link-function: Code evaluation security. (line 50) * org-create-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12) * org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook: Context-sensitive commands. (line 6) * org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree: Headlines. (line 6) * org-cycle-emulate-tab: Global and local cycling. (line 16) * org-cycle-global-at-bob: Global and local cycling. (line 29) * org-cycle-include-plain-lists: Plain lists. (line 69) * org-cycle-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 12) * org-cycle-separator-lines: Headlines. (line 26) * org-deadline-warning-days <1>: Inserting deadline/schedule. (line 24) * org-deadline-warning-days: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 14) * org-default-notes-file <1>: Template elements. (line 49) * org-default-notes-file: Setting up capture. (line 9) * org-default-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) * org-default-priority: Priorities. (line 37) * org-display-custom-times: Custom time format. (line 6) * org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer: Handling links. (line 132) * org-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 28) * org-done (face): Faces for TODO keywords. (line 6) * org-edit-footnote-reference: Footnotes. (line 85) * org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay: Editing source code. (line 6) * org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save: Editing source code. (line 6) * org-emphasis-alist: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * org-emphasis-regexp-components: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * org-enforce-todo-dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6) * org-entities-user: Special symbols. (line 16) * org-execute-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12) * org-export-allow-bind-keywords: Export settings. (line 211) * org-export-async-init-file: The export dispatcher. (line 28) * org-export-backends <1>: Other built-in back-ends. (line 6) * org-export-backends: Exporting. (line 42) * org-export-before-parsing-hook: Advanced configuration. (line 9) * org-export-before-processing-hook: Advanced configuration. (line 9) * org-export-creator-string <1>: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-export-creator-string: Export settings. (line 28) * org-export-date-timestamp-format: Export settings. (line 32) * org-export-default-language: Export settings. (line 38) * org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui: The export dispatcher. (line 6) * org-export-exclude-tags: Export settings. (line 52) * org-export-global-macros: Macro replacement. (line 6) * org-export-headline-levels: Export settings. (line 141) * org-export-in-background: The export dispatcher. (line 39) * org-export-initial-scope: The export dispatcher. (line 48) * org-export-preserve-breaks: Export settings. (line 93) * org-export-select-tags: Export settings. (line 44) * org-export-time-stamp-file <1>: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-export-time-stamp-file: Export settings. (line 186) * org-export-use-babel: Exporting code blocks. (line 36) * org-export-with-archived-trees <1>: Export settings. (line 102) * org-export-with-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 28) * org-export-with-author: Export settings. (line 107) * org-export-with-broken-links: Export settings. (line 111) * org-export-with-clocks: Export settings. (line 116) * org-export-with-creator: Export settings. (line 119) * org-export-with-date: Export settings. (line 127) * org-export-with-drawers <1>: Export settings. (line 123) * org-export-with-drawers: Drawers. (line 38) * org-export-with-email: Export settings. (line 134) * org-export-with-entities: Export settings. (line 131) * org-export-with-fixed-width: Export settings. (line 86) * org-export-with-footnotes: Export settings. (line 138) * org-export-with-inlinetasks: Export settings. (line 146) * org-export-with-latex <1>: Export settings. (line 182) * org-export-with-latex: LaTeX fragments. (line 38) * org-export-with-planning: Export settings. (line 156) * org-export-with-priority: Export settings. (line 162) * org-export-with-properties <1>: Export settings. (line 165) * org-export-with-properties: Drawers. (line 38) * org-export-with-section-numbers: Export settings. (line 149) * org-export-with-smart-quotes: Export settings. (line 73) * org-export-with-special-strings: Export settings. (line 82) * org-export-with-statistics-cookies: Export settings. (line 169) * org-export-with-sub-superscripts: Export settings. (line 97) * org-export-with-tables: Export settings. (line 201) * org-export-with-tags: Export settings. (line 173) * org-export-with-tasks: Export settings. (line 177) * org-export-with-timestamps: Export settings. (line 89) * org-export-with-title: Export settings. (line 190) * org-export-with-toc <1>: Table of contents. (line 6) * org-export-with-toc: Export settings. (line 193) * org-export-with-todo-keywords: Export settings. (line 197) * org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo: Fast access to TODO states. (line 16) * org-fast-tag-selection-single-key: Setting tags. (line 143) * org-file-apps <1>: Attachments. (line 52) * org-file-apps: Handling links. (line 104) * org-fontify-emphasized-text: Emphasis and monospace. (line 6) * org-footnote-auto-adjust <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) * org-footnote-auto-adjust: Footnotes. (line 48) * org-footnote-auto-label <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) * org-footnote-auto-label: Footnotes. (line 34) * org-footnote-define-inline <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) * org-footnote-define-inline: Footnotes. (line 48) * org-footnote-section <1>: Footnotes. (line 48) * org-footnote-section: Headlines. (line 18) * org-format-latex-header <1>: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 12) * org-format-latex-header: LaTeX fragments. (line 6) * org-format-latex-options: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 12) * org-from-is-user-regexp: Template expansion. (line 49) * org-global-properties <1>: Effort estimates. (line 31) * org-global-properties: Property syntax. (line 75) * org-goto-auto-isearch: Motion. (line 26) * org-goto-interface: Motion. (line 37) * org-group-tags: Tag hierarchy. (line 86) * org-hide (face): Clean view. (line 70) * org-hide-block-startup: Blocks. (line 6) * org-hide-leading-stars <1>: Clean view. (line 55) * org-hide-leading-stars: In-buffer settings. (line 129) * org-hierarchical-todo-statistics: Breaking down tasks. (line 25) * org-highest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) * org-highest-priority: Priorities. (line 37) * org-html-container-element: HTML Specific export settings. (line 19) * org-html-doctype <1>: HTML doctypes. (line 8) * org-html-doctype: HTML Specific export settings. (line 16) * org-html-doctype-alist: HTML doctypes. (line 8) * org-html-head <1>: CSS support. (line 43) * org-html-head: HTML Specific export settings. (line 35) * org-html-head-extra <1>: CSS support. (line 43) * org-html-head-extra: HTML Specific export settings. (line 39) * org-html-head-include-default-style: CSS support. (line 43) * org-html-html5-elements: HTML doctypes. (line 66) * org-html-html5-fancy: HTML doctypes. (line 33) * org-html-infojs-options: JavaScript support. (line 51) * org-html-inline-images: Images in HTML export. (line 6) * org-html-link-home: HTML Specific export settings. (line 23) * org-html-link-org-files-as-html: Links in HTML export. (line 6) * org-html-link-up: HTML Specific export settings. (line 26) * org-html-mathjax-options: HTML Specific export settings. (line 30) * org-html-postamble: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-html-postamble-format: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-html-preamble: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-html-preamble-format: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-html-style-default: CSS support. (line 43) * org-html-table-align-individual-fields: Tables in HTML export. (line 19) * org-html-table-caption-above: Tables in HTML export. (line 23) * org-html-table-data-tags: Tables in HTML export. (line 26) * org-html-table-default-attributes: Tables in HTML export. (line 6) * org-html-table-header-tags: Tables in HTML export. (line 32) * org-html-table-row-tags: Tables in HTML export. (line 35) * org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column: Tables in HTML export. (line 38) * org-html-tag-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6) * org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6) * org-html-use-infojs: JavaScript support. (line 51) * org-html-validation-link: HTML preamble and postamble. (line 6) * org-icalendar-alarm-time: iCalendar export. (line 6) * org-icalendar-categories: iCalendar export. (line 6) * org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file: iCalendar export. (line 47) * org-icalendar-include-body: iCalendar export. (line 51) * org-icalendar-include-todo: iCalendar export. (line 6) * org-icalendar-store-UID: iCalendar export. (line 26) * org-icalendar-use-deadline: iCalendar export. (line 6) * org-icalendar-use-scheduled: iCalendar export. (line 6) * org-id-link-to-org-use-id: Handling links. (line 21) * org-imenu-depth: Cooperation. (line 30) * org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file: Activation. (line 27) * org-irc-link-to-logs: Handling links. (line 45) * org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion: Handling links. (line 66) * org-latex-bibtex-compiler: LaTeX export commands. (line 21) * org-latex-classes <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 13) * org-latex-classes: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 20) * org-latex-compiler <1>: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 32) * org-latex-compiler: LaTeX export commands. (line 21) * org-latex-default-class <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 13) * org-latex-default-class: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 20) * org-latex-default-packages-alist <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 13) * org-latex-default-packages-alist: LaTeX export commands. (line 21) * org-latex-default-table-environment: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 22) * org-latex-default-table-mode: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 11) * org-latex-images-centered: Images in LaTeX export. (line 50) * org-latex-listings: Literal examples. (line 23) * org-latex-listings-options: Source blocks in LaTeX export. (line 23) * org-latex-minted-options: Source blocks in LaTeX export. (line 23) * org-latex-packages-alist: LaTeX header and sectioning. (line 13) * org-latex-subtitle-format: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 55) * org-latex-subtitle-separate: LaTeX specific export settings. (line 55) * org-latex-tables-booktabs: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 64) * org-latex-tables-centered: Tables in LaTeX export. (line 64) * org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 21) * org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file: Working with LaTeX math snippets. (line 21) * org-link-abbrev-alist <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 40) * org-link-abbrev-alist: Link abbreviations. (line 12) * org-link-frame-setup: Handling links. (line 104) * org-link-parameters: Handling links. (line 66) * org-list-allow-alphabetical: Plain lists. (line 14) * org-list-automatic-rules <1>: Checkboxes. (line 6) * org-list-automatic-rules: Plain lists. (line 62) * org-list-demote-modify-bullet: Plain lists. (line 56) * org-list-indent-offset: Plain lists. (line 56) * org-list-use-circular-motion: Plain lists. (line 94) * org-log-done <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) * org-log-done <2>: Agenda commands. (line 118) * org-log-done: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 29) * org-log-into-drawer <1>: Agenda commands. (line 295) * org-log-into-drawer: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 6) * org-log-note-clock-out <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) * org-log-note-clock-out: Clocking commands. (line 37) * org-log-refile: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-log-repeat <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) * org-log-repeat: Repeated tasks. (line 37) * org-log-states-order-reversed: Tracking TODO state changes. (line 6) * org-lowest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) * org-lowest-priority: Priorities. (line 37) * org-M-RET-may-split-line <1>: Plain lists. (line 82) * org-M-RET-may-split-line: Structure editing. (line 7) * org-md-headline-style: Markdown export. (line 29) * org-odd-levels-only <1>: Special agenda views. (line 41) * org-odd-levels-only <2>: Clean view. (line 75) * org-odd-levels-only <3>: In-buffer settings. (line 129) * org-odd-levels-only: Matching tags and properties. (line 72) * org-odt-category-map-alist: Labels and captions in ODT export. (line 21) * org-odt-convert: Extending ODT export. (line 36) * org-odt-convert-capabilities: Configuring a document converter. (line 18) * org-odt-convert-process: Configuring a document converter. (line 25) * org-odt-convert-processes: Configuring a document converter. (line 12) * org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks: Literal examples in ODT export. (line 16) * org-odt-fontify-srcblocks: Literal examples in ODT export. (line 13) * org-odt-pixels-per-inch: Images in ODT export. (line 34) * org-odt-preferred-output-format <1>: Extending ODT export. (line 21) * org-odt-preferred-output-format: ODT export commands. (line 9) * org-odt-schema-dir: Validating OpenDocument XML. (line 14) * org-odt-styles-file <1>: Applying custom styles. (line 25) * org-odt-styles-file: ODT specific export settings. (line 22) * org-odt-table-styles: Customizing tables in ODT export. (line 13) * org-outline-path-complete-in-steps: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-overriding-columns-format: Agenda column view. (line 18) * org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator: Plain lists. (line 14) * org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt: The date/time prompt. (line 76) * org-preview-latex-default-process: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 6) * org-priority-faces: Priorities. (line 13) * org-priority-start-cycle-with-default: Priorities. (line 32) * org-property-allowed-value-functions: Using the property API. (line 68) * org-protocol-default-template-key: capture protocol. (line 19) * org-protocol-project-alist: open-source protocol. (line 13) * org-publish-project-alist <1>: Publishing options. (line 13) * org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6) * org-publish-use-timestamps-flag: Triggering publication. (line 21) * org-put-time-stamp-overlays: In-buffer settings. (line 140) * org-read-date-display-live: The date/time prompt. (line 91) * org-read-date-force-compatible-dates: The date/time prompt. (line 61) * org-read-date-prefer-future: The date/time prompt. (line 6) * org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-refile-keep: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-refile-targets: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-refile-use-cache: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-refile-use-outline-path: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-remove-highlights-with-change <1>: Clocking commands. (line 83) * org-remove-highlights-with-change: Sparse trees. (line 20) * org-replace-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 18) * org-return-follows-link: Handling links. (line 123) * org-reverse-note-order: Refile and copy. (line 17) * org-scheduled-delay-days: Deadlines and scheduling. (line 42) * org-show-context-detail: Sparse trees. (line 6) * org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high: Filtering/limiting agenda items. (line 92) * org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 18) * org-special-ctrl-a/e: Headlines. (line 6) * org-special-ctrl-k: Headlines. (line 6) * org-speed-commands-user: Speed keys. (line 19) * org-startup-align-all-tables <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 84) * org-startup-align-all-tables: Column width and alignment. (line 33) * org-startup-folded <1>: Speeding up your agendas. (line 18) * org-startup-folded <2>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) * org-startup-folded: Initial visibility. (line 6) * org-startup-indented: In-buffer settings. (line 79) * org-startup-with-inline-images <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 91) * org-startup-with-inline-images: Handling links. (line 136) * org-startup-with-latex-preview <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 97) * org-startup-with-latex-preview: Previewing LaTeX fragments. (line 28) * org-store-link-functions: Adding hyperlink types. (line 61) * org-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 17) * org-support-shift-select <1>: Conflicts. (line 6) * org-support-shift-select: Plain lists. (line 94) * org-table-auto-blank-field: Built-in table editor. (line 30) * org-table-copy-increment: Built-in table editor. (line 168) * org-table-duration-custom-format: Durations and time values. (line 6) * org-table-export-default-format: Built-in table editor. (line 205) * org-table-formula: In-buffer settings. (line 30) * org-table-formula-constants <1>: Cooperation. (line 12) * org-table-formula-constants <2>: In-buffer settings. (line 30) * org-table-formula-constants: References. (line 110) * org-table-use-standard-references <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. (line 6) * org-table-use-standard-references: References. (line 17) * org-tag-alist <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 174) * org-tag-alist: Setting tags. (line 23) * org-tag-faces: Tags. (line 10) * org-tag-persistent-alist: Setting tags. (line 38) * org-tags-column: Setting tags. (line 11) * org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22) * org-tags-match-list-sublevels <1>: Matching tags and properties. (line 20) * org-tags-match-list-sublevels <2>: Property searches. (line 19) * org-tags-match-list-sublevels <3>: Tag searches. (line 20) * org-tags-match-list-sublevels: Tag inheritance. (line 26) * org-texinfo-classes <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 6) * org-texinfo-classes: Texinfo file header. (line 11) * org-texinfo-coding-system: Texinfo file header. (line 11) * org-texinfo-default-class <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. (line 6) * org-texinfo-default-class: Texinfo specific export settings. (line 20) * org-texinfo-info-process: Texinfo export commands. (line 6) * org-texinfo-table-default-markup: Plain lists in Texinfo export. (line 12) * org-time-stamp-custom-formats: Custom time format. (line 6) * org-time-stamp-overlay-formats: In-buffer settings. (line 140) * org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes: Creating timestamps. (line 23) * org-todo (face): Faces for TODO keywords. (line 6) * org-todo-keyword-faces: Faces for TODO keywords. (line 6) * org-todo-keywords <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 192) * org-todo-keywords <2>: Global TODO list. (line 18) * org-todo-keywords <3>: TODO extensions. (line 6) * org-todo-keywords: TODO basics. (line 41) * org-todo-repeat-to-state: Repeated tasks. (line 19) * org-todo-state-tags-triggers: TODO basics. (line 62) * org-track-ordered-property-with-tag <1>: Checkboxes. (line 80) * org-track-ordered-property-with-tag: TODO dependencies. (line 38) * org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change: Structure editing. (line 29) * org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change: TODO basics. (line 34) * org-use-fast-todo-selection: TODO basics. (line 14) * org-use-property-inheritance <1>: Using the property API. (line 18) * org-use-property-inheritance <2>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. (line 17) * org-use-property-inheritance <3>: iCalendar export. (line 51) * org-use-property-inheritance: Property inheritance. (line 6) * org-use-speed-commands: Speed keys. (line 14) * org-use-sub-superscripts: Subscripts and superscripts. (line 14) * org-use-tag-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22) * org-yank-adjusted-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 86) * org-yank-folded-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 86) * orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp: Orgstruct mode. (line 26) * parse-time-months: The date/time prompt. (line 57) * parse-time-weekdays: The date/time prompt. (line 57) * ps-landscape-mode: Exporting agenda views. (line 20) * ps-number-of-columns: Exporting agenda views. (line 20) * user-full-name: Export settings. (line 25) * user-mail-address: Export settings. (line 35)  Tag Table: Node: Top893 Node: Introduction24392 Node: Summary24833 Node: Installation27530 Node: Activation30226 Ref: Activation-Footnote-131746 Node: Feedback31868 Ref: Feedback-Footnote-135485 Node: Conventions35612 Node: Document structure37649 Node: Outlines38640 Node: Headlines39269 Ref: Headlines-Footnote-140471 Ref: Headlines-Footnote-240647 Node: Visibility cycling40718 Node: Global and local cycling41097 Ref: Global and local cycling-Footnote-143725 Ref: Global and local cycling-Footnote-243783 Node: Initial visibility44052 Ref: Initial visibility-Footnote-145087 Node: Catching invisible edits45268 Node: Motion45733 Node: Structure editing47060 Node: Sparse trees53658 Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-156168 Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-256279 Node: Plain lists56350 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-163762 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-264116 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-364212 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-464459 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-564630 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-664730 Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-764832 Node: Drawers64898 Ref: Drawers-Footnote-166762 Node: Blocks66898 Node: Footnotes67457 Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-171401 Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-271498 Node: Orgstruct mode71575 Node: Org syntax73205 Node: Tables74178 Node: Built-in table editor74819 Ref: Built-in table editor-Footnote-184540 Node: Column width and alignment84640 Ref: Column width and alignment-Footnote-187201 Node: Column groups87298 Node: Orgtbl mode88869 Node: The spreadsheet89678 Node: References91138 Ref: References-Footnote-197856 Ref: References-Footnote-298078 Ref: References-Footnote-398347 Ref: References-Footnote-498460 Node: Formula syntax for Calc98750 Ref: Formula syntax for Calc-Footnote-1103902 Node: Formula syntax for Lisp104226 Node: Durations and time values105961 Node: Field and range formulas107337 Node: Column formulas109734 Node: Lookup functions111822 Node: Editing and debugging formulas113745 Ref: Using multiple #+TBLFM lines118006 Ref: Editing and debugging formulas-Footnote-1119255 Node: Updating the table119391 Node: Advanced features120747 Ref: Advanced features-Footnote-1125228 Node: Org-Plot125334 Node: Hyperlinks129528 Node: Link format130285 Node: Internal links131544 Ref: Internal links-Footnote-1133839 Ref: Internal links-Footnote-2134079 Node: Radio targets134217 Node: External links134884 Ref: External links-Footnote-1138920 Ref: External links-Footnote-2139339 Node: Handling links139595 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-1147450 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-2147609 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-3147791 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-4148086 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-5148332 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-6148451 Ref: Handling links-Footnote-7148523 Node: Using links outside Org148607 Node: Link abbreviations149092 Node: Search options151861 Ref: Search options-Footnote-1153743 Node: Custom searches153824 Node: TODO items154834 Ref: TODO items-Footnote-1155942 Node: TODO basics156056 Node: TODO extensions158880 Node: Workflow states159910 Ref: Workflow states-Footnote-1161211 Node: TODO types161304 Ref: TODO types-Footnote-1162902 Node: Multiple sets in one file162971 Node: Fast access to TODO states164825 Ref: Fast access to TODO states-Footnote-1165698 Ref: Fast access to TODO states-Footnote-2165782 Node: Per-file keywords166075 Ref: Per-file keywords-Footnote-1167446 Node: Faces for TODO keywords167647 Node: TODO dependencies168688 Node: Progress logging171023 Node: Closing items171735 Ref: Closing items-Footnote-1172712 Ref: Closing items-Footnote-2172781 Node: Tracking TODO state changes172855 Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-1175891 Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-2175946 Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-3176086 Node: Tracking your habits176374 Node: Priorities180608 Ref: Priorities-Footnote-1182580 Node: Breaking down tasks182649 Ref: Breaking down tasks-Footnote-1184628 Node: Checkboxes184724 Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-1189351 Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-2189475 Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-3189649 Node: Tags189769 Node: Tag inheritance190825 Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-1192640 Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-2192740 Node: Setting tags192866 Ref: Setting tags-Footnote-1199177 Node: Tag hierarchy199260 Node: Tag searches202628 Node: Properties and columns203910 Node: Property syntax205346 Node: Special properties209687 Node: Property searches211332 Node: Property inheritance212767 Node: Column view214583 Node: Defining columns215818 Node: Scope of column definitions216196 Node: Column attributes217101 Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-1221895 Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-2222051 Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-3222264 Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-4222547 Node: Using column view222680 Node: Capturing column view225605 Ref: Capturing column view-Footnote-1228609 Node: Property API228745 Node: Dates and times229099 Node: Timestamps230006 Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-1232406 Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-2232592 Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-3232723 Node: Creating timestamps233492 Node: The date/time prompt236316 Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-1240898 Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-2241061 Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-3241167 Node: Custom time format241261 Node: Deadlines and scheduling242983 Ref: Deadlines and scheduling-Footnote-1246464 Node: Inserting deadline/schedule246619 Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-1248419 Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-2248527 Node: Repeated tasks248635 Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-1253038 Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-2253287 Node: Clocking work time253486 Ref: Clocking work time-Footnote-1254671 Ref: Clocking work time-Footnote-2254815 Node: Clocking commands254953 Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-1259858 Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-2259965 Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-3260015 Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-4260073 Node: The clock table260151 Ref: The clock table-Footnote-1267613 Ref: The clock table-Footnote-2267707 Node: Resolving idle time267832 Ref: Resolving idle time-Footnote-1271679 Node: Effort estimates272147 Ref: Effort estimates-Footnote-1274900 Node: Timers275007 Node: Capture - Refile - Archive277299 Node: Capture278289 Node: Setting up capture279357 Ref: Setting up capture-Footnote-1279766 Node: Using capture279832 Node: Capture templates282240 Node: Template elements284205 Ref: Template elements-Footnote-1290782 Ref: Template elements-Footnote-2291099 Node: Template expansion291286 Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-1295354 Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-2295441 Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-3295704 Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-4295886 Node: Templates in contexts295984 Node: Attachments296806 Ref: Attachments-Footnote-1300253 Node: RSS feeds300403 Node: Protocols301880 Node: `store-link' protocol303331 Node: `capture' protocol304139 Node: `open-source' protocol305251 Node: Refile and copy308306 Ref: Refile and copy-Footnote-1310728 Node: Archiving310824 Node: Moving subtrees311524 Node: Internal archiving313548 Node: Agenda views316180 Node: Agenda files318508 Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-1321311 Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-2321460 Node: Agenda dispatcher321653 Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-1324484 Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-2324578 Node: Built-in agenda views324680 Node: Weekly/daily agenda325264 Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-1330999 Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-2331226 Node: Global TODO list331401 Node: Matching tags and properties333929 Node: Search view340881 Node: Stuck projects342194 Ref: Stuck projects-Footnote-1344254 Node: Presentation and sorting344284 Node: Categories345241 Node: Time-of-day specifications345970 Node: Sorting agenda items347939 Node: Filtering/limiting agenda items349508 Ref: Filtering/limiting agenda items-Footnote-1356656 Node: Agenda commands357071 Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-1378062 Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-2378143 Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-3378262 Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-4378362 Node: Custom agenda views378445 Node: Storing searches379086 Ref: Storing searches-Footnote-1382038 Ref: Storing searches-Footnote-2382155 Node: Block agenda382403 Node: Setting options383641 Node: Exporting agenda views387230 Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-1392138 Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-2392255 Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-3392411 Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-4392598 Node: Agenda column view392680 Node: Markup395752 Node: Paragraphs396739 Node: Emphasis and monospace397905 Node: Horizontal rules398747 Node: Images and tables398998 Node: Literal examples400705 Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-1405214 Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-2405742 Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-3405911 Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-4406090 Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-5406340 Node: Special symbols406434 Ref: Special symbols-Footnote-1408364 Ref: Special symbols-Footnote-2408519 Node: Subscripts and superscripts408609 Node: Embedded LaTeX409713 Ref: Embedded LaTeX-Footnote-1410527 Node: LaTeX fragments410717 Ref: LaTeX fragments-Footnote-1412797 Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments413020 Ref: Previewing LaTeX fragments-Footnote-1414449 Node: CDLaTeX mode414695 Ref: CDLaTeX mode-Footnote-1417195 Node: Exporting417343 Node: The export dispatcher419963 Node: Export settings422533 Ref: Export settings-Footnote-1430133 Ref: Export settings-Footnote-2430231 Node: Table of contents430333 Node: Include files432177 Ref: Include files-Footnote-1434966 Node: Macro replacement435132 Ref: Macro replacement-Footnote-1437898 Node: Comment lines438115 Ref: Comment lines-Footnote-1438921 Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export439021 Node: Beamer export441997 Node: Beamer export commands442767 Node: Beamer specific export settings443439 Node: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer445264 Ref: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer-Footnote-1448447 Node: Beamer specific syntax448600 Node: Editing support450518 Node: A Beamer example450992 Node: HTML export452259 Node: HTML Export commands453266 Node: HTML Specific export settings453777 Node: HTML doctypes455760 Node: HTML preamble and postamble457811 Node: Quoting HTML tags458945 Node: Links in HTML export459607 Node: Tables in HTML export461016 Node: Images in HTML export462419 Node: Math formatting in HTML export463864 Ref: Math formatting in HTML export-Footnote-1465255 Node: Text areas in HTML export465379 Node: CSS support466494 Ref: CSS support-Footnote-1469923 Node: JavaScript support470095 Node: LaTeX export473345 Node: LaTeX export commands475063 Ref: LaTeX export commands-Footnote-1476334 Node: LaTeX specific export settings476534 Node: LaTeX header and sectioning479262 Node: Quoting LaTeX code481337 Node: Tables in LaTeX export482121 Node: Images in LaTeX export486414 Ref: Images in LaTeX export-Footnote-1488819 Node: Plain lists in LaTeX export488866 Node: Source blocks in LaTeX export489871 Node: Example blocks in LaTeX export491257 Node: Special blocks in LaTeX export491957 Node: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export493193 Node: Markdown export493580 Node: OpenDocument Text export494878 Ref: OpenDocument Text export-Footnote-1495967 Node: Pre-requisites for ODT export496111 Node: ODT export commands496485 Ref: x-export-to-odt496689 Node: ODT specific export settings497818 Node: Extending ODT export498825 Ref: x-export-to-other-formats499684 Ref: x-convert-to-other-formats500089 Node: Applying custom styles500558 Node: Links in ODT export502319 Node: Tables in ODT export502969 Node: Images in ODT export504939 Node: Math formatting in ODT export507733 Node: Working with LaTeX math snippets508194 Ref: Working with LaTeX math snippets-Footnote-1510430 Ref: Working with LaTeX math snippets-Footnote-2510506 Node: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files510551 Node: Labels and captions in ODT export511078 Node: Literal examples in ODT export512338 Node: Advanced topics in ODT export513156 Node: Configuring a document converter513810 Ref: x-odt-converter-capabilities514488 Node: Working with OpenDocument style files514887 Ref: x-factory-styles515292 Ref: x-orgodtstyles-xml515530 Ref: x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml515857 Ref: x-overriding-factory-styles516506 Ref: x-org-odt-styles-file516777 Ref: x-org-odt-content-template-file517685 Node: Creating one-off styles517826 Node: Customizing tables in ODT export519974 Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-1524827 Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-2524931 Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-3525019 Node: Validating OpenDocument XML525334 Node: Org export526210 Node: Texinfo export526943 Node: Texinfo export commands527959 Node: Texinfo specific export settings528557 Node: Texinfo file header529640 Node: Texinfo title and copyright page530582 Node: Info directory file531904 Node: Headings and sectioning structure532607 Node: Indices534573 Node: Quoting Texinfo code535557 Node: Plain lists in Texinfo export536046 Node: Tables in Texinfo export537373 Node: Images in Texinfo export537860 Node: Special blocks in Texinfo export538485 Node: A Texinfo example539075 Node: iCalendar export541199 Node: Other built-in back-ends544792 Node: Advanced configuration545390 Node: Export in foreign buffers552128 Node: Publishing553165 Node: Configuration554033 Node: Project alist554796 Node: Sources and destinations555937 Node: Selecting files557460 Node: Publishing action558461 Ref: Publishing action-Footnote-1560290 Node: Publishing options560447 Node: Publishing links573601 Node: Sitemap574953 Node: Generating an index578681 Node: Uploading files579463 Node: Sample configuration581227 Node: Simple example581716 Node: Complex example582423 Node: Triggering publication584474 Node: Working with source code585470 Node: Structure of code blocks589920 Node: Editing source code592407 Node: Exporting code blocks595166 Node: Extracting source code597461 Node: Evaluating code blocks599903 Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-1603024 Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-2603150 Node: Library of Babel603336 Node: Languages604012 Node: Header arguments606467 Node: Using header arguments606824 Node: System-wide header arguments607630 Node: Language-specific header arguments608325 Node: Header arguments in Org mode properties608845 Node: Language-specific mode properties610288 Node: Code block specific header arguments611108 Node: Arguments in function calls612759 Node: Specific header arguments613519 Node: var616201 Node: results622783 Node: file626682 Node: file-desc627347 Node: file-ext627745 Node: output-dir628162 Node: dir628560 Node: exports630682 Node: tangle631554 Node: mkdirp632399 Node: comments632713 Node: padline633669 Node: no-expand634060 Node: session634770 Node: noweb635847 Node: noweb-ref638459 Node: noweb-sep639563 Node: cache639867 Node: sep642463 Node: hlines642854 Node: colnames644336 Node: rownames645740 Node: shebang646929 Node: tangle-mode647407 Node: eval648191 Node: wrap649175 Node: post649482 Node: prologue651217 Node: epilogue651713 Node: Results of evaluation651971 Node: Noweb reference syntax655692 Node: Key bindings and useful functions657963 Node: Batch execution660002 Node: Miscellaneous660774 Node: Completion661613 Node: Easy templates663656 Node: Speed keys664876 Node: Code evaluation security666045 Node: Customization668849 Node: In-buffer settings669275 Node: The very busy C-c C-c key678708 Node: Clean view680673 Ref: Clean view-Footnote-1684072 Ref: Clean view-Footnote-2684295 Ref: Clean view-Footnote-3684350 Node: TTY keys684422 Node: Interaction685847 Node: Cooperation686244 Node: Conflicts688963 Node: org-crypt693472 Node: Hacking694724 Node: Hooks695710 Node: Add-on packages696028 Node: Adding hyperlink types696556 Node: Adding export back-ends699917 Node: Context-sensitive commands701137 Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax701818 Node: Radio tables703481 Node: A LaTeX example705554 Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-1709267 Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-2709433 Node: Translator functions709868 Node: Radio lists711975 Node: Dynamic blocks713125 Node: Special agenda views715171 Ref: x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp717996 Ref: Special agenda views-Footnote-1718761 Ref: Special agenda views-Footnote-2718956 Node: Speeding up your agendas719084 Node: Extracting agenda information720128 Node: Using the property API723952 Node: Using the mapping API727277 Node: MobileOrg731244 Node: Setting up the staging area732804 Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-1734006 Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-2734175 Node: Pushing to MobileOrg734382 Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-1735261 Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-2735347 Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-3735706 Node: Pulling from MobileOrg735778 Ref: Pulling from MobileOrg-Footnote-1737798 Node: History and acknowledgments737858 Node: GNU Free Documentation License753043 Node: Main Index778233 Node: Key Index875663 Node: Command and Function Index928251 Node: Variable Index963547  End Tag Table  Local Variables: coding: utf-8 End: